Determinants of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change · doctoral study was to examine the...
Transcript of Determinants of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change · doctoral study was to examine the...
i
Determinants of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change
A Thesis Submitted for the Degree of Doctor of Philosophy
By
Naimatullah Shah
Brunel Business School
Brunel University
November 2009
i
PhD Abstract
Organisations are continually confronting challenges to remain competitive and
successful, which compels organisations to regularly re-evaluate their strategies,
structures, policies, operations, processes and culture. Managing change effectively is
however a main challenge in the change management domain because of massive
human involvement. Thus, managers and change agents are eager to know how to
encourage and effectively prepare employees for change situation. The aim of this
doctoral study was to examine the determinant of employee readiness for organisational
change. The objectives were to investigate employee commitment to the organisation
and career and social relationships factors in public sector higher educational
institutions of Pakistan where various change reforms has been introduced recently.
This empirical study proceeded by a systematic review of literature that led to
development of a conceptual model. The data was collected from a sample of teaching
employees by using a survey questionnaire. Data was analysed using descriptive
statistics and exploratory factor analysis run on statistical package for social sciences
and confirmatory factor analysis on the structural equation modelling as well as on
applied analysis of moment structure to assess the model fit of the study and hypotheses
testing. Results showed that independent variables (emotional attachment, feeling of
pride, pay/wages/rewards, promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement and social
relationships in the workplace) were positively and significantly correlated to the
dependent variable (readiness for organisational change). However, two variables i.e.
supervisor and peer relations, and training and skills development were not found
positive and significant to the readiness for organisational change. This study has
methodological limitations, as it is a cross sectional study that used a survey
questionnaire only in public sector higher education sector. This study provides
empirical evidence for employee readiness predictor variables for organisational
change. This study may contribute to the literature on change management, particularly
for Pakistan, and may assist the management, change agents and practitioners of human
resources management and development, and organisational behaviour in assessing,
designing and evaluating new or existing programmes for organisational change.
KEYWORDS: organisational change, employee readiness, organisational commitment,
career commitment, social relationships in the workplace.
ii
Dedication
This doctoral research effort is dedicated to my parents and my two elder brothers I
never had the opportunity to know and understand due to circumstances beyond our
control – may you rest in eternal peace
iii
Acknowledgement
First of all, I would like to thank Allah, the almighty, who made me capable to complete
this doctoral thesis.
I would like to express my gratitude to many people for the support I received from
them during the time that I study at Brunel. First, I am indebted, sincere and owe great
thanks to my first supervisor, Professor Zahir Irani, for his marvellous supervision,
guidance and encouragement. Sincere gratitude is extended to his generous participation
in guiding, constructive feedback, kind support, and advice during my PhD. Thank you
very much Zahir. I greatly appreciate my thesis second supervisor, Professor Amir M.
Sharif for his constructive feedback, excellent encouragement, and valuable guidance.
Thanks a lot Sharif.
I would like to extend my thanks to University of Sindh, Jamshoro, Sindh, for funding
my doctoral studies. Also thanks to Higher Education Commission (HEC) of Pakistan
for supporting my PhD studies. Also, many thanks to all staff of Brunel Business
School and Univeristy of Sindh for their kind support during my PhD studies.
I greatly appreciate all the organisations that participated in this research and their staff,
and for their time and assistance in collecting empirical data to ensure the completion of
the thesis.
My greatest indebtedness is to my wife, and I can not find adequate words to express
how essential her inspiration and support were to bring me this point. I would not be
here if it was not for her patience, continuous encouragement and thoughtful advice
during my work. I also owe special thanks to my brothers, sisters, uncles, cousins and
in-laws for their moral support, continuous prayers, and endless patience.
Special thanks are due to Professor Khalil-ur-Rehman Khoumbati, Professor Zafar Ali
Pirzado and Dr Sarwar Shah, have been a constant source of encouragement throughout
this journey. Lastly, I extend thanks to all my colleagues at the Chadwick building for
their continuous encouragement and support, as well as many thanks to all my friends
and colleagues from Brunel and outside for their time, advice and moral support.
iv
Declarations
This is to declare that:
- I am responsible for the work submitted in this thesis
- This work has written by me
- All verbatim extract have been distinguished and the sources specifically
acknowledged
- During the preparation of this thesis, some papers were prepared as listed below.
The remaining parts of the thesis have not yet been published.
1) Shah, N., and Irani, Z. (2009) “Impact of Employees Psychological and
Financial Predictors for Readiness to Organisational Change”, European and
Mediterranean Conference on Information Systems (EMCIS 2009), Izmir,
Turkey, (CD-Proceedings).
2) Shah, N. and Irani, Z. (2009) “Investigating Employee Attitudes and Beliefs
Using Commitment and Situational Factors”, International Journal of Logistics
System and Management (Paper Accepted).
3) Shah, N., Irani, Z., and Shah, S. (2009) “Measurement of Job Satisfaction of
Employee Readiness for Organisational Change in the Public Sector
Organisation”, Human Relations (Paper Submitted).
4) Shah, N., Irani, Z., and Shah, S. (2009) “Readiness for Organisational Change:
The Impact of Employees Affective and Individual Commitment”, International
Journal of Human Resources Management, (Paper Submitted).
5) Shah, N., Irani, Z., and Shah, S. (2009) “An Examination of the Career
Commitment Antecedents of Employee Readiness for organisational Change”,
Journal of Organisational Change Management (Paper Submitted)
- This work has not been submitted within a degree programme at this or any
other institutions.
Signature: ----------------------------------------------
Date: ----------------------------------------------------
v
Table of Contents
PhD Abstract .............................................................................................................. i
Dedication ............................................................................................................. ii
Acknowledgement............................................................................................................ iii
Declarations ............................................................................................................ iv
Table of Contents ............................................................................................................. v
List of Appendices ........................................................................................................... ix
List of Figures ............................................................................................................. x
List of Graphs ............................................................................................................ xi
List of Tables ........................................................................................................... xii
List of Abbreviations...................................................................................................... xiv
Chapter One Introduction .............................................................................................. 1
1.1 Introduction ................................................................................................. 1
1.2 Background and Scope of the Study ........................................................... 2
1.3 Aim and Objectives of the Study ................................................................ 4
1.4 The Context and the Respondent Base of the Study ................................... 4
1.5 Methodology and Methods Used ................................................................ 7
1.6 Contribution of the Study .......................................................................... 11
1.7 Structure of the Thesis .............................................................................. 13
Chapter Two Literature Review ............................................................................ 15
2.1 Introduction ............................................................................................... 15
2.2 Organisational Change: An Overview ...................................................... 15
2.3 The Role of Employee in Organisational Change..................................... 18
2.3.1 Employee Readiness ..................................................................................... 21
2.3.2 Employee Resistance .................................................................................... 27
2.4 Employee Readiness Studies in Organisational Change ........................... 28
2.5 The Notion of Commitment ...................................................................... 36
2.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation ................................................ 37
2.5.2 Employee Career Commitment .................................................................... 39
2.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace ..................................................... 40
2.7 Gap in the Research .................................................................................. 41
2.8 Conclusion ................................................................................................ 42
vi
Chapter Three Setting of the Study .......................................................................... 44
3.1 Introduction ............................................................................................... 44
3.2 Pakistan: General Background .................................................................. 44
3.3 Structure of National Education System ................................................... 45
3.3.1 National System of Higher Education .......................................................... 47
3.4 The Academic Hierarchy .......................................................................... 48
3.5 Challenges for Higher Education .............................................................. 49
3.6 The Reforms in the Higher Education Sector ........................................... 52
3.7 Conclusion ................................................................................................ 54
Chapter Four Conceptual Framework ................................................................... 56
4.1 Introduction ............................................................................................... 56
4.2 Organisational Change and its Impacts on Employee .............................. 57
4.3 Conceptual Approach ................................................................................ 59
4.4 Theoretical Framework ............................................................................. 66
4.5 Commitment and its Impact on Employee ................................................ 69
4.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation ................................................ 70
4.5.1.1 Affective Commitment .......................................................................... 73
4.5.1.2 Instrumental Commitment ..................................................................... 74
4.5.2 Employee Career Commitment .................................................................... 75
4.5.2.1 Individual Commitment ........................................................................ 78
4.5.2.2 Situational Commitment ........................................................................ 80
4.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace ..................................................... 80
4.7 Demography .............................................................................................. 81
4.8 Conclusion ................................................................................................ 81
Chapter Five Research Methodology .................................................................... 83
5.1 Introduction ............................................................................................... 83
5.2 Research Philosophy ................................................................................. 83
5.2.1 Research Approach Adopted for this Study ................................................. 88
5.2.2 Justification for Quantitative Approach ........................................................ 89
5.2.3 Rationale for Quantitative Approach ............................................................ 90
5.3 Research Design ........................................................................................ 95
5.4 Research Instrument and Measurement Scale........................................... 99
5.4.1 Developing a Survey Questionnaire ............................................................. 99
vii
5.4.2 Measurement Scales ................................................................................... 104
5.4.2.1 Independent Variables ......................................................................... 104
5.4.2.2 Dependent Variable ............................................................................. 106
5.4.3 Data Triangulation ...................................................................................... 107
5.5 Pilot Study ............................................................................................... 108
5.6 Research Protocol.................................................................................... 108
5.7 Planned Research Study Schedule .......................................................... 109
5.8 Reliability and Validity ........................................................................... 110
5.9 Main Study .............................................................................................. 111
5.9.1 Population and Sampling ............................................................................ 112
5.9.1.1 Targeted Samples ................................................................................ 112
5.9.2 Data Collection Procedure .......................................................................... 113
5.9.3 Data Coding, Cleaning and Entry ............................................................... 114
5.10 Data Analysis Techniques and Statistical Packages ............................... 114
5.10.1 Exploratory Factor Analysis and Reliability Assessment .......................... 115
5.10.2 Confirmatory Factor Analysis and Scale Validity ...................................... 117
5.10.2.1 Scale validity.................................................................................... 118
5.10.3 Structural Equation Modelling and Assessment of Model Fit .................... 119
5.10.4 Hypotheses Testing ..................................................................................... 122
5.11 Ethical Consideration .............................................................................. 124
5.12 Conclusion .............................................................................................. 125
Chapter Six Pilot Study .............................................................................................. 126
6.1 Introduction ............................................................................................. 126
6.2 Research Protocol.................................................................................... 126
6.2.1 Introduction ................................................................................................. 126
6.2.2 Aim and Objectives .................................................................................... 127
6.2.3 Hypotheses .................................................................................................. 127
6.2.4 Study Setting ............................................................................................... 128
6.2.5 Sample size ................................................................................................. 129
6.2.6 Research Methods and Design .................................................................... 129
6.2.7 Data Analysis .............................................................................................. 130
6.3 Pilot Study Methodology ........................................................................ 130
6.4 Pilot Study Results and Data Analysis .................................................... 131
6.4.1 Demographic details ................................................................................... 131
viii
6.4.2 Descriptive Statistics................................................................................... 133
6.4.3 Reliability.................................................................................................... 133
6.4.4 Pearson’s Correlations Analysis ................................................................. 133
6.5 Discussion ............................................................................................... 134
6.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation .............................................. 135
6.5.2 Employee Commitment to the Career ........................................................ 135
6.5.3 Social Relationships in the Workplace ....................................................... 136
6.6 Participants Comments on the Survey Questionnaire ............................. 136
6.7 Conclusion .............................................................................................. 137
Chapter Seven Main Study Analysis and Findings .............................................. 138
7.1 Introduction ............................................................................................. 138
7.2 Data Management ................................................................................... 138
7.3 Data Screening Prior to Analysis ............................................................ 139
7.3.1 Missing Data ............................................................................................... 140
7.3.2 Outliers........................................................................................................ 140
7.3.3 Normality, Linearity and Homoscedasticity ............................................... 143
7.3.2.1 Normality ............................................................................................. 143
7.3.2.2 Linearity .............................................................................................. 146
7.3.2.3 Homoscedasticity ................................................................................ 148
7.4 Demographic Characteristics and Relationships ..................................... 150
7.5 Factor Loading and Data Analysis .......................................................... 154
7.5.1 Exploratory Factor Analysis ....................................................................... 155
7.5.1.1 Eigenvalue ........................................................................................... 156
7.5.1.2 Scree Plot ............................................................................................. 159
7.5.2 Confirmatory Factor Analysis and Measurement Models .......................... 155
7.5.2.1 Discriminant Validity .......................................................................... 173
7.5.3 Assessment of Model Fit ............................................................................ 174
7.6 Hypotheses Testing ................................................................................. 175
7.7 Conclusion .............................................................................................. 182
Chapter Eight Discussion ....................................................................................... 184
8.1 Introduction ............................................................................................. 184
8.2 Population and Sample Issue .................................................................. 184
8.3 Measurement Scale Purification ............................................................. 186
ix
8.4 Determinants of Readiness for Organisational Change: Effects of Employee Commitment to the Organisation ........................................... 188
8.5 Determinants of Readiness for Organisational Change: Effects of Employee Career Commitment ............................................................... 191
8.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace: A Determinant of Readiness for Organisational Change ............................................................................ 197
8.7 Conclusion .............................................................................................. 198
Chapter Nine Conclusions ..................................................................................... 199
9.1 Introduction ............................................................................................. 199
9.2 Research Implications ............................................................................. 200
9.2.1 Theoretical Implications ............................................................................. 200
9.2.2 Practical Implications ................................................................................. 202
9.2.3 Methodological Implications ...................................................................... 204
9.3 Research Limitations ............................................................................... 206
9.3.1 Theoretical Limitations ............................................................................... 206
9.3.2 Methodological Limitations ........................................................................ 207
9.4 Future Research Avenue ......................................................................... 208
References ......................................................................................................... 211
List of Appendices
Appendix 1 Survey Questionnaire .............................................................................. 239
Appendix 2 Covering Letter ...................................................................................... 244
Appendix 3 Research Consent Form .......................................................................... 245
Appendix 4 Survey Questionnaire Coding and labelling ........................................... 246
Appendix 5 Survey Questionnaire Coding and labelling ........................................... 249
Appendix 6 Univariate Statistics ................................................................................ 250
x
List of Figures
Figure 2.1 Organisation Change Nomenclature ......................................................... 20
Figure 2.2 Employee Organisational and Career Commitment Factors ..................... 26
Figure 3.1 Academic Hierarchy of Public Sector Universities .................................. 49
Figure 4.1 Conceptual Framework ............................................................................ 62
Figure 5.1 Deductive and Inductive Reasoning in Research ...................................... 86
Figure 5.2 Research Design ........................................................................................ 97
Figure 7.1 Model ...................................................................................................... 177
xi
List of Graphs
Graph 7.1 Inbox Plot ................................................................................................ 142
Graph 7.2 Scree Plot ................................................................................................ 159
xii
List of Tables
Table 2.1 Classification of Employee Readiness Factors ......................................... 23
Table 2.2 Literature Review ...................................................................................... 29
Table 3.1 Structure of National Education System ................................................... 46
Table 4.1 Change Message Factors ........................................................................... 67
Table 4.2 Maslow’s Hierarchy Need Theory Factors ............................................... 68
Table 4.3 Maslow’s Hierarchy of Need Level Compared to Employee’s Needs ..... 69
Table 5.1 Summary of Philosophical Stance of Research Approach ........................ 85
Table 5.2 Key Features of Positivist and Phenomenological Paradigms .................. 87
Table 5.3 Two Tradition of Social Science ............................................................... 88
Table 5.4 Readiness Studies ...................................................................................... 93
Table 5.5 Survey Questionnaire Items Relations with the Hypotheses and Variables . ......................................................................................................... 103
Table 5.6 Purpose of the Pilot Survey ..................................................................... 108
Table 5.7 Time Schedule for the Research Study ................................................... 109
Table 6.1 Demographic Characteristics of Participants .......................................... 132
Table 6.2 Coefficient Alpha and Correlations of Scales for Pilot Study ................ 134
Table 7.1 Univariate and Multivariate Outliers Results .......................................... 143
Table 7.2 Descriptive Statistics ............................................................................... 145
Table 7. 3 Tests of Normality................................................................................... 146
Table 7.4 Pearson’s Correlations ............................................................................ 147
Table 7.5 Test of Homogeneity of Variances ......................................................... 148
Table 7.6 Demographic Characteristics of Participants .......................................... 151
Table7.7 Demographic Multi Analysis of Variances (MANOVA) ....................... 153
Table 7.8 Communalities ........................................................................................ 156
Table 7.9 Total Variance Explained ........................................................................ 157
Table 7.10 Factor Loading ........................................................................................ 158
Table 7.11 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change Scale .................................................................. 161
Table 7.12 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Commitment to the Organisation Scale .................................................................................. 162
Table 7.13 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Commitment to Career Scale ............................................................................................ 164
Table 7.14 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Social Relationships in the Workplace Scale...................................................................................... 165
xiii
Table 7.15 Measurement Model of Employee Commitment to the Organisation Variables ................................................................................................. 167
Table 7.16 Convergent Validity of Employee Commitment to the Organisation Variables ................................................................................................. 167
Table 7.17 Internal Consistency of Employee Commitment to the Organisation Variables ................................................................................................. 168
Table 7.18 Measurement Model of Employee Commitment to the Career Variables .... ......................................................................................................... 168
Table 7.19 Convergent Validity of Employee Career Commitment Variables ........ 169
Table 7.20 Internal Consistency of Employees’ Career Commitment Variables ..... 170
Table 7.21 Measurement Model of Social Relationships in the Workplace Variable .... ......................................................................................................... 170
Table 7.22 Convergent Validity of Social Relationships in the Workplace Variable..... ......................................................................................................... 171
Table 7.23 Internal Consistency of Social Relationships in the Workplace Variable .... ......................................................................................................... 171
Table 7.24 Measurement Model of Readiness for Organisational Change Variable 172
Table 7.25 Convergent Validity of Readiness for Organisational Change Variable 172
Table 7.26 Internal Consistency of Readiness for Organisational Change Variable 173
Table 7.27 Discriminant Validity .............................................................................. 174
Table 7.28 Model Fit Indicators ................................................................................ 175
Table 7.29 Regression Weights ................................................................................. 178
Table 7.30 Summary of Results of Hypotheses Testing ........................................... 182
xiv
List of Abbreviations
AGFI Adjusted Goodness of Fit Index
AJK Azad Jummu and Kashmir
AMOS Analysis of Moment Structure
BE Bachelor of Engineering
BC British Council
BTS Barlett Test of Sphericity
CR Critical Ratio
CACO Career Commitment
CFA Confirmatory Factor Analysis
CFI Comparative Fit Index
CM Change Management
CV Convergent validity
df Degree of Freedom
DV Discriminant validity
EFA Exploratory Factor Analysis
EMAT Emotional Attachment
FANA Federal Administered Northern Area
FATA Federal Administered Tribal Areas
FOPR Feeling of pride
FRBE Fringe Benefits
GDP Gross Domestic Product
GFI Goodness of Fit Index
GoP Government of Pakistan
GNI Gross National Income
HEC Higher Education Commission
HEL Higher Education Level
HRM Human Resource Management
HSSC Higher Secondary School Certificate
JOIN Job Involvement
JOSA Job Satisfaction
xv
M Mean
MANOVA Multi Analysis of Variances
MBBS Bachelor in Medicine and Bachelor in Surgery
ML Maximum Likelihood
MPhil Master of Philosophy
MS Marital Status
MSc Master of Sciences
MSA Measure of Sample Adequacy
MTDF Medium Term Development Framework
N Number of Participants
ND Number of Dependents
NFI Normated Fit Index
NNFI Non Normated Fit Index
NWFP North West Frontier Province
OC Organisational Change
OD Organisational Development
PAWA Pay/wages/Rewards
Ph.D Doctor of Philosophy
PMTN Promotion
PSO Personal sense of obligation
RMSEA Root Mean Square Error Approximation
ROCH Readiness to organisational change
SE Standard Error
SEM Structural Equation Modelling
Sig. Significant
SMC Squared Multiple Correlations
SORE Social Relationships in the Workplace
SPRE Supervisor and Peer Relations
SPSS Statistical Package for Social Sciences
SSC Secondary School Certificate
TNRE Tenure
TSDE Training and Skills Development
xvi
TTS Tenure Track System
UGC University Grants Commission
UK United Kingdom
USA United States of America
VIF Variance Inflation Factor
YPE Years with present employer
α Cronbach’s alpha
ρ Composite Reliability
χ2 Chi square
1
Chapter One Introduction
1.1 Introduction
This chapter provides a brief outline of the overall study. This doctoral study is
concerned to identify the determinants of employee readiness predictor variables for
organisational change. In today’s increasingly dynamic technological and
communications networked environment, organisations are continually confronting
challenges such as competition, development, general instability, mergers and
reengineering of work processes. These forces challenge organisations to re-evaluate
their strategies, structure, policies, operations, processes, and culture. In this situation,
organisational change (OC) is unavoidable. Of great importance is the fact that humans
have different individual life experiences, motivational levels, socio-demographic
characteristics, knowledge, attitudes, support systems, values, and behavioural patterns
which might involve painful learning and relearning and can create feelings of
uneasiness and tension among employees. Thus, researchers and practitioners need to
know as much as possible about employee readiness predictors so that management can
endeavour to understand an individual’s attitudes, beliefs and behaviours towards
organisational change.
This research empirically investigates the relationships of employee commitment and
social relationship factors with employee readiness for organisational change in public
sector higher educational institutions in Pakistan. A brief description of the background
and scope of the study is provided in this chapter, followed by the aim and objectives of
the study. This chapter explains the context and the respondent base of the study,
methodology and methods used, the contribution of the study, and finally, the structure
of the thesis.
2
1.2 Background and Scope of the Study
Change in organisation usually affects employee attitudes, behaviours and beliefs
because of transferring a situation from the known to the unknown. This particular
situation can develop uncertainty, strain and anxiety among employees. Thus, domain
experts and researchers are concerned with how to deal with employees within
organisations so that they can actively accept and become involved in change
programmes. A review of the literature undertaken by this researcher has revealed that
an individual’s attitudes, beliefs, behaviours and response to organisational change are
influenced by employee readiness factors (Armenakis et al., 1993; Bernerth, 2004;
Madsen et al., 2005). These factors may be related to individual’s psychological and
financial predictors (Alvi and Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999; Goulet and Singh, 2002).
In fact, relationships between employee and employer develop on the basis of the work
environment and mutual exchanges that can galvanise the individual to utilise his or her
abilities, efforts, experiences and skills. The work environment may support an
employee’s developing commitment with the organisation because he or she sees the
possibility of accomplishing their desires, needs and future expectations. By achieving
these desires and needs, an employee can accept or identify with the organisation’s
goals and values. In addition, an employee can develop positive attitudes and
behaviours when he or she understands the need for action. Accordingly, researchers
and experts are interested to explore the factors which support employees for
developing attitudes and behaviour for organisational change (Goulet and Singh, 2002;
Yoon and Thye, 2002; Madsen et al., 2005). This would be possible by analysing the
factors related to an individual’s commitment to the organisation and career. These
factors are mostly applied to understand an individual’s cognitive level towards the
organisation (Goulet and Singh, 2002; Penely and Gould, 1998). On the basis of this
conceptualisation, this research study has been developed on employee commitment to
the organisation and career predictor variables which follow an individual’s
psychological and financial needs. According to Galais and Moser (2009) commitment
to the organisation may be a way of satisfying a need for belonging and identifying. By
applying this approach, management can encourage positive thoughts and feelings
3
among employees towards the organisation and their career which may support
effective and successful change implementation.
The main focus of this study is on employee commitment to their organisation and
career and social relationships in the workplace factors which are related to employee
attitudes and behaviours (Goulet and Singh, 2002; Yoon and Thye, 2002; Madsen et al.,
2005). The literature on change management reveals that Madsen et al. (2005) were the
first to examine the predictors of employee commitment to an organisation and found it
to be positively and significantly related to readiness for organisational change.
However, employees can develop positive feelings and thoughts on the basis of the
employee career commitment as well. If an employee is satisfied with his or her career
he or she will tend to show positive thoughts and feelings for changes in an
organisation. In career development, employees always look to organisational support
regarding the psychological and financial variables that may strengthen their future
career.
This study was conducted in public sector higher educational institutions of Pakistan
where the government of Pakistan has recently announced education reforms for the
faculty members (Shami and Hussain, 2005; Siddiqui, 2006). Indeed, Pakistan is
struggling with high inflation, low growth, corruption, politicisation, increased
population, economic instability, repeated military intervention, gender relations,
ethnicity, religion, and growth of media, industrialisation and decentralisation (Nadvi
and Robinson, 2004). According to Alvi and Ahmed (1987) and Chang (1999)
employees can develop their positive attitudes and behaviours through psychological
and financial factors and these factors may be found to be important for individuals of
Pakistan. Thus, these factors require employee attitudes and behaviours in the context of
Pakistan to be examined, where the readiness predicators for change may be influenced
by different socio-economic, political, religious and cultural factors (Fatima, 2002).
This study is proposed to examine the employee commitment to the organisation and
career and social relationships factor for employee attitudes and behaviours in the public
sector higher educational institutions in Pakistan. The rationale for the proposed study is
that recent organisational changes have been introduced in academic institutions
4
especially in public sector universities across the country and there has been resistance
from employees.
1.3 Aim and Objectives of the Study
Given the importance of employee readiness for organisational change, it is important to
investigate further readiness determinants. The primary aim of this study is to develop a
conceptual framework that explains how employees of public sector institutions of
Pakistan develop their positive attitudes and behaviours regarding organisational
change. The research aim is to investigate employee readiness determinants for
organisational change. This doctoral study has three main research objectives.
1. To examine the relationship of employee commitment to the organisation, career
and social relationships factors to readiness for organisational change.
2. To test the conceptual framework in Pakistan that will help the researcher to
examine the external validity of western developed theories.
3. To examine employee commitment and social relationships predictor variables
in higher educational institutions where change has been announced recently for
the faculty members of the institutions in Pakistan.
1.4 The Context and the Respondent Base of the Study
Much like business organisations, educational systems are affected by steadily
increasing rates of technological, administrative and social change (Rosenblatt and
Inbal, 1999). After World War II higher education institutions developed a unique
position because of highly complex economic, social, political, and environmental
challenges. To address these challenges, higher education institutions became more
complex organisations through which these challenges can be met by teaching, research,
and services functions performed by staff, faculty, and students. To become effective
and successful, these institutions need to change in order to cope with these challenges.
5
Potentially society needs higher education for its development because learning is a
process of development of the mind. To achieve the desired results the main focus has
been laid on faculty who can perform effectively in higher educational institutions.
These institutions desire loyal, knowledgeable, creative and enthusiastic faculty
members to fulfil current needs. Faculty requires a broad set of skills, knowledge,
teaching skills, and research in the field as well as relevant administrative and social
skills. By developing these multi-skill approaches the faculty can potentially enrich
students and contribute to social, economical, and development factors.
But due to increasing trends of computerisation, deregulation, and social integration
which affect the nature of the teaching job, bringing to the front the need for new and
innovative educational methodologies, including the need for teachers to integrate
diverse bodies of knowledge, higher educational institutions are facing enormous
challenges today (Salomon, 1993). These challenges require continuous and constant
changes to improve the performance of educational institutions. To enhance the
performance of institutions and growing professional stability within faculties,
educational institutions have introduced career development strategies. These strategies
are mostly concerned with faculty development programmes which can directly affect
teaching and learning, promote scholarship and academic success, develop leaders and
innovators, and influence the culture in which they work. Faculty development is to
promote teaching as a scholarly activity and to create an educational climate that
encourages and rewards educational leadership, innovation and excellence. In this
regard researchers and practitioners have mainly focused on faculty development in
respect of other organisational components due to enhancing the capacity of faculty to
satisfactorily perform complex duties and to solve society’s problems (Kopelman, 1985;
Salomon, 1993).
Faculty development efforts are designed to facilitate faculty members’ commitment to
and ability to achieve both their own goals and their institution’s goal. An effective
faculty development programme will simultaneously and continuously attend to all the
aspects that impact on the success of the faculty including faculty members’ goals, the
institution’s goals and individual ability levels together with the institution’s features
6
that inhibit or facilitate faculty members’ ability to achieve their goals and collectively,
the institutions. Faculty development literature consists of work commitment,
motivation, performance, productivity, stress, satisfaction, turnover, and attitude
(Shirom, 1994; Kopelman, 1985).
The ability of faculty to perform effectively depends upon his or her expectations when
change is expected. During the change they may evaluate the situation in the light of
their own needs, expectations, success probability, outcomes, and change behaviour in a
given environment to adopt new changes. Researchers and practitioners are confused
about the success of change because employees are in a continuous state of change.
They can not anticipate human attitudes, behaviours and expectations which fluctuate
from hour to hour and sometimes from moment to moment (Davis, 1979). They try to
become aware of new possibilities every day. Each of these possibilities is assumed to
have associated with it an approach or avoidance tendency and that choice is determined
primarily by the faculty member’s perceptions of the success and payoff associated with
each tendency. Faculty members always assess the probability of success and the
probability of payoffs, which brings a healthy scepticism to the situation.
This study is based on a conceptual framework that has been developed on the basis of
employee need and expectation theory. More specifically, this research is investigating
employee attitudes and behaviours in public sector higher educational institutions of
Pakistan. There are no consistent links between overall human developments, wealth,
gender, or education in the region, but many interlinked factors such as politics, culture,
and governmental structures which affect each other. In order to transform Pakistan
from an agriculture based economy to a knowledge economy, specific programmes
(faculty development, improving access, promoting excellence in learning and research)
particularly in higher education have been introduced as priority national programmes
(Shami and Hussain, 2005; Siddiqui, 2006). In recent reforms, the main focus has been
on faculty development (Mughal and Manzoor, 1999). Under the faculty development
programme, faculty member grades were enhanced one step ahead of other government
employees. For the promotion to the next grade, higher degrees such as Master of
Philosophy (MPhil) or Doctor of Philosophy (PhD) and research publications are
7
compulsory. Furthermore, a tenure tracking system (TTS) was introduced which looks
at faculty appointments and promotions. In this reform appointment of faculty will be
on a contract basis and the evaluation process has also been changed which affects the
relationships between faculty and management (this is discussed in the next chapter).
This study seeks to investigate the employee commitment and social relationship factors
based on these changes, in which the researcher attempts to understand employee
attitudes and behaviours. In this regard a conceptual model has been developed to show
the relationships of employee commitment to the organisation and career and social
relationships in the workplace to the readiness for organisational change.
For this study, only public sector universities from all over Pakistan were included. The
population included full time teaching employees including all categories of faculty
members such that professors, associate professors, assistant professors, and lecturers.
The targeted participants (n=518) of the main survey were faculty members, for which
full information was obtained from the web site of the Higher Education Commission
(HEC) of Pakistan and individual university web sites which were selected for this
study. The researcher started the procedure by contacting a randomly selected sample of
population to establish their willingness to participate in the research study and any
queries regarding the instrument and privacy. After getting consent from the
participants, a survey questionnaire containing a copy of the questionnaire and a
covering letter prepared by the supervisors of the study were handed over either on
personal visits or sent by post or email. Addresses and contact numbers of the
participants were obtained from the higher education commission web site and from the
respective university web sites or personal visits to universities. After two weeks the
researcher contacted the participants reminding them to provide a response. Three
reminders were issued. However, after sixty days or a third reminder, participants who
did not respond were excluded from the study.
1.5 Methodology and Methods Used
The aim of this research is to examine employee readiness predictor variables to
understand the attitudes and behaviours towards organisational change in Pakistan. This
8
research study has been developed on the basis of a literature review and conceptual
approach. With the support of a conceptual approach, hypotheses have been developed
in relation to independent and dependent variables. The procedure adopted for this
research followed a quantitative approach for data collection and analysis. According to
Gilbert (2001, p-19), the positivism paradigm uses deduction, beginning with
hypotheses. Hussey and Hussey (1997, p-55) suggested that the normal process under a
positivistic paradigm is to study the literature to establish an appropriate theory and
construct hypotheses. There are certain reasons for adopting a quantitative approach to
data collection from the workplace. First, this study is going to measure the
relationships between the variables. Second, the ontological position suggests the realist
position. Third, the epistemology position allows independent observable facts. The
fourth assumption is human nature in relation to environment. Finally, there are the
methodological issues relating to measurement and identification of underlying themes.
Burrell and Morgan (1979, p-5) revealed that quantitative research seeks to explain and
predict what happens in the social world by searching for patterns and causal
relationships between its constituent elements. This method is more suitable when the
object of the research is to gather data related to the frequency of occurrence of
phenomena. According to Gilbert (2001, p-32), the aim is to develop valid and reliable
ways of collecting “facts” about society, which can then be statistically analysed in
order to produce explanations about how the social world operates.
Thus, this method can be applied to gain understanding of human attitudes and
behaviours regarding information about people through objective values. This research
is predominantly quantitative to collect data and test theories. Due to its descriptive
nature, it adopts a quantitative approach and uses a survey method to gather data
(Churchill, 1979).
The literature reveals that many well known researchers have adopted quantitative
methods to collect data in change management domain to understand individual
attitudes and behaviours. In this connection, Hanpachern et al. (1998) found the factors
related to margin in life and demographic factors with readiness for organisational
9
change. By getting 131 survey questionnaires from a manufacturing company in the
United States of America (USA), they found significant impact of job knowledge and
skills, social relations in the workplace, organisational culture, and management
leadership relationships to employee readiness. Cunningham et al. (2002) examined
logistical and occupational risks of change, the ability to cope with change and to solve
job related problems, social support; active vs. passive job constructs to influence
readiness for change in healthcare organisations. In Canada, Madsen et al. (2005) were
the first to describe significant relationships between employee readiness, organisational
commitment and social relationships in the workplace. By applying survey
questionnaire in four profit-oriented companies from northern Utah, Canada, Miller et
al. (2006) focused on employee readiness for change by examining three workplace
factors-management and leader relationships, job knowledge and skills, and job
demands and found a significant influence on employee readiness for change. Rafferty
and Simons (2006) focused on the factors that make readiness for two types of change
like corporate transformation and fine-tuning. A recent research study conducted by
Holt et al. (2007) received 464 questionnaire surveys from full-time employees in
public and private companies in northern Utah. Researchers found that readiness for
change is influenced by employees’ beliefs of self-efficacy, appropriateness,
management support, and personal valence.
The above literature reveals that employees and management have always needed to
know the attitudes and behaviours regarding organisational change. By understanding
the objectives, the majority of researchers have applied a positivist approach through
survey questionnaires. Survey questionnaires can provide insight into individual
perception and attitudes as well as organisational policies and practices (Baruch and
Holtom, 2008, p-1140). According to Chen (2005, p-153) attitude measurement often
involves asking respondents not just what they feel about a particular object, but what
they believe about it. In positivist methodology, survey questionnaires use Likert
scaling to measure the attitudes of individuals (Miller and Brewer, 2003) because the
reliability of Likert scales tends to be good and partly because of the greater range of
answers permitted to respondents (Oppenheim, 1992, p-200).
10
In this study, the researcher sought to examine employee commitment to the
organisation and career predictors which are related to employee attitudes and
behaviours towards his or her organisation and their vocation. The researcher applied a
quantitative approach which is one of the major approaches in business and social
sciences research methodology. This design is intended to enhance understanding of
human attitudes, behaviours, and beliefs during change programmes. A quantitative
approach focuses on what, where and when (Collis and Hussey 2003). Thus, this
doctoral study addresses the following questions.
1. What impact does the employee commitment to the organisation factor have on
employee readiness for organisational changes?
2. What impact does employee career commitment factor have on employee
readiness for organisational changes?
3. What impact do employee’s social relationships in the workplace have on
readiness for organisational changes?
The analysis of data for the main study consists of three major stages. In the first stage,
the content and the relevance of the multi-item scales were refined on the basis of
quantitative data gathered from the different sample populations. In the second, scales
were validated using confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) via structural equation
modelling (SEM). Lastly, hypotheses were tested using analysis of moment structure
(AMOS) 16.0 version software in structural equation model.
Before conducting the main study, a pilot study was conducted to establish the
reliability of multi-item scale development. A Cronbach’s coefficient alpha (α) was
applied to check the reliability of scales in the pilot study (Carmines and Zeller, 1979;
Peter, 1979; Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). In addition, the face validity of survey
questionnaires was carried out through field experts. In this connection, a few surveys
were sent to university professors to confirm the face validity. Moreover, for the main
study survey questionnaire reliability and validity was assessed by applying exploratory
factor analysis followed by confirmatory factor analysis. In order to assess the validity
of scale, a confirmatory factor analysis was performed on the main survey data before
11
structural model testing (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Anderson and Gerbing,
1988; Hair et al., 2006). However, the construct validity of the questionnaire was
assessed by composite validity, Cronbach’s alpha’s reliability, and average variance
extraction methods. Finally, the relationship between the constructs was tested by an
analysis of moment structure via structural equation modelling.
Missing data, descriptive statistics, outlier examination, linearity test, normality of data,
homoscedasticity, exploratory factor analysis and reliability analysis tests were dealt
with using statistical package for social sciences (SPSS) 15.0 version for windows
(Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006). However, an analysis of moment
structure (AMOS) 16.0 versions software was used to perform both the confirmatory
factor analysis and the structural model testing (Hair et al., 2006).
1.6 Contribution of the Study
The contribution of this study is based on the development of a comprehensive
theoretical framework that examines the factors that influence the individual attitudes
and behaviours for organisational change in public sector higher educational institutions
of Pakistan. To the best knowledge of the author, this is the first time such a theoretical
framework has been tested empirically and theoretically. Previous studies that have
been conducted in the area of employee readiness for organisational change did not
focus on the employee career commitment factors and failed to develop the relationship
with employee readiness for change. This study establishes an integrative theoretical
framework that combines a set of factors of employee commitment that influence the
employee positive attitudes and behaviours. The aim of this study was to investigate
employee readiness predictor variables for developing positive attitudes and behaviours
to organisational change. Several other contributions emerged from this research.
First, one of the distinctive contributions is the development of an integrated model
based on Maslow’s hierarchical need theory and Armenakis five key message
components of employee readiness for organisational change. In the present study, an
integrative model was developed that combines factors associated with employee
12
commitment to the organisation and career and social relationships in the workplace.
These are emotional attachment, feeling of pride, personal sense of obligation,
pay/wages/rewards, promotion, career commitment, job satisfaction, job involvement,
supervisor and peer relations, training and skills development, social relationships in the
workplace. Most previous studies have focused on the psychological, workplace,
environmental, cultural and social factors and ignored other potential individual
development factors. This is first study to the best knowledge of the researcher, that
combines both psychological and financial factors that are relevant to individual factors.
Second, another contribution to knowledge is that it is the first study of its nature based
on valuable data from Pakistan. In addition, the study contributed to the limited so far
knowledge on how employees from Pakistan develop their attitudes and behaviours for
organisational change. The conceptual framework was developed on the basis of
employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours that can be developed by satisfying basic
needs such that psychological and financial.
Third, in the literature it was found that most prior studies were conducted in
organisations other than higher educational institutions. In this study, data was collected
from the employees of public sector higher education institutions of Pakistan. This is
the first such study reported in Pakistan’s higher education institutions. The sample
consisted of thirty three public sector universities from all over Pakistan out of an
overall number of seventy eight. The sample is regarded as a good representation of
public sector institutions of Pakistan.
Fourth, a strong point of the research relates to the fact that it brings empirical evidence
from a relatively new cultural context taking into account that most of the preview
studies have taken place in USA, Canada, UK and Australia. This is the first study
reported on employee readiness for organisational change in the Pakistan context. This
is significant in permitting a test of the wider validity of findings derived from research
conducted in developed economies.
13
Finally, the results show that personal attributes are affecting the employee attitudes and
behaviours to readiness for organisational change. This finding is a key contribution for
a country like Pakistan. Although we could expect to find that personal attributes of
employee would be influenced in developing attitudes and behaviours for organisational
change, the findings have shown that external environment matters more for the
attitudes and behaviours of Pakistani employees.
1.7 Structure of the Thesis
This thesis has eight chapters along with references and appendices. The outlines are as
follows:
Chapter 1 Introduction - The first chapter discusses the background and scope of the
study, aims and objectives, the context and the respondent base of the study. It
continues by presenting the methodology and methods adopted and contribution of the
study.
Chapter 2 Literature Review – This chapter reviews existing literature on
organisational change, the role of the employee in organisational change, employee
readiness and resistance, employee commitment to the organisation and career
commitment and social relationships in the workplace. It reveals extant studies in
disciplines such as change management, organisational behaviour, and organisational
development. Past studies on employee readiness predictors are then reviewed. Finally,
a gap in the research is identified and discussed.
Chapter 3 Conceptual Framework – The construct of this chapter is to develop
research hypotheses to examine employees’ readiness predictors for organisational
change. To address the hypotheses effectively, the researcher reviews and integrates
subject areas such that organisational change and its impact on an individual employee,
conceptual approach, theoretical frameworks, employees’ commitment to the
organisation and career, social relationships in the workplace and demography. This
leads to the clarification of the research area and development of a conceptual approach
14
and a theoretical framework.
Chapter 4 Research Methodology – This includes a detailed discussion of the
empirical research methodology including data collection and data analysis procedure.
The data collection section is described in five parts as (a) data collection (b) sample
selection and participation (c) developing the survey questionnaire (d) measurement
scales and (e) pilot study. After that reliability and validity are discussed to justify the
data. The chapter also discuss what kind of data is required to examine the variables.
Then, data analysis processes and statistical techniques are selected to analyse the data.
Finally, the research ethical issues are discussed to ensure the data is unbiased and can
support generalisability. Conclusions are presented in this chapter.
Chapter 5 Pilot Study – This chapter present the pilot study analysis and the findings.
It consists of the research protocol, pilot study methodology, pilot study results and data
analysis; discussion, participants’ comments on the survey questionnaire. Finally,
conclusions and suggestions are presented.
Chapter 6 Main Study Analysis and Findings – This chapter presents the analysis and
findings of the main survey. The chapter begins with data management, data screening,
demographic characteristics, factor loading, exploratory factor analysis, and assessment
of model fit. The chapter ends by showing the outcomes of hypotheses testing
Chapter 7 Discussion – The structure of this chapter is as follows. First, the population
and sample issues, second, the results of scale purification are presented. Third, the
findings of all hypotheses testing are reviewed and compared with past research.
Finally, the results of social relationships in the workplace to readiness for
organisational change are discussed.
Chapter 8 Conclusions – This chapter summarises the results of this study and the
thesis. It discusses first the theoretical contribution of the thesis in terms of gaps in the
research. Second, the managerial implications of the study’s findings are described.
This is followed by a discussion of the methodological and theoretical limitations of the
research. Finally, future research directions are suggested.
15
Chapter Two Literature Review
2.1 Introduction
The previous chapter provided a brief setting of the study. This chapter takes a detailed
look from the extant literature on the issues that have direct affect on employee attitudes
and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. Importantly, these insights
highlight the fact that employee readiness for organisational change is imperative for
successful implementation of organisational change programmes. The literature review
covers sufficient ground to ensure a solid perspective on the factors that may support
the development of positive employee attitudes and behaviours. The literature review is
a critical analysis in business and management research, that shows the current state of
the research topic is understood and supports any conceptual framework (Maylor and
Blackmin, 2005, p-117). The literature review demonstrates a clear understanding of the
research topic, identifies the major studies related to the research area, identifies the
different points of the views on the research topic, draws clear and appropriate
conclusions, and demonstrates the relevance and importance of the research problems
(Hart, 1998, p-198).
A review of the literature on organisational change, employee role in organisational
change, employee readiness and resistance, employee commitment to the organisation,
career commitment and social relationships in the workplace is the focus of this chapter.
It examines extant studies in disciplines such as change management, organisational
behaviour, and organisational development. The chapter begins with an overview of
organisational change and the role of employees in organisational change. Past studies
on employee readiness predictors are then reviewed. Finally, the research gap is
identified and discussed.
2.2 Organisational Change: An Overview
Change is concerned with the development of organisation. It is used to solve the
problems and challenges of the organisation. In organisation, most problems and
16
challenges are generated by competition, advanced technology, mergers, expansion,
product quality maintenance, or enhancing employee efficiency on the one hand and
rapid growth, new business ventures, exciting opportunities, innovations, and new
leadership and management approaches (Madsen et al., 2005, p-213) on the other.
Organisational change is defined by shifting from one stage to another or it is concerned
with breaking down existing structures and creating new ones (Chonko, 2004). Barnett
and Carroll (1995) defined it as a transformation between two points in time with the
key ability to compare the organisation before and after the transformation. Change
might be small or large but are concerned with improvement, variation, alteration or
modification of something (Bennett, 2001). The source of change is both internal and
external pressures associated with the expansion or need of businesses to respond to
challenges. Internal change factors are concerned with organisational growth, while
external factors are associated with issues like institutional and market volatility
(Barnett and Carroll, 1995).
Potentially change in organisation is referred to as chaotic and dramatic (Gleick, 1987;
Abrahamson, 2000), because transferring from a known to an unknown position can
develop particular uncertainties, anxiety and ambiguities. In this position, employee can
develop different thoughts, feelings and behaviours towards the situation which might
involve painful learning and relearning and create a feeling of uneasiness and tension. It
is important to remember that humans have different individual life experiences,
motivational levels, socio-demographic characteristics, knowledge, attitudes, support
systems, values, and behavioural patterns (Ilgen and Pulakos, 1999). Employees
approach organisational change in different ways as some individuals perceive that it
can provide opportunities for learning and growth, while others view it as a threat.
Successful adjustment to change can result in higher levels of enthusiasm providing
opportunities for learning and growth, while poor adjustment to change is characterised
by feelings of uncertainty, frustration, alienation, and anxiety, particularly in relation to
issues of job security, status, work tasks, co-worker relations, and reporting
relationships (Ashford, 1988; Holt et al., 2007). Thus, researchers and practitioners
need to know the maximum level of employee readiness predictors so that management
17
can endeavour to understand the maximum level of individuals’ beliefs, intentions and
perceptions during implementation of change programmes.
Competing with important and often unknown challenges, managers of organisations
are anxious to know how to survive for future and stay competitive. Change agents and
practitioners suggest that an organisation must change its policies, strategies, structures,
approaches, culture, and procedures to compete (Cummings and Worley, 2005). In the
organisation, change may be small or large, quantum leap or incremental but requires
proper attention because its consequences affect organisational performance,
development, reputation, competition and future survival. Although in any sort of
situation organisations require proper processes for controlling disruption and
challenges.
Stress among employees can be disseminated by different factors like environment,
culture, and situation. Employee response might be in favour or against, because of
different feelings, thoughts and behaviours (Armenakis et al., 1993; 1999). However,
these feelings and perceptions can be learned by past experiences and demographic
values. The literature reveals that stress due to organisational change is caused not only
by the organisation but a prime source is employees within the organisation (Vakola and
Nikolaou, 2005). Beliefs, behaviours and attitudes of different employees might be
different in same job and the same place because of different individual perception
levels. Thus, it is difficult for change promoters and practitioners to anticipate the
individual employee disposition level to manage the change programme. The sole desire
of the organisation is getting positive results to change initiatives, and in order to
achieve that managers and change promoters need to know more employee readiness
predictors.
The existing literature on change management supports the idea that main focus has
been concentrated on employee attitudes, behaviours, perceptions and beliefs which
depend upon past experience, current situation, and future perspectives (Armenakis et
al., 1993; Ilgen and Pulakos, 1999; Bernerth, 2004). Regarding attitudes and
18
behaviours, employee may have a positive or negative judgment of a change
implemented by the organisation (Lines, 2005).
Within organisation, employees have been found to be a useful and successful source
for mobilisation of organisational assets, while change management has explored the
essential and dominant factors for sustaining organisational change programmes
(Armenakis et al., 1999; Smith, 2005; Susanto, 2008; Elias, 2009). Literature of change
management adds the idea that before or during the launch of any change programme,
change promoters and agents should develop employee positive attitudes, beliefs, and
intentions towards the proposed organisational change (Armenakis et al., 1993,
Bernerth, 2004). Heracleous and Langham (1996) advocate that understanding of
employee is imperative for managing change due to the subtle issues involved.
Armenakis et al. (1993; 1999) point out that employee positive response is viable
towards change because of the level of their involvement. Viewing employee as a
centrifugal force, researchers in the main have focused on employee issues to support
the development of positive behaviours and attitudes (Eby et al., 2000; Cunningham et
al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simons, 2006; Cinite et al., 2009). These
issues can be broadly classified into two categories like individual and workplace
factors. Cunningham et al. (2002) advocate the idea that research on individual, process,
and workplace factors in readiness for organisational change is important to success.
The following section discusses the role of employee in organisational change.
2.3 The Role of Employee in Organisational Change
To achieve their objectives and goals in a challenging situation, organisations today
need to change the status quo for future survival and staying competitive. This change
might involve a transformation of strategies, cultures, structures, approaches, or
processes that may overcome the challenges of organisations (Cummings and Worley,
2005). Potentially change involves tracking the new situation with respect to need and
capability of the organisation. Researchers and practitioners are interested to know how
to deal with unknown situations created by organisational change. Furthermore, domain
literature describes that by changing the status quo or any transformation, those
19
primarily affected are employees whose response might be positive or negative
(Armenakis et al., 2001; Rafferty and Simons, 2006; Holt et al., 2007). Although the
literature points out that employee openness regarding acceptance and resistance
depends upon their attitudes and behaviours with respect to the workplace and
individual context (Figure 2.1).
The success of organisational change is often determined by employee attitudes and
beliefs towards the change (Beer and Walton, 1990). According to Arnold el al. (1995,
p-167) “Attitudes reflect a person’s tendency to feel, think or behave in a positive or
negative manner towards the object of the attitude”. Many researchers like Eby et al.
(2000); Kotter (1996); and Martin (1998) focused on positive attitudes and behaviours
to promote effective change programmes. Vakola et al. (2003) argue that employee can
be happy or excited or angry and fearful when confronted by change. It shows that the
individual’s perceptions towards the new situation primarily affect organisational
change goals and objectives.
To develop a positive response from employee towards change is imperative because of
the sheer scale of involvement of individuals who have different experiences of life.
Armenakis and Bedeian (1999, p-307) reported that “as open systems, organisations
depend on human direction to succeed”. The response of employee towards change
largely arises from his or her positive or negative perceptions. Employee positive
response shows willingness towards change while negative reflects resistance. If
employee response is negative, this means they don’t want to accept or believe and may
intend to resist or quit. Given such a response, organisation might face threats from
employee, high turnover rates, uncertainty, frustration, lower efficiency, anxiety, and a
decline in output and decreased organisational commitment (Coch and French, 1948;
Kotter and Schlesinger, 1979; Goldstein, 1988; Martin et al., 2005). Conversely, a
20
Figure 2.1 Organisation Change Nomenclature
Structure Strategies
Readiness
Culture
Resistance
Organisation Change
Process
Human
- Emotion - Lack of Readiness - Ineffective Communication - Non-Satisfaction - Leadership Failure - Politics - Insufficient Planning -Uncertainty
- Change Agent Role
- Effective Communication - Job Knowledge & Skills - Social Relations - Organisational Culture - Management/Leadership Relationship - Individual Attitude - Job Attitudes - Logistic & Systemic Support - Trust - Autonomy - Principal Support - Self-efficacy - Discrepancy - Personal Valance - Appropriateness - Wellness - Active-Passive Job -Job Demands - Belief - Participation - Commitment - Power and Load - Demography
21
positive response shows employee readiness which can support the organisational
change. This response may provide high commitment, low turnover, high performance
and low absenteeism (Desplaces, 2005). Thus, in the domain of organisational change
management, the human factor has been found to be the most crucial, complex and
dominant factor in supporting effective and successful implementation of change in
organisation (Armenakis et al., 1993; Smith, 2005; 2006).
Change management literature shows that employee beliefs, perceptions and attitudes
are critical in successful organisational change (Schalk et al., 1998; Weber and Weber,
2001). Acceptance and resistance are affected by how the change is seen to affect the
sense of the individual’s identity in the organisation. Dirks et al. (1996, p-8) points out
that “individuals will promote change efforts under conditions fulfilling their needs for
self enhancement”. The literature further points out that a positive employee response
can be obtained by fulfilling basic needs such that financial and psychological (Alvi and
Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999).
2.3.1 Employee Readiness
As discussed in the previous section that organisational change affects individual
perceptions that may be supportive or resistant (Armenakis and Bedeian, 1999). Support
of employee shows readiness. Readiness is defined as a belief, intention, attitude and
behaviour regarding the extent to which change is needed and the organisational
capacity to achieve it successfully (Armenakis et al., 1993; Rafferty and Simons, 2006;
Susanto, 2008). Bernerth (2004) defines that readiness is a state of mind during the
change process that reflects a willingness or receptiveness to changing the way one
thinks. Before developing positive state of mind towards organisational change,
employee needs to be able to visualise the current situation of the organisation and
environment by comparing past and anticipated future perspectives.
Researchers believe that employee willingness and receptivity is essential for an
organisation to implement change successfully (Hanpachern, et al., 1998; Eby et al.,
2000; Jansen, 2000; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006). Thus, it is
necessary to know how to deal with employee before, during and after launching the
organisational change programmes. During change, an employee possesses two options
22
such that positive or negative. Positive attitudes can underwrite the organisation
development and future survival, while negative attitudes would be followed by
frustration and resistance. In fact, the failure of a change programme would have a
negative impact on the organisation as well as employee (Goldstein, 1988; Martin et al.,
2005). These negative impacts may include loss of time of managers and cost which can
affect organisational performance, development, and reputation (Smith, 2005). Thus,
researchers and practitioners are more interested in exploring possible employee
readiness predictors galvanising the employees for effective and successful
implementation of organisational change (Hanpachern, et al., 1998; Eby et al., 2000;
Bernerth, 2004; Madsen et al., 2005; Holt et al., 2007).
Many researchers have made individuals the centre of analysis for the success of
organisational change (Judge et al., 1999). Over the past few decades it has been
observed that this is how to get employee to embrace effective and successful change
programmes (Armenakis et al., 1993; Bernerth, 2004; Holt et al., 2007; Cinite et al.,
2009). Many predictors like change agent role, proper process, need for change,
capability of organisation, participation, culture, belief, environment, and commitment
have been found to be related to employee readiness (Hanpachern et al., 1998; Eby et
al., 2000; Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simons, 2006).
These predictors can be categorised by individual, psychological, workplace,
environmental, cultural and social factors. However, researcher further categorised these
factors into two categories (individual and workplace factors) (Table 2.1). Ilgen and
Pulakos (1999) and Desplaces (2005) have advocated that extent of certain individual
and workplace characteristics may lead to the development of a positive attitude and
behaviour towards change readiness.
23
Table 2.1 Classification of Employee Readiness Factors
Category Factor(s) Reference(s)
1. Workplace Factors
Active and Passive Job Appropriateness Change Efficacy Communication Decision Latitude Discrepancy Flexible Policies and Procedures Job Demands Job Knowledge and Skills Logistic and System Support Management and Leadership Relationships Organisational Commitment Organisational Culture Perceived Organisational Support Personal Valence Social Relations at Workplace Social Support Wellness
Cunningham et al. (2002); Miller et al. (2006) Armenakis and Harris (2002); Holt et al. (2007); Weber and Weber (2001) Armenakis and Harris (2002); Holt et al. (2007); Lehman et al. (2002) Holt et al. (2007); Armenakis and Fredenberger (1997); Wanberg and Banas (2000) Cunningham et al. (2002) Armenakis and Harris (2002); Armenakis et al. (1993) Rafferty and Simons (2006); Eby et al. (2000) Cunningham et al. (2002); Miller et al. (2006); Hanpachern et al. (1998) Miller et al. (2006); Hanpachern (1998); Cunningham et al. (2002) Rafferty and Simons (2006); Eby et al. (2000) Miller et al. (2006); Hanpachern et al. (1998) Madsen et al. (2005); (Elias, 2009) Hanpachern et al. (1998); Lehman et al. (2002); McNabb and Sepic (1995) Rafferty and Simons (2006); Eby et al. (2000); Holt et al. (2007) Armenakis and Harris (2002); Holt et al. (2007) Madsen et al. (2005); Hanpachern et al. (1998) Cunningham et al. (2002); Wanberg and Banas (2000) Madsen (2003)
2. Individual Factors
Adaptability Autonomy
Lehman et al. (2002) Weber and Weber (2001)
24
Beliefs Demography Depression Emotional Exhaustion General Attitude Intention to Quit Self Efficacy Job Satisfaction Participation Personal Resilience Rebelliousness Skills Variety Supervisory Support Team Work Trust (in Peers; management; Senior Leaders) Turnover Work Irritation
Peach et al. (2005) Madsen et al. (2005); Holt et al. (2007); Weber and Weber (2001); Hanpachern et
al. (1998); Wanberg and Banas (2000) Cunningham et al. (2002) Cunningham et al. (2002) Holt et al. (2007) Wanberg and Banas (2000) Cunningham et al. (2002); Eby et al. (2000); Wanberg and Banas (2000); Lehman et al. (2002); Rafferty and Simons (2006); Armenakis and Bedian (1999) Wanberg and Banas (2000) Cunningham et al. (2002); Rafferty and Simons (2006); Eby et al. (2000); Weber and Weber (2001); Wanberg and Banas (2000); Armenakis and Fredenberger (1997) Wanberg and Banas (2000) Holt et al. (2007) Eby et al. (2000) Weber and Weber (2001) Eby et al. (2000) Rafferty and Simons (2006); Eby et al. (2000); Weber and Weber (2001) Wanberg and Banas (2000) Wanberg and Banas (2000)
Affective Commitment Elias (2009)
25
A large amount of literature is available on the employee readiness domain relating to
individual and workplace factors (Weber and Weber, 2001; Cunningham et al., 2002;
Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006; Holt et al., 2007; Elias, 2009).
However, the impact of both factors can be envisaged by employee attitudes, beliefs,
and perceptions. Indeed, individual factors are associated with personal and social
aspects of individuals such as an active problem solving approach, beliefs, autonomy,
depression, emotional exhaustion, demography, self-efficacy, locus of control (Weber
and Weber, 2001; Cunningham et al., 2002; Peach et al., 2005; Madsen et al., 2005).
These characteristics show an individual’s influence and support for reducing the
uncertainty and ambiguity of the change process. Another important factor is the
workplace which is related to the organisational environment, culture, and services. In
the workplace factor employee hold expectations and assumptions which affect their
perceptions regarding change. In the workplace factor, appropriateness, discrepancy,
organisational commitment, social relationships in the workplace, job knowledge and
skills, logistic and system support, social support, and wellness factors have been found
in the literature (Wanberg and Banas, 2000; Armenakis and Harris, 2002; Cunningham
et al., 2002; Madsen, 2003; Miller et al., 2006; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and
Simon, 2006).
All these factors have been examined with different correlations and found more
potential results for employee readiness during the implementation of organisational
change. After extensive literature review this study focused to investigate more
employee readiness predictors relating to individual and workplace factors (Figure 2.2),
which may support to develop positive employee responses for effective and successful
implementation of organisational change in Pakistan.
26
Figure 2.2 Employee Organisational and Career Commitment Factors
Career
Commitment
- Career Commitment - Job Satisfaction - Job Involvement - Supervisor & Peer Relations - Training and Skills Development - Social Relationships in the Workplace - Promotion
Demographic
Factors
Employee Readiness
- Gender - Age - Marital status - Employee Status - Education Level – No. of dependents - Years on Present Job
- Years Present employer
Organisational
Commitment
- Emotional Attachments - Feeling of Pride - Personal Sense of Obligation - Pay/Wages/ Rewards
27
2.3.2 Employee Resistance
During organisational change, employee is likely to have two responses: either
readiness or resistance. Readiness factors enhance employee willingness to embrace
change while resistance can be assumed as a passive response. Chawla and Kelloway
(2004, p-485) define resistance to change as “an adherence to any attitudes or
behaviours that thwart organisational change goals.” A passive response may be the
expression of the fear of loss of something valuable, a sense of loss of control caused by
fear of an unknown situation, and fear of failure in the new situation which is likely to
trigger the resistance to change (Tannenbaum and Hanna, 1985; Bridges, 1986; Jick,
1979; Dirks et al., 1996; Chreim, 2002).
In the literature employee resistance might be better viewed as comprising two
components such that attitudinal and behavioural responses to change. In attitudinal
resistance to change, an employee response depends on psychological rejection of
change on the basis of need, whereas behavioural resistance probably relates to
individual behaviours that reflect unwillingness to support the change or unwillingness
to stay with the organisation through this troubled time (lack of commitment to change)
(Chawla and Kelloway, 2004). According to Dent and Goldberg (1999) people do not
necessarily resist change, but instead resist the loss of status, pay, or comfort that may
be associated with it. The response manifesting itself as by anger or fear constitutes
resistance to change. According to Bove and Hede (2001) an organisation gets
resistance since the change process involves going from a known to an unknown
situation which makes individuals uncertain. Thus employee can develop different
thoughts, beliefs, and attitudes regarding the organisational change. Many researchers
have urged the importance of employee perceptions regarding organisational change
(Kotter, 1995; Armenaki et al., 1999; Holt et al., 2007; Elias, 2009). They argue that
most of the failures of change programmes are due to human factors which are directly
related to individual and workplace determinants. Through these factors, employee may
develop positive attitudes and behaviours that can indicate an employee satisfaction
with relation to the organisation (Martin et al., 2006).
28
2.4 Employee Readiness Studies in Organisational Change
Regardless of the need for and inevitable changes, organisation needs supportive
mechanisms to implement organisational changes. Over the past few decades,
considerable research has been conducted in the domain of change management
(Armenakis et al., 1993; Cunningham et al., 2002; Vokala et al., 2004; Chawla and
Kelloway, 2004; Peach et al., 2005; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006;
Holt et al., 2007; Erturk, 2008; Cinite et al., 2009). Many aspects of organisational
change have been observed and analysed by applying different theories, models,
conceptual and empirical studies. The literature advocates that employee readiness
factor has been found more effective and successful for implementation of
organisational change programmes (Eby et al., 2000; Armenakis and Harris, 2002;
Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006). Several
authors have concluded that organisational vitality depends upon employees who are
persistently pushed to implement organisational change (Armenakis et al., 1993; 1999;
Chawla and Kelloway, 2004; Jones et al., 2005; Cinite et al., 2009). However, in
literature employee has been found to be more complex and sensitive, thus, employee
perceptions, beliefs, and attitudes have been considered as a critical and imperative
factors in successful change programmes (Armenakis et al., 1993; Weber and Weber,
2001). In this regard change management experts and practitioners have often urged the
exploration of the different possible employee readiness factors in different combination
to minimise employee resistance (Hanpachern et al., 1998; Cunningham et al., 2002;
Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006; Erturk, 2008; Cinite et al., 2009).
A substantial amount of literature has been found in the domain of change management
which has mainly focused on various possible readiness predictors (Table 2.2). Many
theories, models, influencing strategies, and determinants have been determined to
focus on employee readiness perspectives. The literature describes employee readiness
predictors such that change efficacy, communications, job demands, job knowledge and
skills, logistic and system support, organisational commitment, participation, social
relations at workplace, job satisfaction, participation and many more factors prevail in
support of change programmes (Eby et al., 2000; Wanberg and Banas, 2000;
Cunningham et al., 2002; Chawla and Kelloway, 2004; Peach et al., 2005; Madsen et
al., 2005; Rafferty and Simon, 2006). Indeed, these factors have been positive
29
Table 2.2 Literature Review
Description
Author’s
Name (s)
& Years
Place Findings
Size and Structure in Complex Organisations
Mileti et al.
(1977) USA By applying Blau’s formal theory of
differentiation findings suggests altering and extending the explanatory scheme. Suggests establishing propositions may be unique to organisational type that may support several alternative propositions about organisational growth and change.
Creating Readiness for Organisational Change
Armenakis et
al. (1993)
USA
By combining the urgency and capability of organisation influence strategies, change agents play an effective role in change readiness.
Modelling Internal Organisational Change
Barnett and Carroll (1995)
USA
Process and content show the greatest potential for resolving the situation during organisational change. Models that comprise both are useful to solve the problem. Thus models can be used to test social science theories and evaluate the change programmes.
The View from the Top: Senior Executives’ Perceptions of Changing Management Practices in UK Companies
Ezzamel et
al. (1996)
UK
In UK corporate sector senior managers perceive rapid and continuous change. It is found that change is a question of degree not a radical break with past practices.
Building the People’s capacity for change
Wright and Thompsen (1997)
USA
The real force for change is employee readiness that can make possible successful organisational change.
Presenteeism, Power and Organisational Change: Long Hours as a Career Barrier and the Impact on the Working Lives of Women Managers
Simpson (1998)
UK
In male dominated organisations, restructuring leads to increased workloads and pressure of long working hours. Presenteeism also founded to be gendered. Being managed by women, it is seen as a form of ‘male resistance’ to their presence that may impose heavy costs on women.
Comparing Change Readiness, Quality Improvement, and Cost Management among Veterans Administration, For Profit, and Non-profit Hospitals
West (1998)
USA
Developed model and the matrix combination to offer a framework for managers to pursue organisational change and operational innovation within organisation.
Five symbolic roles of the external consultant: Integrating change, power and symbolism
Kaarst-Brown (1999)
During organisational change process power and politics have been accepted as often detrimental elements.
Changing the “whole system” in the public sector
White (2000) UK In organisations, change reforms show attempts to cope with a turbulent environment. This study explores the implication of process for changing the whole system for public sector organisations.
30
Perceptions of organisational readiness for change: Factors related to employees’ reactions to the implementation of team bases selling
Eby et al.
(2000) USA
Examined large-scale change where individual attitudes and preferences, work group and job attitudes, and contextual variables of employees found effective for readiness. Trust in management is not positively related with employee readiness for change.
Tools and Techniques to facilitate change
Bechtel and Squires (2001)
USA
Internal organisational development or training professionals can be done by change programme. It depends upon mindful planning with support of tools and techniques that can facilitate this. Key success depends upon thinking holistically and focusing on the critical success factor to understand all of the change implications.
Skill-Biased Organisational change? Evidence from a panel of British and French Establishments
Caroli and Reenen (2001)
France
Organisational change and skills are complementary. It reduces the demand for unskilled workers and is negatively associated with increases in regional skill price differentials. It also leads to greater productivity increases in establishments with larger initial skill endowments. Technical change is complementary as an independent role but not related to technological change.
Crafting a change message to create transformational readiness.
Armenakis and Harris (2002)
USA
Discrepancy, appropriateness, efficacy, principal support, and personal valence, strategy of message conveying, participation and persuasive communication create readiness for organisational change
Readiness for organisational change: A longitudinal study of workplace, psychological and behavioural correlates
Cunningham et al.(2002)
Canada
Employees achieve readiness with active jobs, an active job problem-solving style and job change self-efficacy factors. An active approach to job problem-solving with higher job change self-efficacy scores reported a higher readiness for change.
Managing Change and Changing managers from ABC to XYZ
Burnes (2003)
UK Organisational changes develop managerial development in parallel with benefits. Study emphasis that managerial development and change should run in parallel where managers should develop strategic strategies for success in competitiveness.
Wellness in the Workplace: Preparing Employees for change
Madsen (2003)
Canada
Employee’s performance is related with organisational performance. By improving the physical, emotional, spiritual, social, and intellectual wellness, organisational performance can be heightened.
The role of emotional intelligence and personality variables on attitudes toward
Vokala et al.
(2004) Greece Individual character is critical for success
of change. Relationship of individual emotions and personality trait found
31
organisational change
significant towards change.
Expanding Our Understanding of the Change Message
Bernerth (2004)
USA By applying theoretical foundation of Armenakis’ employee readiness model, researcher found that employee readiness factor is critical for success of organisational change process. Presented theoretical foundation of model including appropriateness, self-efficacy, principal support, discrepancy and personal valance.
Predicting openness and commitment to change
Chawla and Kelloway (2004)
Canada Results found that communication, trust, and job security is predicted on openness. Participation predicted trust directly or indirectly but predicted openness to change only indirectly. While turnover predicted negatively by openness and trust.
Achieving readiness for organisational change
Smith (2005)
Australia
Employees of the organisation are key factor for success or resistance in effective organisational change programmes.
The role of psychological climate in facilitating employee adjustment during organisational change
Martin et al.
(2005)
Australia
By applying theoretical model of employee study found that employee’s perceptions of the organisation and environment have positive results that appraise change favourably. Study suggests that a favourable environment reported better adjustment in terms of higher job satisfaction, psychological well-being and organisational commitment, and lower absenteeism and turnover intentions.
Status differences in employee adjustment during organisational change
Martin et al.
(2005)
Australia
Upper level staff reported more positive attitudes than clinical staff during change, across a range of indicators. Study found that managers who felt more in control of the situation appraised change as more stressful than non managers.
Beliefs Underlying Employee Readiness to Support A Building Relations
Peach et al.
(2005)
Australia
Significant differences found between employees with moderate compared to high intentions to engage in change supportive behaviours on a range of beliefs.
A Multilevel Approach to Individual Readiness to Change
Desplaces (2005)
UK
By applying theoretical and testable individual model explored both objective and subjective context of change which determine the employee readiness towards success of change.
Readiness for Organisational Change: Do Organisational Commitment and Social Relationships in the Workplace Make a Difference?
Madsen et
al. (2005)
Canada
By examining the data study found significant relationships between employee readiness, organisational commitment and social relationships at the workplace. Study further found relationships between readiness and
32
number of children, social relationships and gender and organisational commitment and employee age, educational level and gender.
Continuing professional development and workplace learning
Smith (2006) Australia In organisation, change is to be assumed imperative and constant factor.
Postscripts to change: survivors’ retrospective views of organisational changes
Chreim (2006)
Canada
Changing identify and enhancing the role of employees and organisation
Exploring the implications of vision, appropriateness, and execution of organisational change
Cole et al.
(2006)
USA
Study found to predict managers, job satisfaction, turnover intentions and role ambiguity by three-way interaction between change vision clarity change appropriateness, and change execution.
Readiness for change: Implementations on Employees’ Relationship with Management, Job Knowledge and Skills, and Job Demands
Miller et al.
(2006)
Canada
All three workplace factors have an influence on employees’ readiness for change. But employees’ relationship with their managers is the strongest predictor of readiness for change.
An examination of the antecedents of readiness for fine-tuning and corporate transformation changes
Rafferty and Simons (2006)
Australia
Employees have different approaches for different types of change. Results suggest that trust in peers and logistical and system support displayed for fine-tuning change, while, trust in senior leaders and self efficacy displayed strong positive relationships with readiness for corporate transformation changes. One important finding is that participation in change was not significantly concerned with readiness for corporate transformation changes
Readiness for Organisational Change: The Systematic Development of a Scale Utilizing the theory of planned behaviour to inform change management A trust-based approach to promote employees’ openness to organisational change in Turkey
Holt et al.
(2007) Jimmieson et
al. (2008)
Erturk (2008)
Canada Australia Turkey
Readiness for change is influenced by employees’ beliefs of self-efficacy, appropriateness, management support, and personal valence. Results found that employees’ attitudes, subjective norms, and perceived control were predicted to intention to carry out organisational change. Results indicated that trust in supervisors mediate the relationship between openness and managerial communications and partially mediated with openness and participation.
Measurement of Perceived Organisational Readiness for Change in the Public Sector
Cinite et al.
(2009) Canada Readiness for change can be obtained by
conceptualising three factors such that commitment of senior managers to the change, competence of change agents and the support of immediate managers.
33
implicated in reducing employee resistance and enhancing readiness. However,
literature emphasises the need to explore more employee readiness predictors with
different correlations (Armenakis et al., 1993; Hanpachern et al., 1998; Cunningham et
al., 2002; Bernerth, 2004; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simons, 2006; Cinite et al.,
2009).
Armenakis et al. (1993) argued in a conceptual research paper that the role of change
agents and management strategies in term of beliefs, attitudes and intentions of
employee reflected the urgency and employee readiness for necessary changes.
According to Armenakis and Harris (2002) there are five factors including discrepancy,
appropriateness, efficacy, principal support, and personal valence given by Armenakis
et al. (1999) that are helpful in creating readiness for organisation change. This paper
encourages researchers on change theoretically and as well as empirically to understand
the models and also by encouraging change agents to apply these five factors for change
readiness. By applying the theoretical foundation, Bernerth (2004) described the
components of the model set out by Armenakis et al. (1999) such as discrepancy,
appropriateness, efficacy, principal support, and personal valence can serve as a tool for
a successful organisational change programme. In addition, Bernerth (2004) described
that organisational leaders must be proactive to implement the change effective and
successfully and this can be possible through enhancing employee readiness.
Hanpachern et al. (1998) applied survey questionnaire to manufacturing company in the
USA. From 131 respondents, they found positive and significant relationships of
employee openness with employee margin in life factors such that job knowledge and
skills, social relations in the workplace, organisational culture, and management
leadership relationships and demographic variables. West (1998) measured
organisational performance in USA by developing three dimensions including change
readiness, quality improvement, and cost management. A developed model and a matrix
combined to offer a framework for managers to pursue organisational change and
operational innovation within an organisation. Results found that veteran administration
hospitals work differently than other organisations. This model presents an
organisational change process in hospitals.
34
Cunningham et al. (2002) examined the logistical and occupational risks of change,
ability to cope with change and to solve job-related problems, social support, and active
vs. passive job construct as they influence readiness for organisational change in
healthcare. By getting 654 completed surveys from Canadian teaching hospitals, they
found that workers who have an active approach to solving job problems with higher
job change self-efficacy are more ready for change. Active jobs that have higher
demands and greater decision latitude also tend to show more readiness for
organisational change.
An employee readiness can be achieved by improving physical, emotional, spiritual,
social, and intellectual wellness explored by Madsen (2003). She worked on the role of
employee wellness as it affects employee readiness to initiate, accept, and participate in
change. The research revealed that organisations can increase performance through
individual readiness for change, because individual performance is related with
organisational performance.
Madsen et al. (2005) found significant relationships between employee readiness,
organisational commitment and social relationships in the workplace in their Canadian
study. Results also described the relationships between readiness and the number of
children, social relationships and gender and organisational commitment and employee
age, educational level and gender.
Peach et al. (2005) worked on the theory of planned behaviour as a framework for
understanding employee readiness for change. This study identified the fundamental
beliefs which distinguish between those who intend and do not intend to perform the
behaviour under investigation. By using a survey questionnaire this research was
conducted among local government employees in Australia and consists of 149
participants to assess their behavioural, normative, and control beliefs regarding change.
Significant differences were found between employees with moderate compared to high
intentions to engage in change supportive behaviours on a range of beliefs.
By applying a theoretical and testable individual model, Desplaces (2005) examined
both the objective and subjective context of change which determines employee
readiness towards change. Antecedents relates with both context showing their
35
significance and relationship to understanding individual readiness during
organisational change. Results suggest that both objective and subjective context of
change determine the employee readiness for change.
Miller et al. (2006) focused on employee readiness for change by applying three
workplace factors such that management and leader relationships, job knowledge and
skills, and job demands. By applying a survey to four profit-oriented companies from
northern Utah, Canada, the researchers found that these workplace factors had a
significant influence on employee readiness for change. But employee relationship with
their managers was the strongest predictor of readiness for change.
Rafferty and Simons (2006) focused on the factors that create readiness for two types of
change like corporate transformation and fine-tuning in five Australian organisations.
Findings suggested that trust and self-efficacy play an important role in senior managers
for corporate transformation changes. While in fine-tuning trust in peers, and logistical
and system support antecedents showed a strong, positive relationship with readiness.
One important finding was that participation in change was not significantly concerned
with readiness for corporate transformation changes.
A study conducted by Holt et al. (2007) received 464 questionnaire surveys from full-
time employees in four public and private companies in two areas of northern Utah,
Canada. Researchers found that readiness for change was influenced by employee
beliefs of self-efficacy, appropriateness, management support, and personal valence.
Using structured questionnaires, 878 employees from a public sector organisation in
Turkey, Erturk (2008) found through structural equation modelling that trust in
supervisors mediates between managerial communication and openness to change and a
partial relation was found between participation and openness to change via trust in
supervisors.
Cinite et al. (2009) conducted a study recently in five Canadian public sector
organisations to measure perceived organisational readiness for change in the public
sector. Using structural equation modelling techniques, researchers found a perceived
readiness for change from three sub-constructs such that commitment of senior
36
managers to the change, competence of the change agent and support of the immediate
manager.
From the above literature review, it was found that mostly researchers focused on
employee readiness predictor variables for developing positive attitudes and behaviours
for organisational change. A large number of factors with different correlations have
been investigated (Table 2.2). The literature reveals that Madsen et al. (2005) were the
first to examine the predictors of employee commitment to the organisation and found
support for organisational change. It is important to note here that career commitment is
related to the employee attitudes and behaviours (Goulet and Singh, 2002). The research
has largely neglected the links between employee career commitment and employee
readiness for organisational change. By applying employee commitment to the
organisation and career factors, this study focused to examine employee attitudes and
behaviours for organisational change. According to the literature reviewed, this may be
first study in the domain of change management to examine employee career
commitment factors along with employee commitment to the organisation to understand
the employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours to readiness for organisational change.
In developing countries like Pakistan change methods adopted by western culture
should be used as a body of knowledge in the domestic situation (Fatima, 2002; Alvi
and Ahmed, 1988). Fatima (2002) further described in her paper relevant changes in
Pakistani organisations, emphasising that change agent need to demonstrate by both
reasons and emotions that the source of resistance of vested interest emanates from
strictly personal rather than professional or organisational reasons. Once the vested
interest is exposed by employee and organisation, it is easy to manage such feelings and
actions to realign their heads and hearts with the changed organisational requirement.
2.5 The Notion of Commitment
Commitment is defined as one’s motivation to work in a particular vocation or as an act
of commitment to trust or pledge to something or someone, (Hall, 1971; Merriam-
Webster, 1999). The concept of commitment has widely been used to find out
individual attitudes and behaviours in the workplace. Over the past three decades
commitment has been dominated in the literature as behaviour and used in terms of
careers, organisations, norms, identification, morals, work, jobs, and job involvement
37
(Reilly and Orsak, 1991). In organisation and social fields the term is recognised as a
predictor of much behaviour including absenteeism, turnover, job satisfaction,
employee readiness and organisational citizenship behaviour. From a behavioural aspect
the main focus is on employee turnover (Bartol, 1979; Blau and Boal, 1987; Huselid
and Day, 1991; Park and Kim, 2009), absenteeism (Gellatly, 1995; Sagie, 1998) and
organisational citizenship behaviour (Mathiew and Zajak, 1990; Schappe, 1998).
It is important to note that commitment and organisational change became antecedents
of each other thus further research in the area is warranted (Coleman et al., 1999;
Madsen et al., 2005). In organisational change, employee of an organisation can create
new sets of expectations to meet changing situations, attitudes and behaviours that are
outcomes of a process in which individual compare realities and expectations.
Employee commitment is attitudes and behaviours to the organisation because of
privileges like fringe benefits, salary, tenure, promotion, employee identity. On the
basis of these privileges employee integration increases and they become more loyal to
an organisation. Employee who receives encouragement and rewards for change are
more likely to act voluntarily in support of organisational change goals contributing to
overall organisational effectiveness (Organ, 1988; Van yperen et al., 1999). In the
academic literature of commitment, employee commitment to the organisation and
career commitment seem often to run in parallel.
2.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation
The important component of commitment is organisational commitment which has
multi dimensional approach may be interpreted in different ways. In the literature, the
term has been treated as a pattern of behaviours or attitudes towards an organisation
(Liou and Nyhan, 1994). It creates employee beliefs and willingness towards the goals
of organisation. It is widely accepted that the degree of organisational commitment and
job performance are positively related (Mowday et al., 1974), whereas tardiness,
absenteeism, and turnover (Steers, 1977; Hom et al., 1979) are inversely related.
According to Zangaro (2001) a person who is committed to an organisation should be
dedicated and have a strong belief in the organisation goal and values. Penley and
Gould (1988) focused on organisational commitment from two viewpoints, instrumental
38
and affective. The instrumental view is concerned with the system of compensation and
rewards received by an individual in return for that person’s accomplishment within an
organisation. The affective view relates to a person’s emotional attachment, feeling of
pride and personal sense of obligation to perform their duties within the organisation. It
can be developed by work experience such as job challenge, degree of autonomy, and a
variety of skills. These job characteristics have been found to be strongly and positively
associated to affective commitment among employees from a wide variety of
organisation (Dunham et al., 1994).
Moreover, employee and organisation have mutual interests based on certain needs,
desires, and expectations. Organisation provides an environment to employee related to
expectations and demands that induce employee to utilise their knowledge, skills and
experiences. This environment creates commitment to the organisation because the
employee needs can be fulfilled by the organisation. Most studies related to
commitment have been conducted in developed economies but few attempts have been
made in Pakistan (Alvi & Ahmed; 1987; Chang, 1999; Madsen et al., 2005). According
to Chang (1999); Goulet and Singh (2002), employee commitment is enhanced by
fulfilling the psychological and financial needs. This study focuses on employee in an
underprivileged and developing economy Pakistan, where individuals expect only the
satisfaction of their needs from their organisation. With the help of instrumental and
affective factors of organisational commitment, this study seeks to examine employee
commitment to the organisation towards employee readiness for organisational change.
According to Madsen et al. (2005), there is no direct study which links employee
organisational commitment and readiness for organisational change. However, some
studies have shown an indirect correlation. Such as Eby et al. (2000); Weber and Weber
(2001) worked on employee involvement in an organisation for readiness to
organisation change. While others (Good et al., 1996; Zangaro, 2001; Goulet and Singh,
2002) have also worked on career and organisational commitment with job satisfaction,
job involvement etc., which are linked in an indirect way with readiness.
39
2.5.2 Employee Career Commitment
A career is an evolving sequence of a person’s work experiences over time. It relates to
the individual’s perceived sequence of vocation, occupation or profession that person
occupies over time (Hall, 1976; Solomon et al., 1986). An individual’s attitude towards
his or her career is described as career commitment (Chang, 1999). It is recognised as a
form of work commitment (Morrow, 1993). The conceptual definition of career
commitment is one’s attitude towards one’s vocation or profession (Blau, 1985). It can
be characterised by the development of personal career goals and the individual’s
attachment to, identification with and involvement in those goals (Colarelli and Bishop,
1990).
Individuals with a strong degree of career commitment may show higher levels of
expectations and requirements from the organisation with which they have forged
relationships. It also implies that highly career committed individuals may be more
motivated when their expectations are satisfied by the organisation than those who are
less committed. Career commitment seems to be an important factor for career
progression and development that is relevant to practical concerns of individual and
organisation to excel in their occupations or jobs. Moreover, career commitment
involves self generated goals and commitment to one’s own career which is influenced
by number of factors such as personal, behavioural and environmental decisions
(London, 1983). If an employee commits to a career she or he would pursue career
goals in spite of obstacles and setbacks otherwise, they make a career change rather than
persevere in achieving career objectives (Colarelli and Bishop, 1990).
Indeed, a career involves trade offs between security and risk and between individual
success and family, and peoples’ career behaviour may interact with culture. The
literature shows that employee attachment, identification and involvement depend upon
extrinsic and intrinsic outcomes such as pay, promotion, appraisal, and satisfaction that
can refer to one’s motivation to work in a chosen vocation (Hall, 1971). According to
Poon (2004) career commitment is predicated on objective career success in form of
salary level and subjective career success in the form of career satisfaction. Most of the
research has focused on individual factors that influence career commitment such as job
involvement and organisational commitment (Blau, 1985; McGinnis and Morrow,
40
1990); situational factors (organisational uncertainty, fear of job loss and job fit) used
by Goulet and Singh (2002) along with organisational commitment, job satisfaction and
involvement because the economic and organisational situation (downsizing and
restructuring) may have an impact on career commitment (Morrow, 1990; Hall and
Associates, 1986). Thus career commitment is reflected by individual and situational
factors which affect career motivation or construct behaviour (London, 1983). These
two factors examined by Goulet and Singh (2002) consist of job involvement,
organisational commitment, need for achievement, work ethic and job satisfaction for
the individual and fear of losing the job and job fit as the situational factor.
After reviewing the literature, it was found that no research has been found which
relates to employee career commitment and employee readiness for organisational
change (refer section 2.4). Although, career commitment is related with individual’s
attitudes and behaviours towards his or her career, thus it was proposed that employee
may be developed their positive attitudes and behaviours on the basis of commitment to
the organisation as well as career. Thus, this study focused on employee career
commitment to career predictors such that job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisors
and peers relations, training and skills development, and promotion factors to examine
employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change.
2.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace
Employee, who receive encouragement and rewards for change, are more likely to act
voluntarily in support of organisational change goals contributing to overall
organisational effectiveness (Organ, 1988; Van yperen et al., 1999). Such
encouragement and rewards are directly or indirectly related to employee commitment
to the organisation or career. Though, previous discussion focuses on employee
commitment to the organisation and career to readiness for organisational change while
it is believed that social relationships in the workplace also focuses on employee
feelings, attitudes, and perceptions. In organisation, employee interacts with colleagues
in the form of subordinates, peers or supervisors but feelings, attitudes and perceptions
may be positive or negative. Hanpachern et al. (1998) and Madsen et al. (2005) focused
on social relationships with employee readiness for change and found a significant
correlation between them. This study also focuses on employee likes and dislikes and
41
enjoyment related to talking, interacting and working in social relationships factor.
According to the literature there is no relevant study except (Hanpachern et al., 1998;
Madsen et al., 2005) while many authors have reported indirectly like Eby et al. (2000);
Weber and Weber (2001); Cunningham et al. (2002).
2.7 Gap in the Research
This review of the literature reveals several directions for further research in the field of
change management. First there has been long debate over the impact of organisational
change on employee. Some authors such that Cunningham et al. (2002); Madsen et al.
(2005); Miller et al. (2006); Holt et al. (2007) suggest that employee attitudes and
behaviours can be developed by organisational factors and others argue that individual
factors are more essential for that (Wanberg and Banas, 2000; Eby 2000; Lehman et
al., 2002; Peach et al., 2005; Elias, 2009). However, these issues are important and
require extensive study because these factors provide support in developing employee
attitudes and behaviours.
A number of researchers Hanpachern et al. (1998); Eby et al. (2000); Madsen et al.
(2005); Rafferty and Simons (2006); and Elias (2009), have investigated the relative
influence of employee readiness predictors to develop attitudes, beliefs and behaviours
to organisational change. Although it is true that researchers have worked on micro
level issues in change management, there is still a need to learn more. This study
examines employee readiness determinants for organisational change to support and
strengthen the existing literature.
Most studies on employee readiness for organisational change have focused individual,
psychological, workplace, environmental, cultural and social factors. An important
aspect of this is that commitment and organisational change became antecedents of each
other thus further research in the area is warranted (Coleman et al., 1999; Madsen et al.,
2005). A study on employee commitment to the organisation along with social
relationships in the workplace was conducted for the first time by Madsen et al. (2005).
The research has largely neglected the link between employee career commitment and
employee readiness for organisational change. This study seeks to fill this void and to
examine the employee commitment to the organisation and career predictor for change
42
readiness.
Most research work has been done in developed or western cultural work settings. Less
research work has been found so far in developing countries like Pakistan. This requires
more attention by researchers and practitioners to establish employee readiness
predictors in different work settings environments and cultures. In Pakistan, change
methods adopted by western cultures should be used as a body of knowledge in the
domestic situation (Fatima, 2002). In this study the variables have been chosen to justify
the study in an underprivileged and developing economy where employee expects only
the satisfaction of their basic needs from their organisations. According to Alvi and
Ahmed (1987) and Chang, 1999, employee commitment is enhanced by fulfilling the
psychological and financial needs along with others in Pakistan. Attempts to fill this gap
are considered vital as it helps researchers to understand employee attitudes, beliefs and
behaviours in a less affluent country which may help to generalise the studies for all.
Further, although most studies have been conducted in different organisations like
health, financial, manufacturing and service oriented, there is a need to know employee
attitudes, beliefs and behaviours in educational institutions. This study examines
employee readiness determinants in public higher education institutions of Pakistan.
2.8 Conclusion
Through general competition, instability, mergers, expansion, technology and other
internal or external reasons, today organisations have to change strategies, structure,
policies, approaches, procedures, products or management to deal with this situation.
Change might be small or large, quantum or incremental but requires proper attention.
Its consequences can affect the organisation’s performance, development, reputation
and survival as well as wasting managerial energy and organisational expenditure and
costs. The literature reveals that change today is more complex and rapid than ever
before, thus it needs more timely and appropriate attention. The literature in the change
management domain has concluded that the employee readiness factor is the most
important for effective and successful implementation of organisational change.
Although employee has different characteristics, motivational approaches, knowledge,
values and behaviours, however, their reaction depends upon his or her attitudes, beliefs
43
and intentions. Employee readiness depends upon their proximal perception that can
vary according to different experiences, internal and external environmental factors,
knowledge, and future expectations as well. The literature available on employee
readiness factors has been classified into two categories such that individual and
workplace. Individual factors are related to personal, psychological and social aspects
having a positive influence on employee for reducing the uncertainties of change
programmes. In fact, employee can develop their expectations and assumptions on the
basis of workplace environments. In workplace factors researchers have included the
organisational environment, culture, and facilities factors. By examining these factors in
different combinations, researchers have found significant results during the
implementation of change programmes. The majority of published research work has
been conducted in developed countries such that Australia, Canada, UK, and USA
where organisational culture, environment and employee behavioural approaches are
different than in less developing country such that Pakistan. To the knowledge of this
researcher, there are hardly any studies which have been conducted in Pakistan focusing
on employee commitment to the organisation and career predictors along with social
relationships in the workplace for change readiness. Therefore, there is a need for such a
study.
The researcher therefore intended to examine employee commitment to the organisation
and career factors which are related to employee attitudes and behaviours for
organisational change. The literature suggests that if employees are satisfied with their
organisation or career they may change their attitudes and behaviours during
implementation of organisation change programmes. A few researchers have examined
organisational commitment as an employee readiness predictor and found positive
results. Nevertheless, the career commitment factor, which is one of the most important
factors in individual attitudes and behaviours, has not been investigated so far in
relation to employee readiness. In addition, some other factors like social relationships
in the workplace and demographic variables can also be significant in a particular
culture and environment. Thus, this study was developed to examine employee attitudes
and behaviours for organisational change in public sector higher educational institutions
of Pakistan. The justification of this research is that government of Pakistan has been
introduced reforms in public sector universities. The next chapter is related to the study
settings.
44
Chapter Three Setting of the Study
3.1 Introduction
The study was conducted in Pakistan where new reforms have been announced by the
government for public sector higher educational institutions. A brief description of the
setting of the study is provided. Consequently this chapter describes the structure of the
national education system, the national system of higher education, the academic
hierarchy, the challenges for higher education, the reforms in the higher education
sector, and finally concludes with a description of career culture.
3.2 Pakistan: General Background
Pakistan became independent on 14th August, 1947. It is located in the region of South
Asia bordering the Arabian Sea, between India on the East and Iran and Afghanistan on
the West and China in the North. The country is one of the most densely populated
countries, comprising 162 million people, making it the world’s sixth most populous
country and second most populous in the South Asia region (World Bank, 2006).
According to Sawahel (2009), Pakistan has a high proportion of young people, about
eighty five million below the age of 19, or 54% of the total population. Pakistan is
divided into four provinces. These are Punjab, Sindh, North West Frontier Province
(NWFP), and Baluchistan. The country consists of four territories namely as Islamabad
capital territory, Azad Jammu and Kashmir (AJK), Federal Administered Northern
Areas (FANA) and Federally Administered Tribal Areas (FATA) (World Bank, 2006).
Its gross national income (GNI) per capita is US$2700 in 2008, which places it at the
156th rank in the world (World Bank, 2009).
In Pakistan, there are no consistent links between overall human developments, wealth,
gender, or education (Oxfam, 2006). Politics, culture, society and governmental
structures affect the development of country and especially the education system. In the
21st century, with the emergence of globalisation and increasing global competition,
education is an important factor that plays a leading role in human development, and is
becoming one of the defining enterprises. In the fast changing and competitive world,
education and technology are the important factors for respectable survival and the
progress of Pakistan (Shami and Hussain, 2005). According to Memon (2007, p-47), the
45
functions of the educational institutions are to develop the people physically, mentally,
psychologically, socially and spiritually. However, the education sector in the Pakistan
suffers from insufficient financial input, low levels of efficiency for implementation of
programmes, and poor quality of management, monitoring, supervision and teaching.
As a result, Pakistan has one of the lowest rates of literacy in the world, and the lowest
among countries of comparative resources and social or economic situations (Memon,
2007). Thus, the government of Pakistan initiated to make reforms in the sector of
education for the benefit of social development and reducing poverty in the society.
3.3 Structure of the National Education System
Because of changes in technology, labour market patterns and general global
environment today, education is a basic need of society and is considered as a very
important investment in human and economic development (National Education Policy,
2009). Education is considered as a technological, scientific and social improvement of
a country but it depends upon the quality of education (Mohanthy, 2000; Haider, 2008).
Thus, today education has been given importance and priority in Pakistan.
Both public and private sector institutions in Pakistan are source of education, and
public sector is the major source. In public sector institutions, the educational system is
highly centralised and it is a statutory requirement for all to follow a national
curriculum. The education system has been divided into three levels (Table 3.1)
including elementary education, secondary education and tertiary education (Shami and
Hussain, 2005). In elementary education both primary and middle educations have been
considered. Primary education is provided by primary schools over five years and
middle stage education is provided at the age of 10 years of children for three years.
After elementary education, the next stage is secondary education which consist on two
stage such that secondary and higher secondary. Secondary stage of education is
provided by secondary schools. It covers two years from 14-15 year old cohort of
children. There is a Secondary Schools Certificate (SSC) examination at the end of the
tenth class and is conducted by the Boards of Intermediate and Secondary Education
through out the country (Shami and Hussain, 2005, p-2). After passing secondary stage
of education, a student can be enrolled for higher secondary education which is
provided by colleges or higher secondary schools.
46
Table 3.1 Structure of National Education System
Level/Stage Class Duration Age on Entry
1.Elementary
Primary I-V 5 years 5 years
Middle VI-VIII 3 years 10 years
2. Secondary
Secondary IX-X 2 years 13 years
Higher Secondary XI-XII 2 years 15 years
3. Tertiary
Undergraduate XII-XIV 2 years 17 years
Postgraduate XV-XVI 2 years 19 years
Source: Adopted from Shami and Hussain, (2005, p-3)
The students follow a two year programme of study at higher secondary level, which
leads to the higher secondary school certificate (HSSC) and is a pre requisite for
entrance to university or an institution of higher education (Shami and Hussain, 2005).
After this education a student can either join professional university or institution that is
agriculture, engineering, medical or general universities. There are a few colleges that
provide higher education but are affiliated with some universities, or that the
government has authorised to grant degree of higher education. Universities in Pakistan
offer undergraduate, graduate and postgraduate programmes of studies in general and
professional education. Before higher education commission reforms (refer section 3.7)
honours bachelor degree was considered for three years but now it extends to four year
programmes. The master degree programmes in arts and science are of two years if
student passed bachelor of two year from college side. However if student passed
honours degree of four year, this is now counted as equal to a masters degree. The
minimum degree of Master of Philosophy or Master of Science (M. Phil or MS) is two
years but if student passed four year honours degree then M. Phil or MS is of one year.
The doctor of philosophy (PhD) degree is offered by research as well as by the course
work with research for three years.
47
3.3.1 National System of Higher Education
Higher education has always been an important component and is recognised as a
dominant factor for economic, capital and social investment of a country (Barnet, 1990).
In the emerging knowledge economy, higher education is a great source of any country
development. Society needs higher education for its development because the world has
been transformed into knowledge economies which are known as the engine for socio-
economic development because important natural resources have greatly diminished.
Considering the entire issue of development in a holistic manner, it thus becomes
apparent that “Higher Education” serves as the engine of change that not only impacts
economic development, but also serves to strengthen the entire system of education
(MTDF2005-10, 2005, p-1).
The education sector in Pakistan has been divided into three levels (primary, secondary
and tertiary) (refer section 3.3). Tertiary education is imparted mostly by universities or
colleges which are affiliated with any university or government given special status to
issue degrees. Tertiary education is known as a higher education which has been divided
into sector wise such that engineering, medical, agriculture and general including arts,
natural science, social science, commerce, business, law, pharmacy, computer and
information system. Both public and private sectors are involved to provide higher
education under the supervision of higher education commission of Pakistan. However,
public sector is more dominant sector to provide education and majority of the student
are attending the public institutions. According to higher education commission’s
statistical booklet on higher education Pakistan, at present 10,471 full time faculty
members are working in sixty eight public sector universities of Pakistan (HEC, no date
a).
In Pakistan higher education institutions offer undergraduate, graduate and postgraduate
programmes of studies in general and professional education. Engineering universities
offer bachelor of engineering (B.E), master of engineering (M.E), master of philosophy
(M. Phil) and doctor of philosophy (PhD) degrees. In medical universities, they offer
bachelor of medicine and bachelor of surgery (MBBS) degrees. Agriculture universities
provide engineering, bachelor and master degrees in agriculture sector. However, in
general universities, many programmes (Bachelor, Masters, M. Phil and PhD) are
48
offered in many fields such as arts, natural science, social science, commerce, business,
law, pharmacy, computer and information system. The basic requirement for getting
admission for higher educational institution is twelve year education (Five years of
primary, three years of middle, two years of secondary and two years of higher
secondary education) (Shami and Hussain, 2005).
3.4 The Academic Hierarchy
In Pakistan, the source of higher education is both public and private sector universities
however, public sector is known as major source of higher education. These universities
are controlled by ministry of education, ministry of health, ministry of sciences and
technology and higher education commission of Pakistan (Previously known as
university grants commission). However, the governance and managerial hierarchy of
the public sector universities is a legacy of the colonial past where the structures and
positions are modelled on public sector British universities basis. In public sector
universities, two parallel hierarchies’ (administrative and academic) are working in the
structure. In the administrative hierarchy, Chancellor is followed by a Vice Chancellor
(known as Chief Executive Officer), Registrar, Treasurer, Provost, and Controller of
Examination. In addition to administrative hierarchy, universities have academic
hierarchy like Chancellor, Vice Chancellor, Pro Vice Chancellor, Deans, Head of
Departments or Institutions, and Teachers (Figure 3.1).
49
Figure 3.1 Academic Hierarchy of Public Sector Universities
Chancellor
↓
Vice Chancellor
↓
Pro Vice Chancellor
↓
Deans
↓
Head of Departments/Institutions
↓
Teachers
In public sector universities Chancellors are head of state or provinces. If universities
are in federal territory, the head of state (President) is Chancellor of those universities.
Like that in province, Governors are the Chancellors of the respective provinces
universities. In this system, the chancellor can appoint any person as a vice Chancellor
on the recommendation of body consisted on three persons for four years tenure. In
Public Sector University, Vice Chancellor position is responsible for looking after the
administrative as well as academic matters of the university. In academic hierarchy, the
Dean who is responsible purely academic is the authority to look after their faculties.
His or her selection criteria is from the most three senior professors in the faculty for
three years. Deans are followed by head of departments or institutions of faculty known
as academic head of their respective departments or institutions. Selection of the head is
on the basis of most three seniors from the departments or institutions for three years.
3.5 Challenges for Higher Education
Today, people of Pakistan are facing multidimensional problems such that cultural,
political, ethnicity, population, religious, financial, and terrorism as a general and higher
education as a particular. These problems may be population explosion, lack of
resources, less participation of private sector, scarcity of qualified man power,
inconsistency in the policies of various regimes, political instability, inefficient
50
educational management system, wastage of resources, and poor implementation of
policies and programmes (Hays, 1987; Sharif et al., 2007). According to Mughal and
Manzoor (1999), in higher education so many factors such as institutions, students’
mobility, qualified teachers availability, globalisation of economy have direct impact on
the higher education. Despite all these issues, the Pakistani government is striving to
improve the higher education in relation to the development of knowledge economy.
Thus, the purpose of higher education is not only to provide knowledge but have deeper
meaning and objectives. In this context people of Pakistan are striving to pursue higher
education in order to help the country to compete with any other nation of the world.
After rising to power in 1999, General Pervez Musharraf (military ruler of the country)
started a series of reforms especially in the higher education sector. This corresponded
with broader international support from development and donor communities for
investment in higher education (Osama et al., 2009). Thus, in 2001, the Government of
Pakistan (GoP) initiated a process of reforms in the higher education sector and formed
a task force to analyse the current condition of their education sector and to recommend
necessary changes. The task force was consisted on different group of people. Two
persons were as its co chairmen including one businessman cum educationist who is
running a successful private university and the second was the president of a leading
private medical university in the country. In addition, fifteen members were vice
chancellors of different universities of the country. Seven vice chancellors were from
public sector universities, among which only three were PhD. The rest of members were
retired army officers who were appointed as a vice chancellor of different universities.
Other than these, bureaucrats and few teachers from private sector universities were
included. Thus the task force was the composition of different groups including
educationists, retired army officers and bureaucrats who are suppose to be having an
efficient and effective knowledge and expertise in the field. (Obaid, 2006)
In fact, objectives assigned to the task force were, “to review higher education in
Pakistan and recommend ways of improving qualities” (Government of Pakistan, 2002).
The task force made some surprising discoveries like only 2.6% of 17-23 year olds were
enrolled in an institution of higher education in Pakistan compared with 6.2% in India,
12.7% in Iran and 68% in South Korea. The task force identified one challenge which is
chronic underfunding of higher education. The total public funding of 41 public sector
51
universities was a meagre Rs3.9 billion per annum (US$55 million in 2001). This
amounted to a mere 0.1% of the country’s gross domestic product (GDP) (World Bank,
2006). The national allocation for university research was only Rs40 million (Osama et
al., 2009). Apart from this issue, other issues discovered by the task force were a lack of
political will for the role education, ineffective governance systems, political
interference in university administration, weak institutional leadership and, at the
university level, a lack of performance culture and accountability (Osama et al., 2009).
Government of Pakistan recognise the current problems of higher education in Pakistan.
After the recommendations of the task force, the higher education commission
recognised the following fundamental problems facing higher education in Pakistan
(MTDF2005-10, 2005, p-iii).
a. Access – At present only 2.9% of our students aged between 18 and 23 years
have access to higher education.
b. Quality - The present quality of higher education is very low. Not a single
university of Pakistan is ranked among the top 500 in the world. According to
Clark (2005, p-56), the main cause of this deplorable state of higher education is
seen as insufficient education and training of faculty. Of 7000 faculty member,
only about 25 percent, or 1700 in all of Pakistan, have PhDs. This is very low
for a country of 160 million people.
c. Infrastructure – Each public sector university will need its departments to be
upgraded in terms of availability of books, journal, scientific equipment,
consumables, teaching aids and high speed internet connectivity as well as
sports and other facilities to provide the requisite environment for quality
education.
In addition to these challenges, higher education sector itself identified the following
issues in its policy document Medium Term Development Framework (MTDF)2005-10
(2005, P-6): -
i. Poor standard of faculty and lack of training/capacity building.
ii. Low enrolment in higher education
52
iii. Minimal relevance of higher education to national needs and lack of
compatibility to international standards
iv. Low quality of research and lack of relevance to national requirement
v. Poor governance of Universities
3.6 The Reforms in the Higher Education Sector
Education is being considered a key to change and progress because of closed link with
development (Memon, 2007). It increases the economic, social and political adjustment
of the individual in the society and assists harmonious development to raise productivity
and efficiency of the individual. Like other developing countries, the situation of the
higher education sector in Pakistan is not very encouraging and human aspect of
development has not been given due consideration in the past. Thus, it demands special
attention in order to improve higher education for developing nation.
The higher education system is currently undergoing major changes in Pakistan
(Siddiqui, 2006). Government of Pakistan has planned to improve higher education at
the centre of the economic planning and this is expected to provide greater opportunities
and choices to improve the individual’s lives (Shami and Hussain, 2005). In the
emerging knowledge economy, nations that fail at creating a decent learning
environment will lag behind, and may end up becoming virtual colonies of those that do
succeed in this regard (Shami and Hussain, 2005). All over the world universities are
guiding and cooperating with industrial and agricultural development organisation and
they are developing their economics rapidly and meaningfully (Memon, 2007, p-47).
In Pakistan, higher educational system is narrow, uneven, and fragile, where low access,
large disparities, poor quality, and weak performance are evident. According to World
Bank Report (2006), Pakistan is lagging in the education sector from those countries
that has similar levels of development. It is only in the early 2000s that the powerful
potential of a healthy higher education subsector began to be recognised by the highest
authority (World Bank, 2006, p-5). However, Pakistan has a long history of reforms but
mostly they failed. According to a draft prepared by The Boston Group, (2002, p-15),
besides a spew of repeated constitutional reforms and constitution making (as evidenced
53
by two quasi-constitutions in 1948 and 1985, three full fledged constitutions in 1956,
1962, and 1973, and four supra-constitutional frameworks introduced by military rulers
in 1958, 1969, 1977, and 1999), the country has witnessed repeated attempts to
introduce agricultural and land reforms (1953, 1958, 1969,1972) administrative reforms
(1959, 1973), local government reforms (1962, 2000), industrial reforms (1972),
financial sector reforms (1972), and many others.
Recognising the above problems and challenges facing higher education in Pakistan,
higher education commission (HEC) has set out a strategic plan to improve the state of
higher education in the country. According to MTDE2005-10 (2005) core strategic aims
are:
a. Faculty Development
b. Improving Access
c. Promoting Excellence in Learning and Research
d. Relevance to the Economy and Development
The aim of the first plan is to improve the quality of teaching and research through the
teaching skills and academic qualification of faculty members. A series of
recommendation has been given by the task force including calling for a huge jump in
public funding for universities from Rs3.9 billion in 2001- 02 to Rs21.7 billion in 2005-
06 (World Bank, 2006), which is unprecedented in the country’s history. Special
attention has been given in areas of scholarships, fellowships, and teachers’ promotion.
In this connection the HEC launched programmes for human resources development,
research, and physical infrastructure. Human resources took the lion’s share with 5,000
new PhDs at local universities over five years and more than 2000 foreign PhD
scholarships has been sponsored to study abroad. Based on the task force
recommendations, the Ministry of Education enacted the University Model Act. This act
proposed radical changes in different areas of the universities including changes to the
University Grants Commission (UGC), the Senate and the Syndicate. The act also
proposed changes to working conditions of teachers and functional responsibilities of
various administrative positions. According to Sawahel (2009) the then Federal Minister
54
of Education said “The reform process has included a number of innovative steps for
promoting human resource development and enhancing capacity building with the aim
to establish a world class faculty, expand access and improve the quality and relevance
of higher education and research to economic growth and sustainable development”.
According to Osama et al. (2009), the success of reforms must not be measured by the
number of grants made or PhDs awarded, rather it should be judged on whether it is
creating a culture of research driven not by financial incentives, and by a genuine desire
to create new knowledge and to enable the broader society to reap the benefits. So far
the impetus claims have caused a 400% increase in the number of papers published in
international journals by Pakistani universities (Osama et al., 2009). It also takes credit
for the appearance of three Pakistani universities among a popular top six hundred chart
of world universities with Pakistan a rising star in five fields of science and engineering
and external endorsements by evaluation teams the British Councils (BC), the World
Bank and USAID (Osama et al., 2009). In the past five years, forty seven new
universities and degree awarding institutions have been established, almost tripling the
enrolments, while fifty six universities were linked with fibre optic and international
research networks (Sawahel, 2009). However, these reforms faced a lot of opposition
from various stakeholders particularly from the public sector university teachers
(Sawahel, 2009 and Osama et al., 2009). From financial incentives, faculty members
criticised the deep divisions between winners and losers in a two tier salary structure
(Osama et al., 2009). Despite this resistance, the HEC seems to have changed the
culture of Pakistani academia considerably over the past five years (USAID, 2008).
3.7 Conclusion
This chapter attempted to review the context of study. The main body of this chapter
focuses on back ground of the country such that Pakistan where this research conducted,
structure of national education system, national system of higher education, the
academic hierarchy, challenges for higher education, and reforms in the higher
education sector. The country has given importance to higher education and recognised
it as a dominant factor for economic and social development. In Pakistan, both public
and private sector institutions are involved but public sector is known as the major
source of education. However, public sector institutions are highly centralised and it is
55
statutory requirement for all to follow a national curriculum. Due to a lower
performance of public sector higher educational institutions, the government initiated a
process of reforms and recognised the recommendations of a task force in respect of
faculty development, improving access, promoting excellence in learning and research,
relevance to the economy and development of task force. However, these reforms faced
a lot of opposition from various stake holders particularly from the public sector
university teachers. Despite the resistance, the government intends to further change the
culture of Pakistani academia considerably.
56
Chapter Four Conceptual Framework
4.1 Introduction
This research examines employee readiness determinant to build up employee positive
beliefs, intentions, behaviours, attitudes, and expectations during organisational change.
In literature review chapter researcher proposes that employee can be developed
positive attitudes and behaviours on the basis of their commitment to the organisation
and career along with social relationships in the workplace factors. The conceptual
approach for this research study is based on a broad theoretical framework and the study
examines employee readiness predictors for organisational change in public sector
higher educational institution of Pakistan.
Regardless of the need for and inevitable change in organisations, predictors can be
used as a support and source for management in developing policies, strategies and
planning before implementing successful organisational change programmes. In the
change management domain, various determinants of employee readiness have already
been explored to infer for effective implementation of change programmes in different
ways, different times and at different places (Chapter Two Literature Review Table
2.2). This study focuses on employee psychological and financial predictors of
commitment which were found in literature to help in developing employee attitudes
beliefs, and behaviours particularly in Pakistan.
The purpose of this chapter is to develop research hypotheses to examine the employee
readiness determinants for organisational change. To address the hypotheses effectively,
the researcher reviews and integrate subject areas such that organisational change and
its impact on an individual employee, conceptual approach, theoretical frameworks,
employees’ commitment to their organisation and career, social relationships in the
workplace and demography. This will clarify the research area and development of a
conceptual approach and a theoretical framework for this study.
57
4.2 Organisational Change and its Impacts on Employee
Change in organisation is quite inevitable due to tremendous internal and external
environmental pressures. These challenges or pressures can direct an organisation to
apply ‘therapy’ in the form of alterations, modifications or variations to its structures,
policies, strategies, approaches, or culture. Change in an organisation is, in fact, an
adaptation of new ideas or behaviours that can be defined in many ways like
transformation of an organisation between two points in time (Barnett and Carroll,
1995) or planned or unplanned transformation in the structure, technology and people of
an organisation (Greenberg and Baron, 2002). However, its impact on an organisation
and its business might be positive or negative. Thus, it is necessary to act according to
the situation created by any external or internal organisational forces to promote
business as well as ensure future survival. By taking such action, organisations must
create a difference such that they can compare between the two different times.
During organisational change, employee is the most acutely affected element. Apart
from other components, employee might be given the wrong impression or are unclear
because of diverting from a known to an unknown situation during organisational
change. Being a major resource of an organisation, employee can play a central and
active role in change activities which may be planned or unplanned. The reaction of
employee may be developed according to his or her perceptions which are supported by
his or her skills, experiences, opportunities, benefits, and commitment. Looking at the
reality, change in organisation seems to be largely an essential, exciting, critical and
complex activity because it often occurs more rapidly, in greater volume, and is more
complex than ever before (Bennett, 2001). Thus, developing employee cognition levels
or reducing employee resistance is a critical issue in the change management domain.
Being mere humans, they might become uneasy, disbelieving and stressed. Indeed the
employee’s position in this situation becomes more fragile and they have to decide a
future line of action in order to either support or resist the change.
To overcome the employee anxiety regarding change programmes, management and
change agents focus on foreseen challenges faced by employee during implementation
of organisational change. Academic researchers and organisational practitioners have
extensively advocated employee readiness predictors as an imperative source for
58
controlling the situation properly (Armenakis et al., 1993, Bernerth, 2004; Holt et al.,
2007; Cinite et al., 2009). According to the literature employee readiness factors have a
significant impact in preparing them mentally and physically for immediate action
(Madsen, 2003). By applying readiness predictors, before announcing change
programmes, management can develop employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours that
can support the organisation in formulating supportive policies and strategies to stop
resistance by employees (Bernerth, 2004; Miller et al., 2006). Thus, employee readiness
factors have been empirically found effective and useful in relation to preparing
employees for organisational change in general (Eby et al., 2000; Cunningham et al.,
2002; Rafferty and Simons, 2006).
In the change management domain, the term employee readiness is defined as an
employee’s beliefs, thoughts, and behaviours to accept the needs and capability of an
organisation. It is known as a cognitive precursor to behaviours of either resistance or
support (Armenakis et al., 1993). In fact, employee’s cognitive precursor to behaviours
usually reveals his or her attitudes, beliefs, and intentions towards organisational
change. Simultaneously, readiness is similar to Lewin’s (1951) concept of unfreezing,
reflecting an employee’s beliefs, attitudes, and intentions regarding the extent to which
changes are needed and the organisation’s capacity to successfully make these changes.
Whatever the reason, quantity or speed of what is to be changed the most significant
concern among experts is how to deal with the uncertainty created during or after
implementing organisational change programmes. Various theories, models and
predictors have been applied by researchers to control the situation and reduce
employee resistance (Armenakis et al., 1993; Desplaces, 2005; Rafferty and Simons,
2006). In this regard, researchers and practitioners have focused on employee readiness
predictors to develop employee positive feelings and attitudes. And now, more
readiness predictors in different correlations are being demanded to increase the
effectiveness of change programmes (Madsen et al., 2005).
59
4.3 Conceptual Approach
Organisational change has been considered a vague and unknown situation which may
develop uncertainty and anxiety among employees (Armenakis et al., 19993; Ilgen and
Pulakos, 1999). Employee can be affected by a range of different factors like individual
life experiences, socio-demographic characteristics, knowledge and skills, attitudes,
values, and behavioural patterns. In addition, employee can be affected by internal and
external factors as well as social factors. Thus, employee can develop different feelings,
thoughts, beliefs, behaviours and attitudes towards organisational change on the basis
the level of organisational support and their own perceptions. In this regard, change
management agents and academic researchers are concerned with how to deal with
employee so that they can actively accept and become involved in the organisational
change. Researchers like Tetenbaum (1998); Cunningham et al. (2002) emphasised that
organisations must consider employee readiness predictors in change management
before developing policies and strategies to cope with the situation.
In any given organisation where change is to be implemented, employee could be
mislead and unclear about the change. An employee’s response may be either active or
passive but can be critical and serious for the management. In active behaviour,
employees commonly become positive to organisational change because they perceive
new opportunities for development and progression. On the other hand, passive
behaviour relates with those employees who become reluctant to the organisational
change as they view the change as an uncertain situation and source of stress. This
perception indicates unsuccessful change efforts by the organisation and may lead to
decreased morale and productivity and increased turnover or subsequent organisational
failures.
A passive reaction to the change can create tension among employees, who may have to
undergo painful unlearning and relearning processes (Schein, 1996). Therefore,
organisation needs to formulate policies or strategies on the basis of facts in both
planned and unplanned organisational change. In this way, management can develop
positive perception levels among employees before introducing the organisational
change. However, it could be simpler when the management knows the employee
readiness predictors (Eby et al., 2000; Desplaces, 2005; Madsen et al., 2005) which can
60
be the foundation of such policies or strategies. Thus, researchers and experts have
largely concentrated on employee readiness predictors in different correlations to
develop employee active response. By applying this nomenclature, management can
understand employee thoughts, beliefs, and intentions before or during implementation
of change and focus on preparing employee mentally and physically for inevitable
changes.
In this regard, this study focuses on employee commitment to the organisation and their
career and social relationships in the workplace factors to develop individual beliefs,
attitudes, and behaviours to the organisational change. The literature on change
management reveals that Madsen et al. (2005) were the first to examine the predictors
of employee commitment to the organisation. Results of the study showed a positive
relationship between employee attitudes and behaviours and readiness for organisational
change. It is important to note here that career commitment is related to the employee
attitudes and behaviours (Goulet and Singh, 2002). The research has largely neglected
the links between employee career commitment and employee readiness for
organisational change. By applying both factors (affective and instrumental),
management can achieve more positive results because the literature on commitment
supports both factors simultaneously (Goulet and Singh, 2002; Yoon and Thye, 2002).
Thus, this research study considers both employee dimensions of organisational
commitment (affective and instrumental) along with employee career commitment.
According to the literature this researcher has reviewed, this may be first study in the
domain of change management to examine employee career commitment factors along
with employee commitment to the organisation to understand the employee attitudes,
beliefs, and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. In fact, career
commitment is related to an individual’s attitudes and behaviours towards his or her
career. The literature in the career commitment domain reveals that if an employee is
committed to his or her career, he or she can progress to a higher level within the
organisation (Hall, 1976; Colarelli and Bishop, 1990). Using this concept, the researcher
examines employee commitment to the organisation along with career predictors which
might be effective in developing positive attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours.
The growing globalisation of business has led to an increasing need to implement
organisational strategies that transcend national boundaries (Hampel and Martinsons,
61
2009, p-459). This research study has been conducted in Pakistan where psychological
and financial factors are regarded as more important than in others for developing
positive attitudes and behaviours (Chang, 1999; Alvi and Ahmed, 1987). Thus, the
research has focused on those elements of an organisation which can provide an active
and supportive role in developing individual’s perception level in the context of
Pakistan. In this study, the predictors (Figure 4.1) were applied to employee readiness
for organisational change. Regardless of the need for and inevitability of change in the
organisation, different theories, models and conceptual approaches and frameworks
were applied to ascertain employee readiness. On the basis of conceptualisation, this
research study has been developed on employee commitment to the organisation and
career predictor variables which follow the individual’s psychological and financial
needs. According to Galais and Moser (2009) commitment to the organisation may be
way of satisfying a need for belonging and identifying. By applying this approach,
management can develop positive thoughts and feelings among employees towards the
organisation and career.
In organisational terms, commitment has largely been used to understand employee
behaviours, thinkings and attitudes towards organisation or work (Oliver, 1990). In this
domain the term seeks the nature and quality of the relationship between the employee
and employer and sense of attachment to their action. The relationship of individual
with the organisation shows their beliefs, willingness, and desire to remain with the
organisation. Thus, the commitment factor can be applied to understand the individual’s
response for organisational change.
62
Figure 4.1 Conceptual Framework
Pay/Wages/Rewards
Employee Readiness Organisational Change
- Emotional Attachment - Feeling of Pride - Personal Sense of Obligation
Promotion
- Career Commitment - Job Satisfaction - Job Involvement - Supervisor & Peer Relations - Training & Skills Development
Social Relationships
63
In fact, the relationship between employee and employer develops on the basis of the
work environment and mutual exchanges that can galvanise the individual to utilise his
or her abilities, efforts, experiences and skills. The work environment and exchanges
may support employee developing commitment with the organisation because she or he
sees the possibility of accomplishing desires, needs and future expectations. By
achieving their needs and expectations, employee accepts or identifies with the
organisation’s goals and values. In addition, an employee can develop positive attitudes
and behaviours when she or he knows about the organisation’s ability and need for
action. Thus, academic researchers and practitioners try to explore the factors which
may support to employee for developing their mind, attitudes, intentions and beliefs for
organisational change. This could be possible by analysing the factors related to the
individual’s commitment to the organisation and career. These factors are mostly
applied to understand the individual’s cognition level towards the organisation.
To develop an individual’s cognition level, it is essential for management to
communicate the organisational change messages regarding the need and capability of
organisation when to making any changes. By communicating these change messages,
management mainly focuses on assisting employees to understand the organisation’s
goals in the form of the need for and efficacy of change programmes. Because
understanding the need and capability of organisations can lead to developing positive
beliefs and behaviours in change programmes. However, employee usually develops
relationships on the basis of psychological and financial benefits which are normally
related to employee commitment to the organisation and his or her career.
In the commitment domain, the main emphasis has been on employee commitment to
the organisation and career which is related to developing an employee’s positive
behaviours, beliefs and attitudes. This development is possible when individuals satisfy
their psychological and financial needs. In organisational behaviour literature, the
commitment factor has been found to be relevant to an individual’s needs and future
expectations. By accomplishing these desires employee can develop positive attitudes
and behaviours for management.
Employee commitment to the organisation has been defined as emotional attachment,
feeling of pride, a sense of obligation, as well as salary, rewards and compensation
64
factors to work in an organisation (Buchanan, 1974; Cook and Wall, 1980; Penley and
Gould, 1988; Cohen, 1996; Madsen et al., 2005). Through these factors employee
develop thoughts and feelings which encourage them to maintain their working
relationship with the organisation. In employee organisational commitment domain
literature, the main focus has been to understand employee career, identification,
morals, work, job involvement, turnover, job satisfaction, and readiness behaviour
(Gellatly, 1995; Madsen et al., 2005). Thus, this dimension of commitment can be
applied to know the individual’s attitudes and behaviours towards the organisation when
management intends to make changes.
In organisational commitment two main dimensions (affective and instrumental) have
been applied to measure the individual’s attitudes and behaviours (Allen and Meyer,
1990; Penley and Gould, 1988; Liou and Nyhan, 1994). These factors have a positive
relationship with employee attachment to an organisation. Affective commitment is
related to the individual’s psychological attachment while instrumental commitment is
related to financial attachment to the organisation. Both forms of commitment are useful
for developing positive attitudes and behaviours for organisational change because
employee want to develop relationships on the basis of accomplishment of his or her
needs, expectations and future progression and development. Variables used in this
domain support understanding the individual’s benefits and expectations provided by
the organisation. Indeed, these factors are related to salary, rewards, emotional
attachment, a feeling of pride, and personal sense of obligation. By analysing these
variables, the researcher is interested to measure employee attitudes beliefs, and
behaviours that show loyalty and attachment to the organisational goals and objectives.
Besides employee commitment to the organisation, employee can develop positive
feelings and thoughts on the basis of career commitment as well. If an employee is
satisfied with his or her career and positive thoughts and feelings for the organisation,
they will tend to accept changes. In career development, employee always looks for
organisational support regarding the psychological and financial variables that can
strengthen their future career. Generally psychological factors have been perceived to
have a stronger relationship with individual satisfaction, attitudes, and well being
(Baltes et al., 2009). Career commitment has been applied for measuring the
individual’s cognition level. In this domain a number of variables have been examined
65
and found a relationship between employee and employer on the basis of career. In the
literature, the consequence of career commitment or lack of it has been found as
turnover, absenteeism, or job satisfaction (Good et al., 1996; Wiener and Vardi, 1980;
Yoon and Thye, 2002). Thus, the career commitment factor can be applied for change
management to measure the employee readiness for organisational change.
In career commitment two factors (individual and situational) commonly apply for
measuring the individual’s perception level towards his or her career (Judge et al., 1995;
Chang, 1999; Poon, 2004; Goulet and Singh, 2002). Individual factors are related with
psychological aspects of individual based on job satisfaction, job involvement, training
and skills development, and supervisor and peer relationships (Blau, 1985; Childs and
Klimoski, 1986; Dreher and Bretz, 199; Judge et al., 1995; Goulet and Singh, 2002).
Situational factors are related to financial aspects of the organisation related to an
employee’s promotion and tenure (Judge et al., 1995; Chang, 1999; Poon, 2004; Goulet
and Singh, 2002). Employee generally perceive individual and situational factors
because both support the individual psychologically and financially to develop positive
cognition to the organisation. Thus, through these variables employee can decide to stay
or not with the organisation because career commitment is related to an individual’s
career satisfaction.
Social relationships in the workplace also affect the individual’s attitudes and
behaviours towards organisational change programmes. If an employee develops social
relationships with their managers, peer and subordinate, she or he may show positive
cognition levels towards the organisation. However, an employee interacts with
colleagues in the form of subordinate, peer or supervisor his or her feelings, attitudes
and perceptions may be different. But with social interaction, management can
understand the individual’s cognition towards his or her work. In social relationships
managers can understand the employee likes dislikes and enjoyment as a result of
talking, interacting and working with them.
Apart from these factors, there are also some external factors such that demographical
elements applied to understand the individual’s perception level. In the literature many
researchers have examined readiness predictors with the support of external factors
(Hanpachern et al., 1998; Madsen et al., 2005; Miller et al., 2006). These factors are
66
related to the demography of the employee in which researchers have included such
variables as gender, age, marital status, employment status, and highest educational
level, number of dependents, years in present job, and years with present employer.
By applying this conceptual approach, the researcher is interested to examine the
employee commitment to the organisation and career factors in order to understand
employee attitudes, beliefs and behaviours for organisational change. This study was
conducted in Pakistan where the main focus of an employee is on his or her
psychological and financial aspects. Therefore the variables used in this study are
related with the employee psychological and financial aspects that may support the
development of positive attitudes and behaviours. Apart from this concept, social
relationships in the workplace were applied to know the individual cognition level. In
addition, some external factors were also applied to understand the level of attitudes and
behaviours.
4.4 Theoretical Framework
This empirical study examined readiness predictors to know employee attitudes and
behaviours for effective and successful implementation of organisational change. These
predictors might have a large impact on employee attitudes, behaviours and beliefs
towards organisational change. In the change management domain, various theories
have been applied to gain in-depth insight to measuring employee attitudes and
behaviours, and change readiness. These theories have mostly been applied in
developed or western countries. But this empirical research study was conducted in
Pakistan. In this study the researcher applied the theoretical model given by Armenakis
et al. (1993; 99) and Maslow’s Need theory (1954). Unlike other change theories, these
theories have focused on particular issues rather than general issues about organisational
change. Thus, the application of these studies could help to a great extent in the analysis
and in-depth reflection in the proposed study.
Having different cognition levels, experiences, culture, habits, skills and mental
processes, an employee reaction might be different to even the same change message
(Armenakis et al., 1993; Cummings and Worley, 2005). Thus, Armenakis et al. (1993)
urge that before announcing or implementing changes in an organisation, management
67
must communicate the change messages accurately, effectively and in a timely manner.
Besides, change agents must inform five key message components including self-
efficacy, principal support, discrepancy, appropriateness, and personal valence
(Armenakis et al., 1999), which can provide greater clarity among employees of the
change issues (Madsen et al., 2005). These factors defined in (Table 4.1) will clarify the
needs and capability of an organisation undertaking a change programme as well as
making clear the benefits of the change to individual employee. With honest and open
organisational communication, management can build a trustworthy relationship
offering a sense of belonging to the employees.
Table 4.1 Change Message Factors
Factor Definition
Self-efficacy
Confidence in individual and group’s ability to make the change
succeed.
Principal support Key organisational leaders support this particular change.
Discrepancy A gap between the current state and an ideal state.
Appropriateness The correct reaction to fix the gap identified by discrepancy.
Personal Valence Clarifies the intrinsic and extrinsic benefits of the change
Adapted from Bernerth (2004, p-41)
Commitment and its determinants have widely been studied from a number of
theoretical perspectives. This research study supports Maslow’s need theory (1954) in
analysing the psychological and financial factors for employee change readiness. In this
theoretical framework, Maslow’s hierarchy of needs informs the development of a
human needs hierarchy in developing attitudes and behaviours. This conceptual
framework can refer to individual’s psychological and financial needs, which might
change an employee cognition level in Pakistan especially in public sector higher
educational institutions. This theory posits that individual seek to meet a hierarchy of
needs in order to obtain goals that are determined by their needs. Five hierarchy levels
(Table 4.2) of this theory are organised in such a way that they are built on the previous
level(s).
Anyone who reaches the fifth (highest) level is healthy physiologically and able to fully
68
realise his or her own potential however, to attain this level he or she must first have
satisfied all the basic needs for everyday living, that is, all the needs within the first four
levels of the hierarchy (Sullivan and Decker, 1992). But, researchers do not believe that
one level of need must be satisfied before the next level of need emerge, as proposed by
Maslow (McClelland, 1965; Alderfer, 1969; Pinder, 1998). However, this theory has
become less popular with rising weight on cognitive processes rather than on underlying
needs (Spector, 1997). Above researchers have objection on the Maslow’s hierarchy
needs approach. It is believed that man’s needs are not one or restricted to a particular
level. According to Au et al. (2002, p-459) that disagreement on the number of level
and the categorisation of needs do exist among human beings, and that these affect their
values, behaviours, and attitudes. In fact, needs are dynamic and at one time many other
needs to be satisfied rather than restricting to one level. Likewise, it is difficult to
ascertain that who has reached to which level. There may be individuals who may settle
for lower job satisfaction or salaries but for higher future career benefits. But this is just
an approach, no approach of motivation can satisfy all problems or could answer all
questions.
Table 4.2 Maslow’s Hierarchy Need Theory Factors
Factor Definition
Psychological needs Satisfying basic needs such as food, shelter, and protection from personal harm.
Safety needs Need to avoid danger and deprivation such as job and body security
Belong to a socio
group needs
Personal acceptance by others, belonging to a group such as friends and family
Self esteem and
status needs
Desire for recognition; gaining self respect such as confidence, achievement, respect of and by others
Self actualization
need
The drive towards self fulfilment such as creativity, problem solving, acceptance of facts
Source: Adapted from Cole et al. (2006); Zangaro (2001)
Table 4.3 depicts the application of Maslow’s theory to employee readiness in Pakistan.
The antecedents of the proposed study are concerned with employee psychological and
financial needs that parallel the needs identified in Maslow’s hierarchy. The variables of
69
each antecedent contribute to an individual commitment towards organisation and their
career that can develop positive attitudes and behaviours during organisational change.
If individual needs are satisfied, they will feel comfortable in their relationship with the
organisation and may play a positive and active role in organisational programmes.
Therefore, the employee is self actualised since his or her physiological and financial
needs for security, socialisation, and esteem are met.
Table 4.3 Maslow’s Hierarchy of Need Level Compared to Employee’s Needs
Employee’s Needs Maslow’s Hierarchy of Need Levels
Pay/Wages/Rewards Level 1: Psychological need
Promotion/Tenure Level 2: Need for safety
Social Relationships in Workplace,
Supervisor and Peer relations
Level 3: Need for belonging
Job satisfaction, Job involvement,
Personal sense of obligation
Level 4: Self-esteem
Training and skills development Level 5: Self-actualisation
Source: developed by researcher
4.5 Commitment and its Impact on Employee
Commitment has been conceptualised as the attitudinal and behavioural aspect of
employee towards organisations or work in the domain of organisational behaviour and
social relations (Meyer et al., 1989; Oliver, 1990). The attitudinal approach seeks to
establish the nature and quality of relationships between the employee and an
organisation (Oliver, 1990). This approach shows the individual’s attachment in terms
of beliefs, willingness, and desire to maintain membership of an organisation. In
commitment domain, behavioural approach is developed on the basis of an individual’s
sense of attachment not an organisation but to their actions (Oliver, 1990). In this
approach, individual maintains their relationships on the basis of rewards, salary, wage,
compensation, tenure, promotion or any other financial benefits which may be lost if the
individual leaves the organisation. Academic researchers and practitioners have
attempted to show the relationship of commitment with an individual behaviours and
attitudes towards his or her work and work environment (Gaertner and Nollen, 1989;
Gautam et al., 2001). Thus, higher level of commitment is related to higher levels of
70
employee satisfaction, progression and development.
In the organisational domain, the term commitment has been defined as an act of
behaviours, beliefs, and attitudes towards a pledge, vocation, or organisation in regard
to how she or he tends to be assigned (Hall, 1971; Merriam-Webster, 1999; Yoon and
Thye, 2002). The concept has been applied to measure the individual attitudes and
behaviours in the workplace. Over the past many decades, commitment has dominated
in the literature on organisational behaviour and social relations. In this domain various
factors have been used to identify and understand employee careers, norms,
identification, morale, work, jobs, job involvement, absenteeism, turnover, job
satisfaction, readiness and organisational citizenship behaviour (Reilly and Orsak, 1991;
Gellatly, 1995; Madsen et al., 2005). These determinants have positive or negative
impacts on the relationship between individual and an organisation. In this domain
various dimensions such that personal attributes relating to psychological aspects and
exchange based measures concerned with financial aspects of the individual have been
found to support the employee cognition and belief levels towards the organisation and
organisational work (Judge et al., 1995; Chang, 1999; Goulet and Singh, 2002; Poon,
2004).
In the literature, commitment has been focused as attitudinal and behavioural
approaches to employee readiness for organisational change (Weber and Weber, 2001;
Madsen et al., 2005). Indeed, commitment develops on the basis of expectations and
benefits provided by an organisation. It is through these mechanisms that employee try
to forge relationships with the organisation. In this regard researchers have expended a
great deal of effort to identifying and analysing purposeful determinants of employee
commitment which may support to develop positive perception. Thus, this research
focused on employee commitment to the organisation and career and social
relationships in the workplace factors in order to understand employee attitudes and
behaviours for organisational change.
4.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation
Employee commitment has been treated as active and positive behaviours and attitudes
71
towards his or her organisation. Mowday et al. (1979) define the term organisational
commitment as an individual identification, loyalty, or involvement, which is
characterised by beliefs, willingness, and membership with the organisation. Zangaro
(2001, p-14) described it as the act of pledging or promising to fulfil an obligation to
someone or something at a future date. In organisation, employee beliefs, attitudes and
behaviours can develop when the he or she knows about the organisational goals and
objectives. In developing employee positive perception regarding the organisation,
employee commitment plays an important role. It shows loyalty, identification and
involvement with the goals and values of the organisation (Buchanan, 1974; Cook and
Wall, 1980). Thus, academic and practitioner researchers in this domain are interested
in employee commitment, because of the individual’s perception of trust, and pledge to
the organisation. In general, employee commitment to the organisation includes a belief
in the organisation’s goals and values that indicate strong identification, involvement,
and loyalty to the organisation. In order to develop this, it is essential that employee and
the organisation understand their mutual interests will be served for the future.
However, these relationships can be developed simply on the strength of the mutual
interests between organisation and employee on the basis of certain needs, desires, and
expectations.
Indeed, organisations perceive the need to provide an environment to employee related
to expectations and demands as employee can utilise their ability, efforts, and skills.
Such an environment is feasible when management knows about the individual’s
expectations, needs and desires. Many researchers and practitioners have tried to
explore possible predictors relating to developing a supportive environment for
employee (Penley and Gould, 1988; Allen and Meyer, 1990; Yoon and Thye, 2002).
In this regard, the organisational commitment concept has been used as a multi-
dimensional concept in the domain of commitment (Allen and Meyer, 1990). In
previous research, employee commitment to the organisation has been used as a
predictor of behaviours like absenteeism, turnover, and organisational citizenship
behaviours (Price and Mueller, 1986; Sagie, 1997; Schappe, 1998). According to Good
et al. (1996) and Yoon and Thye (2002) the organisational commitment concept
develops with organisational support, job satisfaction, job involvement, loyalty, or on
the other hand, turnover and anxiety. In the literature, organisational commitment and
72
job performance have been positively related (Mowday et al., 1974), while tardiness,
absenteeism, and turnover (Steers, 1977; Hom et al., 1979; Wiener and Vardi, 1980) are
inversely related. Thus, the term can be applied for individual’s attitudes and behaviours
because in previous research it has been used to know the individual’s cognition levels.
Hence, the main concern of this researcher is to find the predictor variables that may
support the development of individual positive attitudes and behaviours in change
situation. These predictors may help at the time of any alteration, variation, or
modification within the organisation.
Employee develops their attitudes and behaviours on the basis of psychological and
financial needs (Alvi and Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999). These psychological and
financial aspects develop employee commitment to the organisation. Allen and Meyer
(1990) empirically supported the concept by analysing the affective, continuance, and
normative component to measure employee commitment to the organisation. In this
study affective and normative components have been treated as a psychological aspect
of employee, while the continuance component is a part of the financial aspect of
employee. Gautam et al. (2001) supported that these three concepts reflect an
individual’s psychological and financial status. Thus, affective commitment of
employee is related to his or her emotional attachment, identification, and involvement
with the organisation. Continuance commitment is based on costs, while normative is
concerned with feelings of obligation to remain with an organisation. In the literature,
Penley and Gould (1988) describe employee psychological and financial aspects by
instrumental and affective factors of employee commitment. Many researchers like
Etzioni (1961) and Weiner (1982) have used organisational commitment with
calculative, moral and alienative factors to measure employee commitment to the
organisation. Calculative commitment is treated as instrumental form of organisational
commitment which is related to financial aspects of an employee and moral and
alienative commitment are treated as affective forms of organisational commitment
which is related to psychological aspects of employee. In view of the above studies,
there are two main dimensions of employee commitment to the organisation such that
affective and instrumental which are related to the individual’s psychological and
financial aspects which can affect to employee in developing their attitudes and
behaviours towards the organisational change.
73
4.5.1.1 Affective Commitment
An employee develops relationships with an organisation on the basis of reputation,
recognition, expectations and future development and progression. Affective
commitment is one of the most important and supportive element of employee
commitment to the organisation, and relates to individual involvement, loyalty, and
attachment. In the commitment domain, employee affective commitment has been
known by different names like normative, moral and alienative commitment (Allen and
Meyer, 1990; Penley and Gould, 1988). Meyer and Allen (1984, p-375) define affective
commitment as positive feelings of identification with, attachment to, and involvement
in the work organisation. In this domain, researchers include job characteristics such as
job challenge, variety of skills and degree of autonomy (Gautam et al., 2001) which is
related to the psychological aspect of employee. The factors which may develop
employee’s affective commitment include recognition, trust, name and fame, emotion,
experience and reputation of the organisation. With the passage of time, attitudes and
behaviours can be developed by employee when she or he fully understands the
organisational goals and values for the future. In commitment literature Penley and
Gould (1988) described moral and alienative factors as an affective aspect of employee
which is linked with employee emotional attachment, feeling of pride and personal
sense of obligation.
Previous discussion reveals that employee attachment and identification with the
organisation is concerned with understanding of organisational goals and values.
Through it, employee can understand the organisational needs and capabilities that can
support developing cognition levels. Affective commitment is one of the most important
aspects of employee which reveal the individual’s behaviour by his or her attachment to
and relationship with the organisation. In the affective commitment domain many
predictors have been examined to measure the employee commitment to the
organisation. It includes job characteristics (Dunham et al., 1994), participation in
decision-making (Kim and Mauborgne, 1998), good communication (Konovsky and
Cropanzano, 1991), autonomy, task significance, task identity, skill variety, supervisory
feedback, organisational dependability, perceived participatory management (Steer,
1977; Mottaz, 1988), identification, involvement, and loyalty (Allen and Meyer, 1990).
These variables are directly or indirectly used to measure the individual attitudes and
74
behaviours towards the organisation. Indeed, the result of these behavioural aspects of
commitment is employee retention (Mathieu and Zajac, 1990; Meyer et al., 1993),
attendance, job performance and organisational citizenship behaviour (Herscovitch and
Meyer, 2002). However, age and tenure and other demographic factors may affect
individual attitudes and behaviour towards the organisation. In the literature, Penley and
Gould (1988) conceptualised moral and alienative items to establish employee
behavioural relationship with the organisation. By applying these factors, management
can understand the employee attachment, feeling of pride, and sense of obligation. In
the organisational behaviour domain, employee emotional attachment is concerned with
affection for the organisation, feeling of pride is concerned with the identification which
focuses on connection with the organisation and personal sense of obligation is
concerned with involvement which is the psychological absorption in the activities of
one’s role. With the help of Cook and Wall (1980); Penley and Gould (1988); Oliver
(1990); Poon (2004), this researcher examines the following hypotheses to measure
employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change programmes.
Hypothesis 1: There is a significant positive relationship between a feeling of pride and
employee readiness for organisational change
Hypothesis 2: There is a significant positive relationship between emotional attachment
and employee readiness for organisational change
Hypothesis 3: There is a significant positive relationship between personal sense of
obligation and employee readiness for organisational change
4.5.1.2 Instrumental Commitment
Apart from emotional attachment to the organisation, employee can be induced by
financial support of the organisation to exchange his or her ability, skills, and energies.
The instrumental commitment concept is widely known as continuance commitment
which is forged on the basis of costs of an organisation. It can develop as a result of
any action or event that can increase the costs of leaving the organisation (Penley and
Gould, 1988). Penley and Gould (1988, p-44) define that employee exchanging his or
75
her contribution for the inducements provided by the organisation. Instrumental
commitment is related to the extent to which employee feel committed to their
organisation by virtue of the costs that they feel are associated with leaving (Meyer and
Allen, 1984, p-375). This concept focuses on pay/wages/rewards and fringe benefits or
any compensation in return for individual services for an organisation. This concept
largely supports individual and organisational finances which can be resolved by mutual
understanding of need by employee and organisation. Domain researchers and
practitioners have advocated instrumental commitment factors as essential for gauging
the relationship between employee and his or her organisation. Various researchers have
applied this dimension of employee to know how employee forges relationships with
organisation (Allen and Meyer, 1990; Liou and Nyhan, 1994; Cohen, 1996). With the
help of individual commitment factors, this study has developed the following
hypothesis to examine employee attitudes and behaviours towards organisational
changes.
Hypothesis 4: There is a significant positive relationship between pay/wages/rewards
and employee readiness for organisational change.
According to Madsen et al. (2005) there is no direct study which relates employee
organisational commitment with readiness for organisational change. However, a few
studies have been connected with an indirect correlation. Such as Eby et al. (2000);
Weber and Weber (2001) worked on employee involvement in an organisation to
establish change readiness.
4.5.2 Employee Career Commitment
In the organisational behaviour domain, the term commitment has been adopted to
understand employee attitudes and behaviours regarding his or her work organisation or
work. Employee develops positive attitudes and behaviours towards organisation or
work via a supportive organisational environment and psychological and financial
satisfaction. These factors are related to understanding the employee feelings and
thoughts. Researchers and practitioners have conceptualised the term career
commitment to develop positive attitudes and behaviours of employee by career. This
76
dimension of commitment provides the staying power to strengthen business and
professional relationships. It is one of the important concepts of work commitment
associated with employee development and progression in the career field. According to
Chang (1999) career commitment is an individual’s attitude towards his or her career.
Conceptually, it is defined as one’s attitude towards one’s vocation, including
profession (Blau, 1985, p-278). This concept can be characterised by the development
of personal career goals and the individual’s attachment to, identification with and
involvement in those goals (Colarelli and Bishop, 1990). In brief, career commitment
refers to one’s motivation to work in a chosen vocation (Hall, 1971)
Employee can develop attitudes and behaviours on the basis of career commitment,
where people make a significant investment in their careers (Poon, 2004). In
organisation, individual develops relationships with the organisation on the basis of
career goals and future expectations. However, individual’s relationships and
motivation can be supported by extrinsic and intrinsic benefits provided by the
organisation. An extrinsic benefit is where the employee always looks to the outcome of
his or her career such as pay and promotion while the intrinsic outcomes of career
success depend upon a person’s appraisal of his or her own success (Judge et al., 1995).
On the basis of mutual understanding, employee of an organisation may develop
attachment to, identification with and involvement in the activities of an organisation.
In past studies, researchers found that employee who commit to a career tend to develop
attitudes consistent with that commitment (Kiesler, 1971; Carson et al., 1999). An
examination of the literature on career success revealed several individual difference
factors that influence career success including demographic variables (Gattiker and
Larwood, 1988), dispositional traits, motivation and political influence behaviours
(Seibert et al., 1999; O’Reilly and Chatman, 1986; Judge and Bretz, 1994). Individuals
may be attributed by cognitive ability, job satisfaction, job involvement, education and
job tenure that have been demonstrated to predict career success (Childs and Klimoski,
1986; Dreher and Bretz, 1991; Judge et al., 1995).
Individual with a strong degree of career commitment may show higher levels of
expectations and requirements from the organisation with which they forge
relationships. It also implies that highly career committed individuals may be more
77
motivated when their expectations are satisfied than those who are less committed. In
the organisational behaviour domain, career commitment seems to be an important
factor for career progression and development where it is relevant to the practical
concerns of individual and organisation to excel in occupations or jobs. Moreover,
career commitment involves self generated goals and commitments to one’s own career
which is influenced by a number of factors such as personal, environmental, and
behavioural decisions (London, 1983). If an employee is committed to his or her career
he or she would pursue career goals in spite of obstacles and setbacks and if they do not,
then they make a career change rather than persist in achieving career objectives
(Colarelli and Bishop, 1990).
Indeed, a career involves trade-offs between security and risk and between individual
success and family, and people’s career behaviour interacts with culture. The literature
shows that employee attachment, identification and involvement depend upon extrinsic
and intrinsic outcomes such as pay, promotion, appraisal, and satisfaction that refer to
one’s motivation to work in a chosen vocation (Hall, 1971; Judge et al., 1995). Poon
(2004) reveals that career commitment is predicted by objective and subjective career
success. Objective career success is in the form of salary level and subjective career
success takes the form of career satisfaction. This concept is related to the employee
psychological and financial aspects that can be related to the individual’s cognition. On
the basis of this perception career commitment may support developing positive
attitudes and behaviours by the employee towards change.
Career commitment is affected by individual and situational factors which affect career
motivation or construct behaviour regarding work (London, 1983). In the domain of
organisational behaviour most researchers have focused on individual and situational
factors to measure employee career commitment (Blau, 1985; McGinnis and Morrow,
1990; Goulet and Singh, 2002). These two dimensions have been applied to measure the
impact of career commitment on employee (Morrow, 1993; Hall and Associates, 1986).
By using individual and situational factors, this research study examines employee
attitudes towards their career. This concept may support the development of positive
employee attitudes and behaviour towards organisational change.
78
4.5.2.1 Individual Commitment
Employee develops interests on the basis of his or her personal characteristics like
needs, interests, development, and future expectations. These elements are potentially
related to a person’s career and associated with three career domains such that career
identity, career insight, and career resilience (London, 1986). These three dimensions
can identify the individual’s attitudes towards career motivation, strengths, development
and persistence of career motivation. Most academic researchers and practitioners have
focused on individual factors such as job involvement, job satisfaction and
organisational commitment which have a positive influence on career commitment
(McGinnis and Morrow, 1990; Blau, 1999). To develop individual’s perceptions,
employee personal variables can affect their loyalty and involvement. In career
commitment literature this concept has largely been revealed by variables of job
satisfaction, job involvement, work ethics, and organisational commitment (Morrow,
1983; London, 1983; Goulet and Singh, 2002). Empirically, these variables have been
found positive in developing the relationship of employee with his or her career. Indeed,
these factors can support employee to prepare psychologically for their career. To know
the individual’s psychological perceptions regarding his or her career, individual factors
like job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, and training and
skills development may support the development of employee attitudes and behaviours
during change.
Job satisfaction has been defined by Agho et al. (1992) as the degree to which an
employee likes their work. It is related to employee active feelings to his or her job with
specific aspects, such as pay, supervision, morale, and opportunity for advancement
(McNeese-Smith, 1997; Kangas et al., 1999). These feeling can be generated when an
organisation provides all facilities and benefits to promote employee development and
progression. Job satisfaction provides the degree of an individual’s feelings with his or
her current job (Chang and Chang, 2007). In the literature, the job satisfaction variable
has been widely applied by researchers to measure employee attitudes and behaviours
towards his or her career (Blau, 1985; Goulet and Singh, 2002; Gregory et al., 2007).
In career commitment, the job involvement factor is defined as an employee’s
attachment to a job (London, 1983). In job involvement, an employee can be identified
79
by his or her job which shows the importance of the job relative to the individual’s life.
This factor is involved with the individual’s psychological behaviour which can show
individual’s attitudes and behaviours. Buchanan (1974); Blau (1985); Cohen (1996);
Cherniss (1991) applied job involvement to know employee commitment to the career.
In organisation, supervisor and peer relationships have been applied to understand
employee attitudes and behaviours in the organisation. It is commonly regarded as one’s
belief in the importance of hard work and frugality (Morrow, 1993). This relationship is
useful to understand the employee intention when she or he applied to re mapped the
work commitment constellation (Morrow, 1993). Porter et al. (1974); Goulet and Singh
(2002) applied this term to know career commitment and found positive results.
In career development literature, mostly researchers emphasised on training as an
employee skills development (Gaertner and Nollen, 1989; Chang, 1999). In fact,
training and skills of employee followed competence and development in the
organisation. By using these career commitment factors management can develop
positive attitudes and behaviours of employee during organisational change
programmes. On the basis of this perception, the researcher has developed the following
hypotheses.
Hypothesis 5: There is a significant positive relationship between career commitment
factor and employee readiness for organisational change.
Hypothesis 6: There is a significant positive relationship between job satisfaction and
employee readiness for organisational change.
Hypothesis 7: There is a significant positive relationship between job involvement and
employee readiness for organisational change.
Hypothesis 8: There is a significant positive relationship between supervisor and peer
relations and employee readiness for organisational change.
Hypothesis 9: There is a significant positive relationship between training and skills
development and employee readiness for organisational change.
80
4.5.2.2 Situational Commitment
In career commitment, the situational factor plays an important role in developing an
employee attitudes and behaviours. Situational factors relate to the relationship between
employee and the organisation on the basis of an agreement to provide services. In this
domain, researchers have mostly described employee promotion or tenure (Chang,
1999; Goulet and Singh, 2002; Poon, 2004). In the current situation where economic,
financial, competitive and environment dimensions are fragile, these variables can affect
individual’s cognition level. Employee has no lifelong contract with the employer and
this may create uncertainty among employees. This feeling grows among employees
when economic and organisational forces necessitate downsizing and restructuring
(Morrow, 1993; Hall and Associates, 1986). Many elements of the work environment
like job contract, fear of job loss, job fit and organisational uncertainty are likely to be
important to develop career motivation. In the situational factor Goulet and Singh
(2002) used variables like organisational uncertainty, fear of job loss and job fit factors
to know the employee cognition level towards the individual’s career commitment.
With the support of Porter et al. (1974); Gaertner and Nollen (1989); Chang (1999);
Goulet and Singh (2002) the researcher intends to examine the situational factor such
that promotion to measure employee attitudes and behaviours to career commitment.
This may lead to employee change readiness.
Hypotheses 10: There is a significant positive relationship between promotion and
employee readiness for organisational change.
4.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace
Employee, who receives encouragement and rewards for change, is more likely to act
voluntarily in support of organisational change goals thus contributing to overall
organisational effectiveness (Organ, 1988; Van yperen et al., 1999). Such
encouragement and rewards are directly or indirectly related to employee career or
organisational commitment. Although the previous construct focuses on individual
commitment to the organisation and career during change it is believed that social
relationships in the workplace also focus on employee feelings, attitudes, and
perceptions. Employee interacts with colleagues in the form of subordinate, peer or
81
supervisor but feelings, attitudes and perceptions may be either positive or negative.
Hanpachern et al. (1998) and Madsen et al. (2005) focused on social relationships
related to employee readiness and found a significant correlation between them. In
social relationships this study also focuses on employee likes, dislikes and enjoyment
related to talking, interacting and working with colleagues. According to the literature
there is no relevant study except (Hanpachern et al., 1998; Madsen et al., 2005) while
many authors have reported indirectly like Eby et al. (2000); Weber and Weber (2001);
Cunningham et al. (2002). In this study, social relationships in the workplace have been
hypothesised as follows:
Hypothesis 11: There is a significant positive relationship between social relationships
in the workplace and employee readiness for organisational change.
4.7 Demography
Apart from the above predictors, demography may also play an important role in the
domain of organisational behaviour. To develop individual attitudes, beliefs, and
behaviours this factor is to be counted as an imperative for developing individual’s
cognition. In the literature these factors are known as extra related or family situation
factors and include different variables like age, gender, marital status, tenure in
company, tenure in position, job status, spouse, children, education (Mottaz, 1988;
Madsen et al., 2005). In career commitment, this factor has a mixed response on
individual decisions. Aryee and Tan (1992) describe that family situations do not have
any significant effect on career commitment. But most researchers and practitioners
claim that extra work related factors commonly affect commitment because of family
dependency (Blau, 1985; Madsen et al., 2005). However, with increasing dependency
and the associated need for financial resources, employee may actually become more
committed to their personal careers (Goulet and Singh, 2002).
4.8 Conclusion
The review of the literature on employee readiness for organisational change undertaken
by this researcher has revealed that an individual’s beliefs, behaviours and responses to
organisational change are influenced by psychological and financial factors. However,
82
these factors are dependent upon employee commitment to the organisation and career.
Therefore, it is important to identify and assess the psychological and financial factors
to employee readiness for organisational change. In this regard, the researcher has
developed a conceptual framework, which is based on different theories such as
Armenakis’s change messages and five component message theories and Maslow’s
Need theory. The conceptual approach encompasses a number of factors (individual,
situational, instrumental and affective). These factors have been studied with regard to
employee response towards various issues related to job satisfaction, turnover,
attachment, identification and absenteeism but not about employee readiness for
organisational change. Moreover, most of the research about employee change readiness
has been undertaken in the developed or western world and there are hardly any studies
reported from Pakistan in general and academic organisations in particular.
The researcher has therefore developed a few hypotheses on the basis of the conceptual
approach to examine the impact of psychological and financial factors of commitment
on employee readiness and intends to examine the hypotheses in public sector higher
educational sector in Pakistan. The justification for the proposed study is that recent
organisational changes have been introduced in academic organisations, especially in
public sector universities across the country, and there has been resistance from
employees.
83
Chapter Five Research Methodology
5.1 Introduction
The method section of research study is concerned with the choice of appropriate
methodology by which the validity of research is judged. Thus, it requires a clear and
comprehensive rationalisation of how the study is to be done and why particular
procedures were preferred. This research has been developed on the basis of a literature
review and conceptual approach which is previously discussed. With the support of the
conceptual approach a few hypotheses have been developed in relation to independent
and dependent variables. In order to select a methodological approach, initially, a
philosophical stance was reviewed to understand the relationship and justification of
approach which has been adopted. This justification may lead to an explanation for the
use of the methods adopted. The discussion is to be confined to the selection of a
research strategy and justification of the adoption of a strategy for the purpose of theory
testing. Drawing on research approach, a research design has been established to follow
the study step by step in a systematic way. The researcher discusses in detail the
empirical research methodology including data collection and data analysis. The data
collection section is described in five parts as (a) data collection (b) sample selection
and participation (c) developing the survey questionnaire (d) measurement scales and
(e) pilot study. After that reliability and validity are discussed to justify the data. The
chapter also discusses what kind of data is required for examining the variables. Then,
data analysis processes and statistical techniques are selected to analyse the data.
Finally, the research ethical issues discussed to ensure the data is unbiased and can
support generalisability. Conclusions are the final component of this chapter.
5.2 Research Philosophy
Research philosophy means the way a researcher thinks about the development of
knowledge. This section is concerned with the philosophical stance of the researcher, in
which, the method to be adopted for the research is decided. It is useful when a
researcher knows about the philosophical issues of different research fields. These
issues affect the research in several ways like data collection and data analysis. In the
methodology domain, there are two main research paradigms, namely positivist and
84
phenomenological (Easterby et al., 1991; Hussey and Hussey, 1997). Positivist is well
known as scientific and is quantitative and phenomenological is known as non-positivist
and qualitative. Both paradigms have positive and negative impacts on different fields
of research in one way or another but the main concern is same. However, in order to
select an appropriate method to carry out this research, it is necessary to define both
approaches.
The positivist approach is concerned with numerical data collection for understanding
human behaviours. This method can be applied to gain understanding of human
attitudes and behaviours in the way it reveals information about people through
objective values. According to Hussey and Hussey (1997), the positivistic paradigm is
concerned with the facts or causes of social phenomena. In this paradigm, researchers
apply the language of theories, variables, and hypotheses. Being a scientific approach, it
deals with the numbers in an objective fashion and applies statistical methods for
analysis. Burrell and Morgan (1979, p-5) revealed that quantitative research seeks to
explain and predict what happens in the social world by searching for regularities and
casual relationships between its constituent elements. This method is more suitable
when the object of the research is to gather data related to the frequency of occurrence
of phenomena. According to Gilbert (2001, p-32), the aim is to develop valid and
reliable ways of collecting “facts” about society, which can then be statistically
analysed in order to produce explanations about how the social world operates.
The second view of research is qualitative research which is concerned with descriptive
data collection for understanding human behaviours. The qualitative research approach
is well known as a phenomenological, subjective, or non-positivist approach related to
the nature of reality. This method can be applied to gain deep understanding of human
behaviours with regard to revealing people’s values, interpretive schemes and belief
systems (Cavana et al., 2001). The subjective state of the individual centred in this
philosophy is the attempt to understand how and why phenomena occur (Sharif, 2004).
This research approach attempts to define actuality in descriptive ways as it is perceived
by participants to describe meaningful human actions (Sarantakos, 1993). By this
method, data collection is viewed as an alternative to positivism which relies on
interpretive research (Neuman, 2000; Anonymous, 2003). However, the philosophical
stance of both approaches is summarised in Table 5.1 as shown below.
85
Table 5.1 Summary of Philosophical Stance of Research Approach
Approach Description References
Positivist To develop valid and reliable ways of
collecting “facts” about society, this can then
be statistically analysed in order to produce
explanations about how the social world
operates.
Gilbert (2001)
Phenomenological To gain deep understanding of human
behaviour by revealing people’s values,
interpretive schemes and belief systems.
Cavana et al.
(2001)
Both traditions were revealed in their pure forms and found not only different but were
mutually exclusive (Gilbert, 2001). From a philosophical stance, a positivism paradigm
uses deduction, beginning with theory developing hypotheses and collecting data while
the phenomenological follows induction, the process of finding a case and observing
relationships and finally constructing a general theory to cover all cases. According to
Cavana et al. (2001) quantitative design start from support of the theory, developing
hypotheses, collecting and analysing data and then accepting or rejecting hypotheses.
However, the phenomenological research method starts from observing phenomena,
analysing patterns and themes, formulating relationships, and then developing a theory,
support for the theory, and developing hypotheses as shown in Figure 5.1.
86
Figure 5.1 Deductive and Inductive Reasoning in Research
It has been realised in literature that research methodology has a related philosophy
within the different schools of thought. Ultimately the aim of approach is to develop
valid and reliable facts from society. However, Easterby-Smith et al. (1991, p-27)
observed and found different features of these two main different paradigms such that
positivism and phenomenological as shown in Table 5.2.
It is important to select the correct methodological paradigm in order to appreciate
methods and decisions that can be controversial. It is observed that both methods have
some strengths and weaknesses which was well defined by Amaratunga et al. (2002)
that the positivist approach is faster and more economical and can cover a wide range of
population, while the data collection method is inflexible. In the phenomenological
paradigm data gathering methods are seen as more natural than artificial. This method
supports easy understanding of people’s meanings and ideas. From the point of view of
weaknesses, it can be tedious and requires more sources for data collection. It is more
difficult in analysis and interpretation than the positivist approach.
Theory Develop Hypotheses
Data
Develop Hypotheses
Theory
Deductive Approach
Inductive Approach
87
Table 5.2 Key Features of Positivist and Phenomenological Paradigms
Theme Positivist Paradigm Phenomenological Paradigm
Basic Beliefs
The world is external and
objective.
Observer is independent.
Science is value free.
The world is socially constructed
and subjective.
Observer is part of what is
observed.
Science is driven by human
interest.
Research Should
Focus on facts.
Look for causality and
fundamental laws.
Reduce phenomena to simplest
elements.
Formulate hypotheses and test
them.
Focus on meanings.
Try to understand what is
happening.
Look at the totality of each
situation.
Develop ideas through induction
from data.
Preferred method
in the research
Operational single concepts, so
that they can be measured.
Taking large samples.
Using multiple methods to
establish different views of the
phenomena.
Small samples investigated in
depth or over time.
Source: Easterby-Smith et al. (1991)
In research, philosophy depends upon the ontology, epistemology, human nature and
methodology which relate to reality, the relationship between reality and the researcher,
and the techniques used by the researcher to discover the reality, respectively (Healy
and Perry, 2000). The researcher has discussed both paradigms of research in which the
positivism paradigm is based on the ontology of the world that is external and objective,
while the epistemology is based on the belief that observers are independent. According
to Burrell and Morgan (1979), there are four pairs of assumptions of both subjective and
objective paradigms in social science research. From an ontological assumption, the
main concern is on the very nature or essence of the social phenomena that is to be
investigated. In this assumption, a nominalist looks at social reality while an objectivist
at realist position. In epistemology, there is an assumption that the researcher is
concerned with the nature and forms. Whereas a subjective approach is based on the
88
experience and insight of a personal nature and objectivist approach is observable and is
hard in the research domain. The third assumption is human nature in relationship to
human beings and the environment. In this approach, subjectivists consider individuals
as initiator and voluntaristic, while objectivists portray their environment as determinist.
Finally, there are methodological issues related to measurement and identification of
underlying themes. In the above approach, subjectivists try to understand individual
behaviour which may be as ideographic while the objectivist is characterised by
procedures and methods which may be designed to discover a general law is referred to
as nomothetic. Table 5.3 given by Cohen et al. (2000, p-7) shows different research
methods which influence the choice of methodologies.
Table 5.3 Two Tradition of Social Science
The Subjectivist Approach to The Objectivist Approach
Social Science to Social Science
Nominalism Ontology Realism
Anti-positivism Epistemology Positivism
Voluntarism Human Nature Determinism
Idiographic Methodology Nomothetic
Source: Cohen et al. (2000, p-7)
5.2.1 Research Approach Adopted for this Study
This research study measures the relationship between independent and dependent
variables. Initially, the research started from the review of large amount of literature and
developed a conceptual approach for the empirical examination. According to
conceptual approach and with the support of theories, this research has developed
hypotheses to examine the relations between independent and dependent variables. The
procedure adopted for this research follows a quantitative approach for data collection
and analysis. According to Gilbert (2001, p-19), the positivism paradigm uses
deduction, beginning with hypotheses. Hussey and Hussey (1997, p-55) defined the
normal process under a positivistic paradigm is to study the literature to establish an
89
appropriate theory and construct hypotheses. There are certain reasons to adopt a
quantitative approach for data collection from the workplace. First, this study is going to
measure the relationships between the variables. Second, the ontological position
suggests the realist position that requires social facts. Third, the epistemological
position allows independent observable facts in society. The fourth assumption is
human nature in relation to human beings according to their environment as
determinism. Finally, there are methodological issues relating to measurement and
identification of underlying themes. In this approach the objectivist is characterised by
procedures and methods which may be designed to discover general laws which is
referred as nomothetic.
This research consists of an empirical study in which a survey questionnaire has been
applied for data collection. This study was conducted in higher educational institutions
of Pakistan where data was collected from a sample of faculty members such that
professors, associate professors, assistant professors, and lecturers. For analysing the
data, statistical measures were applied to test the hypotheses in relation to independent
and dependent variables. Before collecting the data a pilot study was conducted to
measure the survey questionnaire reliability, language used in the questionnaire and
time horizon to complete the survey.
5.2.2 Justification for Quantitative Approach
The epistemology focuses strongly on hard human facts and causes. This research
approach emphasises realism of context and the use of quantitative methods of research
such as facts and causes of social phenomena. It assumes that the social world is
composed of relatively concrete empirical artefacts that can be identified, studied and
measured through approaches derived from natural sciences. Thus, for the purpose of
conducting this research, it was felt that understanding the nature of ‘individual
behaviour’ demanded a more contextually oriented study perspective. The conceptual
approach presented in chapter four reports several behaviours and attitudes that can
influence the individual during organisational change. These factors indicate that there
are many organisational, environmental and social issues. Thus, this research was
conducted in the higher education system of Pakistan where employee can develop
90
attitudes and behaviours on the basis of psychological and financial needs. There is,
therefore, a need for a research approach that allows the researcher to understand the
beliefs and thoughts of employees from psychological and financial points of view.
5.2.3 Rationale for Quantitative Approach
Change is concerned with the development of organisation which requires proper
handling the situation because of human involvement. Transferring from a known to an
unknown situation can develop uncertainties and ambiguities for employee because of
differences in individual life experiences, motivational levels, socio-demographic
characteristics, knowledge, attitudes, and behavioural patterns. The literature supports
the idea that the main focus has been on employee attitudes, perceptions and beliefs in
change situations.
Employee can have a variety of reactions to change. Successful adjustment to change
can provide opportunities for learning and growth, while poor adjustment is
characterised by feelings of uncertainty, frustration, alienation, and anxiety. Thus
researchers and practitioners are anxious to know employees attitudes and behaviour
towards change. According to Arnold et al. (1995, p-167) “Attitudes reflect a person’s
tendency to feel, think or behave in a positive or negative manner towards the object of
the attitude”. Many researchers like Eby et al. (2000); Kotter (1996); Martin (1998)
focused on positive attitudes to effective change programmes.
In the change domain employee readiness has been associated with individual attitudes
and behaviours that may be supportive or resistant (Armenakis and Bedeian, 1999).
Bernerth (2004) argues that readiness is a state of mind during the change process that
reflects a willingness or receptiveness to changing the way one thinks. Researchers and
practitioners need to know how to deal with employee before, during and after
launching change programmes.
Over the past few decades many predictors have been found to relate to employee
readiness. By applying a survey questionnaire on 758 samples in four profit-oriented
companies from northern Utah, Canada, Miller et al. (2006) focused on employee
readiness for organisational change by influencing workplace factors such that
91
management and leader relationships, job knowledge and skills, and job demands and
found a significant influence on employee readiness for change. By getting 131 survey
samples from a manufacturing company in the USA, Hanpachern et al. (1998) found
that margin in life and demographic variables of employee are related to readiness for
change including job knowledge and skills, social relationships in the workplace,
organisational culture, and management and leadership relationships which all have a
significant relation to readiness for change. Rafferty and Simons (2006) focused on the
factors that make readiness for two types of change such that corporate transformation
and fine tuning in five Australian organisations including public sector organisations
such that utilities and agencies. Cunningham et al. (2002) examined logistical and
occupational risks of change, ability to cope with change and to solve job related
problems, social support, active and passive job construct as they influence readiness
for organisational change in healthcare organisation in Canada. Madsen et al. (2005)
worked in four profits oriented companies from northern Utah, Canada. They found first
time significant relationships between employee readiness, organisational and career
commitment and social relationships in the workplace. A recent research study
conducted by Holt et al. (2007) received 464 questionnaire surveys from full-time
employees in four public and private companies in northern Utah, Canada. Researchers
found that readiness for change is influenced by employee beliefs of self efficacy,
appropriateness, management support, and personal valence.
The above literature shows that both employee and management need to know the
attitudes and behaviours regarding organisational change. By knowing their objective,
the majority of the researchers have applied a positivist approach through survey
questionnaires (Table 5.4). In literature, Eby et al. (2000) applied survey questionnaire
to sales organisation in the USA. From 300 sample respondents, response rate was 39%.
In a study, Cunningham et al. (2002) examined the logistical and occupational risks of
change, solve job-related problems, social support, and active vs. passive job construct
to influence readiness for organisational change in Canadian healthcare organisations.
They distributed 880 surveys to participants and getting 74% response rate. Peach et al.
(2005) conducted study among local government in Australia by using survey
questionnaire to 180 samples. Erturk (2008) applied questionnaire to 878 employees
from a public sector organisation in Turkey and got response 35%.
92
Survey questionnaire can provide information into individual perceptions and attitudes
as well as organisational policies and practices (Baruch and Holtom, 2008, p-1140).
According to Chen (2005, p-153) attitude measurement often involves asking
respondents not just what they feel about a particular object, but what they believe about
it. In positivist methodology, a survey questionnaire uses Likert scaling to measure the
attitudes of individuals (Miller and Brewer, 2003) because the reliability of Likert scales
tends to be good and partly because of the greater range of answers permitted to
respondents (Oppenheim, 1992, p-200).
In this study, the researcher intends to examine employee commitment to organisation
and career predictors which are related to the employee attitudes and behaviours
towards his or her organisation and vocation. It is the intention to apply a quantitative
approach which is one of the major approaches in business and social sciences research
methodology. This design is aimed at understanding human attitudes, behaviours, and
beliefs during change programmes. Quantitative focuses on what, where and when
(Collis and Hussey 2003). It addresses the following questions related to this study:
1. What impact does employee commitment to the organisation have on
employee readiness for organisational change?
2. What impact does employee career commitment have on employee readiness
for organisational change?
3. What impact do employee social relationships in the workplace have on
readiness for organisational change?
93
Table 5.4 Readiness Studies
Paper Description Author’s Name
(s) & Years
Place Organisation
Type
Sample Size Response
Rate
Used
Instrument
Creating Readiness for Organisational Change
Armenakis et al.
(1993)
USA
--------
--------
--------
Descriptive
Changing the “whole system” in the public sector
White (2000)
UK
Public Sector
--------
--------
Case Study
Perceptions of organisational readiness for change: Factors related to employees’ reactions to the implementation of team bases selling
Eby et al. (2000)
USA
Sales Organisation
300
39%
Survey Questionnaire
Crafting a change message to create transformational readiness.
Armenakis and Harris (2002)
USA
Public Sector
--------
--------
Case Study
Readiness for organisational change: A longitudinal study of workplace, psychological and behavioural correlates
Cunningham et al.
(2002)
Canada
Teaching Hospitals Human Resource department
880
74%
Survey Questionnaire
Managing Change and Changing managers from ABC to XYZ
Burnes (2003)
UK
Engineering Company
--------
--------
Case Study
The role of emotional intelligence and personality variables on attitudes toward organisational change
Vokala et al.
(2004)
Greece
Public and Private Organisations
350
39%
Survey Questionnaire
Expanding Our Understanding of the Change Message
Bernerth (2004)
USA
--------
--------
--------
Descriptive
Predicting openness and commitment to change
Chawla and Kelloway (2004)
Canada
Public Sector Organisations
541
34.75%
Questionnaire
94
The role of psychological climate in facilitating employee adjustment during organisational change
Martin et al.
(2005)
Australia
Public Hospitals
779
49%
Questionnaire and Interview
Beliefs Underlying Employee Readiness to Support A Building Relations
Peach et al.
(2005) Australia Local
Government 180 84% Survey
Questionnaire
Readiness for Organisational Change: Do Organisational Commitment and Social Relationships in the Workplace Make a Difference?
Madsen et al.
(2005)
Canada
Profit and Non Profit Organisation
758
61%
Survey Questionnaire
Exploring the implications of vision, appropriateness, and execution of organisational change
Cole et al. (2006)
USA
Manufacturing Companies
244
89%
Survey Questionnaire
Readiness for change: Implementations on Employees’ Relationship with Management, Job Knowledge and Skills, and Job Demands
Miller et al.
(2006)
Canada
Profit Organisations
758
60%
Survey Questionnaire
An examination of the antecedents of readiness for fine-tuning and corporate transformation changes
Rafferty and Simons (2006)
Australia
Public Sector Organisations
311
39%
Survey Questionnaire
Readiness for Organisational Change: The Systematic Development of a Scale
Holt et al. (2007)
Canada
Public & Private Sector Organisations
498
53%
Survey Questionnaire
A trust-based approach to promote employees’ openness to organisational change in Turkey
Erturk (2008)
Turkey
Public Sector Organisation
2500
35%
Survey Questionnaire
Measurement of Perceived Organisational Readiness for Change in the Public Sector
Cinite et al.
(2009)
Canada
Public Sector Organisation
742
59%
Survey Questionnaire
95
5.3 Research Design
This research attempts to examine independent variables such that employee
commitment to the organisation and career and social relationships in the workplace
with dependent variable such that employee readiness for organisation change. Initially,
the literature was reviewed to explore gap in the research and develop an understanding
of the investigation domain. It was observed that employee can develop attitudes and
behaviours on the basis of commitment. From that point of view, researchers have
empirically examined employee commitment factors to readiness for change and found
positive results (Madsen et al., 2005). However, employee career commitment has not
been examined to employee readiness for change readiness so for. By applying
employee commitment to the organisation and career, the researcher attempts to
examine employee attitudes and behaviours towards change. This research has been
conducted in higher educational institutions of Pakistan where changes have been
announced recently. Faculty members of these institutions are resisting these changes.
Thus, this research explores which factors can influence the development of positive
attitudes and behaviours for the change.
For this research, a research design has been developed to focus the research step by
step. In fact, the research design is based on a research model that is rooted in the
assumption that research is perceived as a sequence of steps closely interrelated, and the
success of one step is dependent on completion of the preceding step (Sarantakos,
1993). Although, research design helps to draw boundaries for the research in defining
the study setting, type of investigation that needs to be carried out, the unit of analysis
and other relevant issues related to research, Hussey and Hussey (1997) argued that the
research process can only be successful if the researcher makes the right choices in the
research design.
The research design applied for this study is based on the hypothetico-deductive
method. This method starts from a literature review, theoretical framework, formulating
hypotheses and making logical deductions from the results of the study (Sekaran, 2006).
The hypothetico-deductive method broadly divides a research design into a series of
96
steps that lead to answering the research questions (Neuman, 1995). Figure 5.2 lists the
step-by-step process that will be used to conduct the study.
This research design describes the hypothetico-method that leads to answering the
research questions and justifies the hypotheses. The research process started with
extensive literature review helping the researcher to create an awareness of the research
domain. Through establishing a gap in the literature, an understanding was developed of
the research domain. After finding the gap and developing understanding of the research
in the literature, a conceptual model was developed to represent the intended empirical
research. In the conceptual model several factors have been connected regarding
understanding of employee attitudes and behaviours in a change situation. To test the
model, data is required to validate the research hypotheses. The type of data has been
determined as quantitative, the epistemology stance determined, and a research strategy
identified.
In view of the above discussion, the research follows the positivist philosophical
approach for data collection. According to Cohen et al. (2000), the positivist approach
starts from the literature review and develops hypotheses on the basis of a conceptual
framework. Thus, in this philosophical stance, data can be collected by a survey
questionnaire. According to Chen (2005, p-153), attitudes measurement often involves
asking respondents not just what they feel about a particular object, but what they
believe about it. In positivist methodology, survey questionnaires use Likert scaling to
measure the attitudes of individuals (Miller and Brewer, 2003) because the reliability of
Likert scales tends to be good and partly because of the greater range of answers
permitted to respondents (Oppenheim, 1992, p-200).
Based on the need of research for empirical study, it was decided that this research
design used quantitative research methods as a strategy for theory testing. This research
design follows a plan of action or protocol because of important tool for various
following reasons.
1. To put the task of data collection in a manageable format.
2. To ensure that required data are gathered.
97
Figure 5.2 Research Design
Develop conceptual framework
Instrument Development Population and Sampling
Pilot study Reliability and Validity
Conduct Field work (Establishing contact with
employees)
Unit of Analysis
Discuss findings and
recommendations
End
Develop research protocol
Conduct the main field work
Classified
code data
Analyse empirical
data
Start Review the
literature
Identify research
need
Define research
question
Research
desig
n D
ata collectio
n D
ata analy
sis
98
3. To ensure that the research follows a particular schedule.
4. To follow the path by which knowledge was developed.
Within the protocol, a quantitative research method has been developed to gather data as
required for the analysis of the higher educational institutions. The method is in the
form of a survey questionnaire, in which there is a series of questions relating to the
factors that can develop perception of employees during organisational change. In
addition to the survey questionnaire, data has been collected through office documents
such that notifications, circulars, newspaper archives, minutes of meetings, consultancy
reports, and the website of the Higher Education Commission (HEC) of Pakistan.
A survey questionnaire needs to develop a protocol and address ethical issues before
collecting the full scale data. Initially, to assess the reliability and validity of the
instrument, a pilot study was conducted to check internal consistency, questionnaire
items, language and time taken to complete it and validity was measured through field
experts. In this connection a few surveys were sent to university professors and experts
for confirming the face validity. Data collection included fieldwork and the
implementation of the workplace survey. Data is to be analysed by using descriptive
statistics, statistical package for social sciences (SPSS) version 15.0 for Windows and
structural equation modelling (SEM) which applied analysis of moment objectives
(AMOS) 16.0 version software. The study concludes with an extensive discussion and
findings suggesting recommendations for future research and limitations.
It is important to note that neither the positivist nor the phenomenological approach can
be categorised as being superior to the other. However, the validity of the approach
depends upon the objectives of the research question(s). Moreover, it would be
unrealistic to imply that a fine divide exists between a management researcher adopting
a positivist or phenomenological approach. Hussey and Hussey (1997) noted that some
scholars prefer to use the term interpretivist rather than phenomenology to minimise
confusion between research philosophy and methodological approach.
99
5.4 Research Instrument and Measurement Scale
This empirical study to test the hypotheses was developed in chapter four of this study.
Data for this study was collected from public sector universities by a survey
questionnaire. In the domain of employee readiness for organisational change, many
researchers have used survey instruments to collect the data. Among them are Rafferty
and Simons (2006) who worked on an examination of the antecedents of readiness for
fine tuning and transformation change, Miller et al. (2006) studied readiness for change
by looking at the implications on employee relationship with management, job
knowledge and skills, and job demands, and Madsen et al. (2005) in their study on
readiness for organisational change, ‘Do organisational commitment and social
relationships in the workplace make a difference?’. All these researchers applied survey
questionnaires to collect the data which is an efficient way for collecting data for
specific variables of interest (Hussey and Hussey, 1997; Bove and Hede, 2001).
According to Verschuren and Doorewaard (1999), the survey’s aim is to find out what a
selected group of individuals think, feel, or do. However, this research study is
concerned to know the employee attitudes, behaviours, and beliefs about the issues
created by changes in the organisation. Actually, attitudes are influenced by beliefs,
which can involve asking respondents about what they feel about a particular object. In
survey questionnaires, a Likert scale is commonly used to measure attitudes (Miller and
Brewer, 2003). According to Oppenheim (1992, p-200), the Likert scale was adopted in
the survey partly because the reliability of Likert scales tends to be good and partly
because of the greater range of answers permitted to respondents. By applying a survey
questionnaire, a large amount of people can be involved in the research because it is an
easy and economical tool with which to collect the data. By applying the same
precedent, this study applied a survey questionnaire to collect data. The discussion
regarding survey questionnaires is given in the following section.
5.4.1 Developing a Survey Questionnaire
The process of developing a survey questionnaire is based on what kind of information
is needed. In order to examine the hypotheses developed for this research, a survey
questionnaire was proposed for data collection. A survey questionnaire can provide
insight into individual perceptions and attitudes as well as organisational policies and
100
practices (Baruch and Holtom, 2008, p-1140) According to the philosophical stance
which is discussed in the second section of this chapter, a positivist approach can be
applied for data collection to examine the individual’s attitudes and behaviours. Thus,
for this research, a survey questionnaire has been adapted for data collection which
possesses many options of Likert scaling for the variety of choice for the respondent
(Appendix 1).
This research focuses on individual attitudes, behaviours and beliefs which can support
management to develop employee readiness for organisational change. An individual’s
perception can be developed by fulfilling basic needs such that psychological and
financial. In this regard, a conceptual model has been developed by employing
employee commitment to the organisation and career factors. This research focuses on
employee commitment to the organisation factors such that affective (emotional
attachment, feeling of pride and personal sense of attachment), instrumental
(pay/wages/rewards) and career commitment factors such that individuals (job
satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, training and skills
development) and situational (promotion) factors to know employee attitudes and
behaviours for organisational change.
This is a cross sectional study in which data would be collected at one time from the
random sample of people to test the hypotheses. In this research both independent and
dependent variables have been carried out at the same time. The survey instrument
which is used for this study has five sections.
Section “A” is concerned with the demography of participants, providing information
about participants’ personal attributes (Appendix 1). Eight items from question numbers
1 to 8 are concerned with the demography. These variables such that gender, age range,
marital status, present employment status, highest educational level, number of
dependents, years in present job and years with present employer have been applied as
an intervene which may affect the level of commitment and readiness. Many researchers
like Weber and Weber (2001); Madsen et al. (2005); Holt et al. (2007) applied
demographical factors to know the context of individuals.
Section “B” of survey comprises 14 items (9-22) (Appendix 1). This section brings the
101
information about the individual’s response to the change. These questionnaire items
have been applied by Miller et al. (2006) and Madsen et al. (2005) to employee
readiness for organisational change. Reliability (Cronbach’s alpha) of these items was
.81 and .82 respectively in previous research. This data provided information about the
attitudes and behaviours they have developed regarding the organisational change
programme. This section reflects the individual understands of the line of action for
organisational change.
Section “C” comprises of 15 items (23-36) which provide information about employee
commitment to the organisation (Appendix 1). Survey questionnaire items from 23 to
31 are concerned with affective commitment comprising emotional attachment, feeling
of pride and personal sense of obligation factors. All these questions show the
employees psychological perception regarding commitment to the organisation. These
survey items have been developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and a factor analysis
conducted by Mathews and Shepherd (2002), stated that “the analysis of conducted in
this study has demonstrated that a three factor structure can be best fit to the data” (p-
374). These items were applied by Madsen et al. (2005) and found Cronbach’s alpha of
.81. Instrumental factors of this commitment comprise pay/wages/rewards and fringe
benefits. For this, questions 32 to 36 provide information about the instrumental
commitment to the organisation. These survey items have been applied by Yoon and
Thye (2002) for distributive justice related to financial factors and found Cronbach’s
alpha of .81.
Section “D” of the survey comprises 33 items (37-69) (Appendix 1). This section
provides information about employee career commitment. Questions 37 to 44 are
generally related with employee career commitment. These questionnaire items were
developed by Blau (1985) and applied by various researchers like McGinnis and
Morrow (1990) and Aryee and Tan (1992) to measure employee career commitment.
Goulet and Singh (2002) applied these items to examine individual commitment and
found a reliability alpha of .82. However, career commitment has been divided into two
parts (situational and individual) in this study. For situational, one factor was examined
such that promotion. Information regarding promotion was obtained by questions 45 -
47. These questionnaire items were developed by Gaertner and Nollen (1989) to
measure employee perception about promotion and applied by Chang (1999) who found
102
reliability alpha .73. The data was used to measure individual career commitment from
situational perspectives. The second component of this commitment is related with
factors like job satisfaction which comprises items (48-54) developed by Brayfield and
Rothe (1951). Reliability alpha computed .77 and was corrected by the Spearman-
Brown formula to .87. The second factor is job involvement which comprises items (55-
59) selected from Kanungo’s (1982) nine items and applied by Goulet and Singh
(2002). Reliability alpha computed .86. The third factor is supervisor and peer relations
which comprise items (60-65) developed by Gaerntner and Nollen (1989). These items
were applied by Chang (1999) and reliability alpha computed .92. The last factor for
this section is training and skills development which comprised items (66-70) developed
by Gaerntner and Nollen (1989). These items were applied by Chang (1999) and
reliability alpha computed .72.
In the last, section “E” comprises four questions (71-74) (Appendix 1). This section
relates to social relationships in the workplace. These survey items have been adapted
from the four-item social relationships subscale of Hanpachern’s Revised Margin in
Life Scale (1998). These original items were modified by Stevenson in 1982. These
scales has been applied by Madsen et al. (2005) and found positive results and a
Cronbach’s alpha of .70.
Survey items are related with the variables, which have been used to develop the
hypotheses for the study (Chapter Four). Items adapted in the instrument have been
applied to get information about the variables for analysing the hypotheses. However, a
few items are concerned with the background information like demography (Table 5.5).
The researcher has tried to adapt the survey questionnaire which must be partial to get
in depth perception of employees. All elements which turn to biases have been
considered during development of the survey questionnaire. For example a few
questions are related to the positive impacts of change on individuals in which
respondents may provide expressly emotional behaviour. However, negative aspects of
questions are also employed to express the response. Such balance in the questionnaire
may provide reliability and validate data for this research.
103
Table 5.5 Survey Questionnaire Items Relations with the Hypotheses and
Variables
Hypothesis Variables Relevant
Questions Items
Background Questions
Demography
Q. 1 to 8
Employee Readiness for Change
Employee Readiness
Q. 9 to 22
H1: There is a significant positive relationship between emotional attachment and employee readiness for organisational change
Emotional Attachment
Q. 23 to 25
H2: There is a significant positive relationship between feeling of pride and employee readiness for organisational change
Feeling of Pride
Q. 26 to 28
H3: There is a significant positive relationship between personal sense of obligation and employee readiness for organisational change
H4: There is a significant positive relationship between pay/wages/rewards and employee readiness for organisational change
H5: There is a significant positive relationship between career commitment and employee readiness for organisational change
Personal Sense of Obligation Pay/Wages/Rewards Career Commitment
Q. 29 to 31 Q. 32 to 36 Q. 37 to 44
H6: There is a significant positive relationship between promotions and employee readiness for organisational change
H7: There is a significant positive relationship between job satisfaction and employee readiness for organisational change
H8: There is a significant positive relationship between job involvement and employee readiness for organisational change H9: There is a significant positive relationships between supervisor and peer relations and employee readiness for
Promotion Job Satisfaction Job Involvement Supervisor and Peer Relations
Q. 45 to 47 Q. 48 to 54 Q. 55 to 59 Q. 60 to 65
104
organisational change
H10: There is a significant relationship between training and skills development and employee readiness for organisational change
H11: There is significant relationships between social relationships in the workplace and employee readiness for organisational change
Training and Skills Development Social Relationships in the workplace
Q. 66 to 70 Q. 71 – 74
5.4.2 Measurement Scales
In this research, independent and dependent variables were used to measure the
employee attitudes, behaviours, beliefs, and perception regarding their readiness for
organisational change. Readiness for change variable was served as a dependent
variable, and employee commitment to the organisation and career and social
relationships in the workplace factors served as independent variables. In addition, other
variables were included such as gender, age range, marital status, present employment
status, highest educational level, and number of dependents, years in present job and
years with present employer. In this study, four existing scales were adopted: readiness
for organisational change, employee commitment to the organisation, employee career
commitment, and social relationships in the workplace. These adapted scales were
tested by a pilot study from faculty members in higher education in Pakistan, who are
pursuing doctor of philosophy (PhD) studies in United Kingdom (UK). Personal visits
and email contacts were made to the participants to participate in the survey. The
purpose of the pilot study was to enable the researcher to identify poor wording in
questions and time taken to complete the survey. After measuring the reliability and
validity of the instrument, it was applied to collect data for the main study from faculty
members of higher educational institutions in Pakistan.
5.4.2.1 Independent Variables
To assess individual attitudes, behaviours, beliefs, and perceptions, the following
independent variables of employees’ commitment to the organisation and career and
social relationships in the workplace were selected.
105
Emotional attachment (EMAT)
Three-item scale developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and factor analysis conducted by
Mathews and Shepherd (2002) with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree,
Strongly Agree) was applied.
Feeling of pride (FOPR)
Three-item scale developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and factor analysis conducted by
Mathews and Shepherd (2002) with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree,
Strongly Agree) was applied.
Personal sense of obligation (PSO)
Three-item scale developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and factor analysis conducted by
Mathews and Shepherd (2002) with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree,
Strongly Agree) was applied.
Pay/Wages/Rewards (PAWA)
Pay/wages/rewards were measured by applying a five-item scale with a five-point
Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree to Strongly Agree) from Price and Muller (1986)
modified by Yoon and Thye (2002).
Career Commitment (CACO)
Eight items with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly Agree) from
Blau (1985) was used to measure the employees’ career commitment.
Promotion (PMTN)
Three items with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly Agree) was
used by Chang (1999) based on Gaertner and Nollen (1989) study used to measure the
employee’s perception about promotion within the university.
Job Satisfaction (JOSA)
Seven items with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly Agree) from
Brayfield and Rothe (1951) used to measure the employee’s job satisfaction.
106
Job Involvement (JOIN)
By using Blau (1985) a five-item scale based on Kanungo’s (1982) study was used to
measure the job involvement with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly
Agree).
Supervisor and Peer Relations (SPRE)
Six well-known items with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly
Agree) concerning the employee’s perception of supervisor support and advice on the
employee’s career measured from Gaertner and Nollen (1989) was applied.
Training and Skills Development (TSDE)
This variable measured by four items (where three items were applied by Chang (1999))
based on Gaertner and Nollen (1989) with a five-point Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree,
Strongly Agree) and one item was developed by the researcher.
Social Relationships in the Workplace (SORE)
A four-item with five-point (Strongly Disagree to Strongly Agree) scale was used to
measure social relationships in the workplace. The scale was adapted from the five-item
relationships subscales of Hanpachern’s Revised Margin in Life scale (1998), which
itself had been modified from the original published survey by Stevenson in 1982. The
four items for this scale were extracted from a Revised Margin in Life scale with eight
subscales, one of which was social relationships in the workplace.
Demography
The participant would be asked to tick the appropriate box in the demographic section
of the questionnaire. Demographics included gender, age range, marital status, present
employment status, highest educational level, number of dependents, years in their
present job and years with present employer.
5.4.2.2 Dependent Variable
Readiness for Organisational Change (ROCH)
Fourteen items applied by Madsen et al. (2005) based on Hanpachern’s original
fourteen-item Readiness for Change Scale (with slightly alterations), which was based
107
in part on McNabb and Sepic (1995). Participants were asked to tick one of seven
numbers on a Likert scale (1 = Very Unlikely and 7 = Very Likely).
5.4.3 Data Triangulation
Data triangulation refers to the use of more than one form of data in order to enhance
confidence in findings. In social and behavioural sciences research, it is found as a
source of reducing bias. Thus, it is important to retrieve more than one data that can
strengthen the object to process the facts for appropriate results. Flick (2002) reveals
that validation of data can be done by triangulation tools because it is collected by more
than one source. There are five types of triangulation.
i. Data triangulation: refers to the variety of data at different times and social
situations used in the study.
ii. Investigator triangulation: refers to collecting the same data type from a
single source by several researchers.
iii. Theory triangulation: refers to interpreting the same data set with multiple
perspectives.
iv. Methodological triangulation: refers to use of multiple research strategies for
a single problem.
v. Interdisciplinary triangulation: refers to investigate more than one discipline
issues.
In this research to make more reliable and validate findings, data triangulation was
applied. The researcher applied different sources of data like theory triangulation which
refers the same set of data from multiple perspectives. Thus, the survey questionnaire
applied in this research is contained in different sections which were correlated with
desired objects. This questionnaire comprises five sections which were interpreted with
multiple perspectives like employees commitment to the organisation and career
variables relates to employee readiness for organisational change or demographic
variables to the readiness for organisational change. In addition, the researcher
employed documents, newspaper archives and other written sources of data which could
be synthesised to compare with survey data. By employing these sources the researcher
could increase the reliability and validity of findings.
108
5.5 Pilot Study
In business research study, a pilot study is a very common exercise before carrying out
a survey questionnaire. According to Ticehurst and Veal (2000, p-151), a pilot study is
important (Table 5.6 below).
Table 5.6 Purpose of the Pilot Survey
ID Purpose Applicable
1 Testing questionnaire wording Yes
2 Testing questionnaire sequencing Yes
3 Testing questionnaire layout Yes
4 Gaining familiarity with respondent No
5 Testing fieldwork requirement No
6 Testing and training fieldworkers No
7 Estimating response rate Yes
8 Estimating questionnaire completion time Yes
9 Testing analysis procedure Yes
Source: Adapted from Ticehurst and Veal (2000, p-151)
A pilot study is common practice in business research for developing the instrument
which shows the survey instrument reliability and validity. Initially, for assessing
reliability of the instrument, Cronbach’s alpha was analysed and face validity of the
survey questionnaire was done through field experts. In this connection, a few surveys
were sent to university professors and research experts for confirming the face validity.
Through that, the study researcher is able to fine-tune questions, ensure accuracy of
language and responses. According to Kriel (2006, p-109), pre-testing allows the testing
of most aspects of the questionnaire with respect to time taken, ease of completion and
ease of data collection.
5.6 Research Protocol
Research protocol is an essential part of research which describes the methods,
procedures and general rules followed for data collection. It is an instrument which is
109
concerned with systematic review and a piece of original research (Holloway and
Mooney, 2004). Through this instrument, it was ensured that the research study was
smoothly and successfully conducted. Indeed, the use of this instrument is to gather
reliable data. According to Remenyi et al. (1998), a research protocol is important to
increase the consistency of data collection and focus the process of data collection. For
developing a research protocol, Holloway and Mooney (2004) described several stages
including: an introduction, aims and objectives of the study, hypotheses, setting and the
calculation of sample size, research methodology and design, methods used in the
statistical analysis, and study schedule. For details refer to next chapter.
5.7 Planned Research Study Schedule
Table 5.7 Time Schedule for the Research Study
Study Phase Activity Period
Pilot Study
Apply for ethical approval
Contact with participants for their consent
Send the survey instrument to participants
Data coding, entry and cleaning and data
analysis
Writing pilot study results
May, 08
June, 08
June, 08
July, 08
August, 08
Main Study
Contact with participants for their consent
Send the survey instrument to participants
Data coding, entry and cleaning
Data analysis
Writing main study results and
conclusions
Thesis submission
September, 08
September to November, 08
December to January, 09
February to April, 09
May to August, 09
November, 09
110
5.8 Reliability and Validity
Reliability of the research is concerned with the credibility of data collection. Reliability
demonstrates procedures, focuses on the accuracy of measurement and the ability to
repeat the research. If the same procedure is to be repeated, findings must be same.
Thus, it is well known as repeatability and consistency over time. According to Yen
(1994), the extent to which the research is replicable and the research findings can be
repeated determines the reliability of a research study. Robson (1993) described subject
error and bias and observer error and bias threats which may affect data reliability.
Subject error is concerned with the neutral time and date to carry out the data, while
subject bias is related to the pressure of authority to say what they want. Observer error
is concerned with the structure of the instrument, while observer bias is related to how
the data collector interprets the instrument.
In this research, a positivist approach has been adopted which is an efficient way to
collect data for specific variables of interest (Collis and Hussey, 2003). The survey
questionnaire was developed to get data from public sector higher educational
institution employees. All participants are well qualified because the appointment
requirement is at least a Masters’ degree in the country. Contact addresses and numbers
were given in covering letter if participants encountered any problem (Appendix 2). It
was assured that data would be confidential that can reduce the subject bias. Since the
questionnaire was designed in a survey format it did not face any observer error or bias.
Furthermore, items of the survey instrument reliability could be measured by the
internal consistency method (Hussey and Hussey, 1997). This study applied Cronbach’s
coefficient alpha to measure the internal reliability of survey. Further the survey was
assessed by senior experts which is also a well-known method applied to measure
internal consistency of survey questionnaire.
Validity of the research is concerned with the extent of research findings which
represent what is really happening (Collis and Hussey 2003). There are two ways to
establish the validity such that internal and external. By internal validity, the researcher
establishes the phenomena and develops the confidence with which inferences about
real life experience can be made (Reige, 2003). External validity is concerned with the
generalisability of certain findings. For this approach, replication logic would be used
111
for the questionnaire survey. By means of replication, a theory can be tested a second or
even more times and the same results should occur (Yin, 1994, p-35; Lincoln and Guba,
1985, p-291). According to Cresswell (2003, p-171), external validity threats occur
when the experimenter draws incorrect inferences from the sample data to other
persons, other settings and past or future situations. Construct validity establishes
measures for the theoretical concepts adopted by researchers in which it can be assured
that constructs are closely aligned to their real life context (Yin, 1994).
In this research, the survey questionnaire was used for data collection whose validity
was assessed in two ways. According to Belson (1986, p-534-535), first, whether
respondents who completed questionnaires did so accurately, and second, whether those
who fail to return their questionnaires would have given the same distribution of
answers as did the returnees. In the positivistic paradigm, validity remains in danger of
being low, as compared to phenomenological paradigm, because it focuses on the
precision of measurement (Hussey and Hussey, 1997). The danger of low validity in
this research is constrained due to methods and theories used and tested frequently by
prominent researchers (Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and
Simons, 2006). According to Hussey and Hussey (1997), generalisability is the extent to
which conclusions can be made about one thing based on information about another. If
a question can be misunderstood, the information is said to be of low validity. In order
to avoid low validity a pilot study was conducted before full scale data collection.
Through the pilot study the time horizon was measured and language or any other
misconceptions were removed.
5.9 Main Study
Main study was followed by pilot study in which reliability and validity of survey
instrument was assessed and confirmed. The main study was conducted in public sector
higher educational institutions of Pakistan. In this section, the discussion about
population and sample, targeted samples and the data collection procedure has been
defined.
112
5.9.1 Population and Sampling
Population is a set of all elements (Gilbert, 2001). From the population samples were
selected in an attempt to collect data that can be representative of the whole target
population. Sampling is important for an empirical study that uses a positivistic
approach (Hussey and Hussey, 1997). It is a fraction of subjects drawn from a
population. Sekaran (2006) reveals that sampling offers detailed information that deal
with small number of units. For this empirical study, a random sampling has been done
from faculty members of public higher education institutions in Pakistan.
This study was conducted in higher educational institutions of Pakistan. Only faculty
members of public sector universities were included in the study, where, recently, the
government has announced changes for faculty members of public sector universities.
The total population of public sector universities in Pakistan is 10,471 in all sixty eight
public sector universities (HEC, no date a). It was decided to restrict the population
sample for two main reasons: time and distance. To maintain anonymity the name of
universities has not been identified. The population for this study included full time
teaching employees of higher education institutions in Pakistan. In this study, all
categories of faculty members (professors, associate professors, assistant professors,
and lecturers) were involved proportionately. This proportion can reduce the bias of
data and also increase the anonymity of different categories of members. Before sending
the survey questionnaire to participants, the researcher contacted them for any queries
regarding the instrument and privacy. Then the survey questionnaire was handed over
either by personal visits or sent by post or email. Addresses and contact numbers of
faculty members were obtained from the higher education commission web site and the
respective university web sites or personal visits to universities. A postal or electronic
mailing survey questionnaire packet contained the questionnaire and a covering letter
prepared by the supervisors of the study.
5.9.1.1 Targeted Samples
The targeted participants of the main survey were faculty members of higher
educational institutions of Pakistan. Only public sector universities from all over the
country where 10,471 teaching faculty members in all sixty eight universities are
113
working were involved. In this study a large sample of the population was selected from
all categories of employees. The main reason for selecting a large sample was the
requirement for chosen analysis techniques such that confirmatory factor analysis and
multi-variances analysis (Powpaka, 1998). Questions include readiness for
organisational change, employee commitment to the organisation, employee career
commitment, social relationships in the workplace and demographic information were
answered by all categories of faculty members.
As discussed in the previous section, survey research is one of the most established
ways of collecting data. It became popular due to its convenience of handling during
World War I and II and grew steadily since the 1970s (Neuman, 1995; Hussey and
Hussey, 1997). Researchers who use survey questionnaires rely on highly structured
questionnaires. The present study was cross sectional and conducted in higher education
institutions where data was collected appropriately by the survey questionnaire method
and covered a large population in the sample.
5.9.2 Data Collection Procedure
The researcher started the procedure by contacting a randomly selected sample of the
population to ask for their willingness to participate in the research study and any
queries regarding the instrument and privacy (Appendix 3). After getting consent from
the participants, a set of survey questionnaire along covering letter prepared by the
supervisors of the study were handed over by personal visits or sent by postal or email.
Robson (1993) describes subject error and bias which is concerned with a neutral time
and date to carry out data collection, while subject bias is related to the pressure of
authority to say what they want. By adopting this procedure, any bias in data collection
was minimised. All the contact numbers and addresses of the participants were collected
from the higher education commission or respective university web site or personal
visits to universities.
After two weeks, the researcher contacted participants reminding them to respond. This
procedure was followed three times. However, after a third reminder, participants who
did not respond were excluded from the study.
114
In survey research, a probability sampling method is generally more appropriate than a
non probability one because ‘the resulting sample is likely to provide a representative
cross section of the whole (Denscombe, 2002, p-12). Furthermore, researchers can make
unambiguous statements about ‘the accuracy and validity of the findings from the
survey by reference to the degree of error or bias which may be present in it as
measured by well understood statistical methods’ (Baker, 2002, p-106).
Several constraints were faced by the researcher while collecting this data from all over
the country. The law and order situation in urban as well as rural areas confined the
researcher to collecting the survey through personal visits. Shortage of electricity
disturbed the participants in responding to the survey by email. Thus, the response rate
by email was very small. At the time of conducting the main study, most universities
were closed due to the winter vacation. Thus, it took more time to collect responses.
However, the response rate was above fifty per cent which is satisfactory for the
research. Finally, a small number of questionnaire packets were sent out again due to
the loss during delivery. The researcher ended the survey 16 weeks after the first
distribution.
5.9.3 Data Coding, Cleaning and Entry
Coding of data involves translating entries on the questionnaire to letters or numbers. It
is necessary to establish guides for translating responses. After coding the data, it was
processed for easy recording. Data recording involves transferring information from
questionnaires or code sheets to computer files for processing purposes. In fact, this is
an easy way to find objectives from the data. But the researcher has to be sure to avoid
errors during processing the data. To overcome human errors data must be cleaned
which involves double checking the data entries on the computer files, particularly if
there are large numbers of respondents.
5.10 Data Analysis Techniques and Statistical Packages
The analysis of data for the main study consists of three major stages. In the first stage,
the content and the relevance of the multi-item scales were refined on the basis of
quantitative data gathered from the different population samples. In the second, scales
115
were validated using confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) via structural equation
modelling (SEM). Lastly, hypotheses were tested using analysis of moment structure
(AMOS) 16.0 version software in structural equation model. In this section, the features
of each technique will be discussed and the rationale for the selection of these
techniques will be provided.
Before conducting the main study, a pilot study was conducted to find the reliability of
multi item scale development. A Cronbach’s coefficient alpha (α) was applied to check
the reliability of scales in the pilot study (Carmines and Zeller, 1979; Peter, 1979;
Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). In addition, face validity of the survey questionnaire was
done through field experts. In this connection, a few surveys were sent to university
professors for confirming the face validity. Moreover, for the main study survey
questionnaire reliability and validity was assessed by applying exploratory factor
analysis followed by confirmatory factor analysis. In order to assess the validity of
scale, a confirmatory factor analysis was performed on the main survey data before
structural model testing (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Anderson and Gerbing,
1988; Hair et al., 2006). However, construct validity of the questionnaire was assessed
by composite validity, Cronbach’s alpha reliability, and average variance extracted
methods. Finally, the relationship between constructs was tested by analysis of moment
structure (AMOS) though structural equation modelling (SEM).
The treatment of missing data, descriptive statistics, outlier examination, linearity test,
normality of data, homoscedasticity, exploratory factor analysis and reliability analysis
tests was carried out by using statistical package for social sciences (SPSS) 15.0 version
for Windows (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006). However, analysis of
moment structure (AMOS) 16.0 versions software was used to perform both the
confirmatory factor analysis and the structural model testing (Hair et al., 2006).
5.10.1 Exploratory Factor Analysis and Reliability Assessment
Exploratory factor analysis is a method of factor loading into groups to extract
underlying latent factors. It is technique used for “take what the data gives you” and
involves grouping variables together on a factor or the precise number of factors (Hair
et al., 2006, p-104). It is widely used in social science research to identify the latent
116
factors and summarising and reducing a large set of observed variables to a smaller
number of factors that account for co-variation (Hair et al., 2006; Tabachnick and
Fidell, 2007). In this domain this technique is effective for further testing of structural
models (Hair et al., 2006; Joreskog and Sorbom, 1996). Initially, this study applied
exploratory factor analysis to take data in a group for a factor and then apply
confirmatory factor analysis techniques to confirm the group of measurement variables
related to the factor for examining the hypotheses. The existence of clusters of large
correlation coefficients between subsets of variables suggests that those variables could
be measuring aspects of the same underlying dimension (Field, 2006, p-620).
The researcher applied exploratory factor analysis SPSS version 15.0 for Windows to
extract factors in which numerous methods are available for factor extraction and
rotation. Among these, the principal component extract method which is the most
common and default in SPSS programme was used to extract minimum set of variables
accounted for the maximum variance in the data (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). Several
ways are available to assess the adequacy of extraction and the number of factors but
most the common are Eigenvalues greater than one and Scree plot. Before going to
extract factors, it is important to calculate the variability in scores (the variance) for any
given measures (or variables) (Field, 2006). According to Heir et al. (2007, p-102),
communality is the total amount of variance an original variable shares with all other
variables included in the analysis. A variable that has no variance would have a
communality of 1; a variable that shares nothing with other variables would have a
communality of 0 (Field, 2006, p-630). Communality can be calculated from factor
loading in which a model containing multiple constructs with communalities of less
than .5 are required and for a larger sample size less than .7 is required (Heir et al.,
2007). This research applied variables with a communality value above .5.
In order to achieve the best possible interpretation of the factors, the varimax rotation
method was used. Rotation is important to select for improving the interpretability and
scientific utility of the solution. It is used to maximise high correlations between factors
and variables and minimise low ones. Rotation means discriminating between factors
exactly where it implies (Hair et al., 2006). This study applies a varimax of orthogonal
techniques which is most commonly used in rotation for maximising variance.
According to Tabachnick and Fidell (2007, p-620) the goal of varimax rotation is to
117
maximize the variance of factor loading by making high loadings higher and low ones
lower for each factor. The factor loadings above +/- .50 were considered practically
significant (Hair et al., 2006).
In this study for reliability assessment, Cronbach’s alpha technique was applied to the
factors derived from the exploratory factor analysis to test the internal consistency of
factors (Churchill, 1979; Peter, 1979; Litwin, 1995; De Vaus, 2002). Result values
equal to or above 0.70 were considered to be an acceptable level of reliability
(Nunnally, 1978; De Vaus, 2002).
5.10.2 Confirmatory Factor Analysis and Scale Validity
Confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) is a technique usually employed to confirm a priori
hypotheses about the relationship between a set of measurement items and their
respective factors (Netemeyer et al., 2003, p-148). It is used to test whether the pre-
specified relationships on the basis of the theory are present in the data (Hair et al.,
2006). It is the number of common factors or latent constructs needed to account for the
correlation among observed variables. Factor analysis, indeed, reveals underlying
dimensions at which variables seem grouped together in a meaningful way. This could
be achieved by looking for variables that correlate highly with a group of other
variables, but do not correlate with variables outside that group (Field, 2006, p-621).
The validity of a construct is an essential condition for further theory testing and
development (Carmines and Zeller, 1979; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991). Thus,
confirmatory factor analysis is used as a stricter assessment of construct validity to
ensure that the theoretical meaning of a construct is empirically captured by its
indicators (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991). It is generally used to test
the uni-dimensionality of a scale which is important for two reasons. First, the
calculation of coefficient alpha (an indicator of reliability) is meaningful only for a uni-
dimensional set of items (Cortina, 1993; Clark and Watson, 1995). Second, the
calculation of composite scores to be used in a covariance structure model or other type
of analysis is appropriate when individual items are uni-dimensional (Floyd and
Widaman, 1995; Neuberg et al., 1997). According to Netemeyer et al. (2003, p-26), if
118
any individual items are not uni-dimensional, the summed (composite) score will also
contain the effect of other factors on which the item loaded.
5.10.2.1 Scale validity
Scale validity refers to the extent to which an operational measure truly reflects the
concept being investigated or the extent to which the latent construct is the underlying
cause of item co-variation (De Vellis, 2003, p-49). Thus, it is essential to finalise the
measurement scale in the research. Four types of validity applied by Netemeyer et al.
(2003) and Morgan et al. (2004) for assessment have been used in this study.
1) Content validity – the extent to which the elements of measurement scales are
relevant to and representative of the targeted construct for a particular
assessment purpose.
2) Face validity – an assessment that items of a scale adequately measure the
construct of interest.
3) Convergent validity – the extent to which independent measures of the same
construct converge or are highly correlated.
4) Discriminant validity – the extent to which constructs diverge from the other
operationalisations for which the construct is conceptually distinct.
All these steps were observed for confirming the validity of scale in this research.
Content and face validity was assessed in the pilot study in which fifty participants were
asked about the items. In addition, the instrument was assessed through experts or field
researchers in the university (Hardesty and Bearden, 2004) at the initial stage of
research. Experts were asked to comment on the lists of scale items. Third and fourth
such that convergent and discriminant validity were assessed by confirmatory factor
analysis (Anderson and Gerbings, 1988, p-416). Convergent validity (CV) can be
assessed by an item’s own reliability, composite reliability, and average variance
extracted (Anderson and Gerbings, 1988; Babin et al., 2000). In addition, convergent
validity can be assessed by examining whether the factor loading of items (such that
pattern coefficient) in their respective constructs are large (equal to or greater than 0.5)
and statistical significant (Joreskog and Sorbom, 1996).
119
Construct validity examines validity by investigating the measurement item to see if it
reflects the latent construct which it is designed to measure. Discriminant validity (DV)
is one part of assessing construct validity in confirmatory factor analysis. It is the extent
to which a construct is truly distinct from another construct (Hair et al., 2006, P-778).
By using average variance extracted, discriminant validity can be measured (Fornell and
Larcker, 1981 and Hair et al., 2006).
5.10.3 Structural Equation Modelling and Assessment of Model Fit
Structural equation modelling is a technique that allows a set of relationships between
independent variables (either continuous or discrete) and dependent variables.
According to Hair et al. (2006, p-22) structural equation modelling provides the
appropriate and most efficient estimation technique for a series of separate multiple
regression equations estimated simultaneously. It is developed by two components such
that the measurement model and structural model which aims to find overall model fit
as to confirm the consistency of a theoretical model and the estimated model
(Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Hair et al., 2006; Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). In
statistics, many methods are available to develop overall model fit on the basis of both
incremental and absolute goodness of fit measures. Diamantopoulos and Siguaw (2000,
p-83) state that sample size, estimation procedure, model complexity, violation of
underlying assumptions of multivariate normality and variable independence can be
superior to others under different conditions. This study applied model testing using two
separate stages as recommended by Anderson and Gerbing (1982; 1988). One stage is
structural model testing that shows the casual relationships between latent constructs
(Chau, 1997; Anderson and Gerbing, 1988; Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000). Before
going to this stage, developing the measurement model is essential to confirm the
relationships between a construct and its indicators. This model is assisted by
confirmatory factor analysis (Chau, 1997; Anderson and Gerbing, 1988;
Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000). In order to assess measurement scales through
construct validity the following criteria should be assessed: 1) unidimensionality of a
construct (Anderson and Gerbing, 1988; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991), 2) reliability, 3)
120
convergent validity, 4) discriminant validity, 5) nomological validity (Anderson and
Gerbing, 1988; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991; Peter, 1981).
Uni-dimensionality of a construct should be achieved before any attempt at further
theory testing (Anderson and Gerbing, 1988) since it demonstrates that the multiple
indicators of a construct are internally consistent and externally distinct from other
measures. CFA ensures that a construct is uni-dimensional so that it is composed of a
set of logical (theoretical) indicators (Hair et al., 2006; Hattie, 1985) (more details in
CFA section of this chapter). Nomological validity refers to the examination of the
hypothesised relationships between a construct and the empirical links between
indicators and their underlying dimensions (Peter, 1981; Peter and Churchill, 1986). In
addition, utilisation of the goodness of fit indices is useful for assessing nomological
validity. The remaining factor is referred in the previous section.
After estimating the measurement model, the structural model is applied to show the
casual relationships among the variables. The overall fit of the structural model
confirms the consistency of a theoretical model and the estimated model which is based
on the observed values (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Hair et al., 2006). In
statistics, there are so many methods to test the overall model fit, however no one
method can provide an absolute assurance of model fit. Kline (1998, p-130)
recommended at least four tests such that chi-square; GFI, NFI, or CFI; NNFI; and
SRMR. However, most common fit indices are chi-square (χ2), Goodness of Fit Index
(GFI), Adjusted Goodness of Fit Index (AGFI), and Root Mean Square Error
Approximation (RMSEA).
The chi-square statistics (χ2) is the most common fit test in structural equation
modelling. Diamantopoulos and Siguaw (2000, p-83) state that it is a test of perfection,
in which the null hypothesis is that the model fits the population data perfectly. In this
test the null hypothesis is rejected when it is statistically significant. Chi-square value is
computed as (N – 1) Fmin where N is the sample size, Fmin is the value of the fitting
function and the relevant degree of freedom calculates as ½ k (k + 1) – t, where k is a
number of observed variables and t is the number of parameters to be estimated
(Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000, p-83). In AMOS software, the results of chi-square
test shows in the form of CMIN (minimum discrepancy).
121
Goodness of fit index is a measure of the relative amount of variance and covariance. It
is a non statistical measure which indicates the overall degree of fit (Hair et al., 2006). It
compares the squared residuals predicted with the observed value. The possible range of
GFI value is 0 to 1 with higher values indicating better fit (Hair et al., 2006, p-747).
Values ranging from .80 to .89 are indicative of reasonable fit (Doll et al., 1994).
Values between .90 and 1.00 are considered to be a good fit (Diamantopoulos and
Siguaw, 2000).
The adjusted goodness of fit index (AGFI) is an extended version of GFI that is adjusted
by the ratio between the degree of freedom for the proposed model and the degree of
freedom available (Hair et al., 2006, p-747). Value .90 or above are considered to be a
good fit and ranging from .80 to .89 are considered to be a reasonable fit (Doll et al.,
1994; Hair et al., 2006).
Incremental fit measures compare the fit of the targeted model with a null model in
which the variables are uncorrelated (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Hair et al.,
2006). Some of the most common incremental fit measures are normated fit index
(NFI), non normated fit index (NNFI) and normated comparative fit index (CFI).
The normated fit index compares the base model with the suggested model without
considering the degree of freedom. It is computed as (χ2 null - χ2 proposed)/χ2 null
where χ2 is chi-square value (Hair et al., 2006). It can have values between 0 and 1.
Even though there is not an absolute threshold value, .90 and above is mostly
recommended as an indication of good fit (Hair et al., 2006).
The non-normated fit index (NNFI) compares the null and the proposed model by
taking the degree of freedom of both models into consideration. It is calculated as [(χ2
null / df null) – (χ2 proposed / df proposed)] / (χ2 null / df null) where χ2 is chi-square
value and df is degree of freedom (Hair et al., 2006). Unlike all the indices in
incremental fit indices, NNFI take greater than 1.0 (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000).
However, the recommended level of good fit value is the same (.90 and above is as
accepted good fit) (Doll et al., 1994; Hair et al., 2006).
122
The normated comparative fit index (CFI) is another relative fit index which is more
appropriate when analysis is run on a smaller sample size (Hair et al., 2006). Value 0.90
and above are usually considered to be a good fit (Murller, 1996).
In this thesis, the two-step approaches such that measurement and structural model was
adopted. This was suggested by Anderson and Gerbing (1988) in which first model such
that structural model was preceded by the estimation of the measurement model. This
model approach allows the researcher to establish valid constructs to be put into further
theory testing to prove casual relationships between them. Second model is structural
equation model which confirm the pre specified links between the endogenous and
exogenous variables and is running a simulated multiple regression analysis (Hair et al.,
2006).
5.10.4 Hypotheses Testing
After the development and validation of measurement scales, the hypotheses were tested
using the structural equation model (SEM). To predict the output of variables structural
equation modelling is seen as the most robust method in social science and
psychological domain. It is an appropriate and widely used method for investigating the
relationship between a dependent variable and two or more independent variables due to
its well developed underlying statistical theory (Motgomery et al., 2001, p-xii; Hair et
al., 2006). Based on the structural model, the research hypotheses were tested from the
standardised estimate and t value (critical ratio). For data analysis, the researcher
employed AMOS 16.0 for Windows software to examine the model for the hypotheses.
According to Cohen et al. (2000, p-117-124 and Hair et al. (2006), the following
assumption were examined.
1. Descriptive statistics (including the examination of potential outliers) – this
is to give an overview about the aggregated data to be employed in the
analysis. The investigation of potential outliers is particularly important
because their existence may distort an estimation of regression coefficients
and representation of the relationships in a sample (Hair et al., 2006, p-220).
For this outliers were examined in SPSS 15.0 for Windows (Next Chapter).
123
2. Multi-collinearity – this refers to the relationship between two (collinearity)
or more (multi-collinearity) independent variables in a regression model.
Ideally it is desirable to have a number of independent variables highly
correlated with the dependent variable, but with little correlation among
them. When there is a substantial degree of multi-collinearity, the process for
separating the effects of independent variables becomes more difficult. In
other words, it makes the consideration of the contribution of each
independent variable difficult because the effects of independent variables
are confounded. To diagnose this potential problem the researcher employed
SPSS 15.0 for Windows to compare the condition index and variance
inflation factor (VIF) of the model with suggested threshold values (Hair et
al., 2006).
3. Normality of Residuals – for any value of independent variable X, the
residuals around the regression line are assumed to be normally distributed.
The violation of the normality assumption will affect the statistical
significance tests especially in small samples. Furthermore, the normality of
the residuals often is a signal of other problems in the regression model such
as misspecification (using an incorrect regression model) (Cohen et al.,
2000, p-120). Kurtosis and Skewness test (Field, 2006; Tabachnick and
Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006), Kolmogorov and Shapiro method test (Field,
2006) and histogram of all variables data along with normality distribution
also normal Q-Q plot of data was used to assess the normality of
residuals(Next Chapter).
4. Homoscedasticity – for any value of an independent variable X,
homoscedasticity refers to the condition whereby conditional variance of the
residuals around the regression line is constant (Lewis-Beck, 1993, p-18).
Conditional variances represent the variability of the residuals around the
predicted value for a specified value of X. Homoscedasticity is an essential
assumption because its violation will lead to incorrect estimations of the
standard errors as well as significant tests. In this study, the researcher used
Levene’s test of homogeneity of variance in SPSS 15.0 for the Windows to
confirm the results of variability of dependent variables with independent
variables (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007).
124
After important assumption had been evaluated, the researcher tested the significance of
parameters estimated (e.g. overall model fit, significance of coefficient, etc.) and
interpreted the results accordingly.
5.11 Ethical Consideration
Ethical issues play an important role when research is to be conducted among human
subjects. According to Neuman (1995), the researcher must protect human rights, guide
them and supervise the interests of people. Christians (2000) stated the minimum
considerations such that informed consent, privacy and confidentiality, and accuracy. In
this research, all ethical requirements were followed throughout all phases of the
research. Before collecting data, permission was granted by the relevant organisations.
Addresses of faculty members were obtained from university websites or from the
administration of the respective organisation. The survey questionnaire along with
supervisors’ letter was provided by personal visits or post or email addresses. The
participants were asked to participate voluntarily and given the chance to withdraw from
participation if they chose to do so. Participants were told that answering and returning
the questionnaire assumed their consent to participate in this study. All participants
were assured that anonymity and confidentiality of the responses was guaranteed. Also,
the participants were told not to write their names on the questionnaires and data was
coded to ensure anonymity and confidentiality throughout the research process.
Brunel University Ethics Committee guided the issues in this study, which adhered to
the expectations of the Ethics Committee. According to the Ethics Policy Guidelines, a
Brunel Business School Research Ethics Form must be signed by researcher and
followed by the research supervisor. This form was signed by the researcher and
supervisors which were submitted to the academic programme office. Moreover, a
consent form was attached with the questionnaires which described the title of research
study, the researcher and school name, purpose of the research, and what was involved
in participation in a way that could be clearly understood by the respondents prior to
filling in the questionnaire (Appendix 3).
125
5.12 Conclusion
This chapter provides the rationale behind the combination of two important research
paradigms such that positivists and phenomenological. In this regard, a philosophical
stance of both paradigms has been developed in this chapter. It is observed that attitudes
and behaviours of individual can be measured by a positivist approach. Thus, many
researchers in the domain of business performance and strategic management have
applied a positivist approach. Therefore, a positivist approach was considered to be an
appropriate approach for this research. Data for this study was collected from
employees of higher educational institutions of Pakistan through a survey questionnaire.
The survey instrument is structured in five sections such that ‘employee readiness for
organisational change’, ‘employee commitment to the organisation’, ‘employee career
commitment’, ‘social relationships in the workplace’ along with ‘demographic
questions’, which include information about gender, age , marital status, present
employment status, highest educational level, number of dependents, years in their
present job, and years with present employer. A pilot study was conducted to measure
the reliability and validity of the questionnaire before the actual full scale study. Details
of practical considerations such as sampling and participation, measurement scales and
data analysis procedure were also discussed in this chapter. Upon completion of the
study, the data was cleaned, coded and entered on to the statistical package for social
sciences (SPSS) version 15.0 for Windows. Analytical techniques included descriptive
statistics and exploratory factor analysis was discussed briefly. After exploratory factor
analysis, factors were confirmed via confirmatory factor analysis on the basis of
structural equation modelling (SEM). It is used as a stricter assessment of construct
validity to ensure that the theoretical meaning of a construct was empirically captured
by its indicators. Then an assessment of model fit of the study by AMOS 16.0 version
of software and tested hypotheses was discussed. The researcher discussed the
measurement model at the individual level and used the maximum likelihood estimation
procedure for all structural models. Five goodness of fit indices were revealed to assess
the model fit of measurement models such that Chi-square (χ2); root mean square error
of approximation (RMSEA); goodness of fit index (GFI); non-normated fit index
(NNFI); and comparative fit index (CFI). Finally the ethical issues involved in this
study were also presented.
126
Chapter Six Pilot Study
6.1 Introduction
This pilot study began by measuring the reliability of the survey questionnaire, which
was to be applied for data collection in the main field study. The conceptual framework
of this study was developed on the basis of employee commitment to the organisation,
career commitment, and social relationships in the workplace factors to examine the
employee attitudes and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. In this pilot
study, five main scales such that employee readiness for organisational change,
employee commitment to the organisation, employee career commitment, social
relationships in the workplace and demographic factors were tested. A pilot study is a
common practice in business research to assess the survey instrument reliability. In this
connection fifty survey questionnaires were sent to university employees who are doing
PhD studies in the United Kingdom (UK). The reliability of the survey instrument was
computed by applying Cronbach’s coefficient alpha and inter-correlations of scales was
measured by Pearson’s correlations. In this study a research protocol was developed to
ensure systematic review and to show original work. Before analysing the pilot study
the data research protocol is defined as follows
6.2 Research Protocol
Research protocol requires a defined arrangement of the study. In business research, it is
an important tool which can be used to establish the systematic review and new piece of
research. This instrument may ensure successful and smooth run of the study. In
research, building research protocol is one of the difficult tasks but need several stages
such that study introduction, aim and objectives, hypotheses, setting and the calculation
of sample size, research methodology and design, methods used in the statistical
analysis, and study schedule (Holloway and Mooney, 2004).
6.2.1 Introduction
In the history of organisational development, change has been thought of as an
important factor in the development of organisations. The pace of change has increased
127
to deal with increasing challenges such as competition, technology, communication,
development, general instability, mergers, and reengineering. Such challenges emerged
rapidly during the emergence of the global economy in the late 1980s and 1990s. The
past few decades have been seen increasingly rapid advances in the field of change
management mainly focused on the issues of effective and successful implementation of
changes. This requires proper handling of the situation because of human involvement
that can develop uncertainties and ambiguities due to changing from a known to an
unknown situation as well as individual differences in their lives. Thus, getting positive
consequences, management need to understand employee attitudes, beliefs and
behaviours towards organisational change programmes.
6.2.2 Aim and Objectives
The aim of this research is to examine employee readiness determinants which may
support in developing employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change. It is
observed that employees can develop positive attitudes and behaviours on the basis of
psychological and financial needs. Thus, this research focuses on employee
commitment to the organisation and career factors which are related to the individual
psychological and financial needs.
6.2.3 Hypotheses
In organisational change, employee perceptions can be developed on the basis of
psychological and financial needs. The literature reveals that both needs can be obtained
by employee commitment to the organisation and their career. In this regard, a
conceptual approach has been developed to identify employee responses towards
organisational change. Various predictor variables such that feeling of pride, emotional
attachment, personal sense of obligation, pay/wages/rewards, fringe benefits,
promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement, career commitment, supervisor and peer
relations, training and skills development, and social relationships in the workplace
have been related in a way to examine employee attitudes and behaviours to readiness
for organisational change. On the basis of the conceptual model a few hypotheses have
been developed as noted below.
128
H1: There is a significant positive relationship between feeling of pride and employee
readiness for organisational change.
H2: There is a significant positive relationship between emotional attachment and
employee readiness for organisational change.
H3: There is a significant positive relationship between personal sense of obligation
and employee readiness for organisational change.
H4: There is a significant positive relationship between pays/wages/rewards and
employee readiness for organisational change.
H5: There is a significant positive relationship between promotion and employee
readiness for organisational change.
H6: There is a significant positive relationship between career commitment and
employee readiness for organisational change.
H7: There is a significant positive relationship between job satisfaction and employee
readiness for organisational change.
H8: There is a significant positive relationship between job involvement and employee
readiness for organisational change.
H9: There is a significant positive relationship between supervisor and peer relations
and employee readiness for organisational change.
H10: There is a significant positive relationship between employees training and skills
development and employee readiness for organisational change.
H11: There is a significant positive relationship between social relationships in the
workplace and employee readiness for organisational change.
6.2.4 Study Setting
This research was conducted in public sector higher educational institutions in Pakistan
where changes have been announced for faculty members in the recent past. Teaching
staff members of these institutions are going through these changes. By applying the
survey questionnaire this study examined employee attitudes and behaviours to
readiness for organisational change.
129
6.2.5 Sample size
The total population is 10,471 in all sixty eight public sector higher educational
institutions in Pakistan (HEC, no date a). For data collection, a random sampling was
done among full time faculty members of all categories such that professors, associate
professors, assistant professors, and lecturers. The quantity of participants was
proportionate according to category. Before sending a survey questionnaire to
participants, the researcher contacted them for any queries regarding the instrument and
privacy. Then the survey questionnaire was handed over by personal visits or sent by
post or email. Addresses and contact numbers of faculty members were obtained from
the respective university web sites or personal visits to universities. A postal or email
survey questionnaire packet contained a copy of the survey questionnaire and a covering
letter prepared by the supervisors of the study.
6.2.6 Research Methods and Design
This is a cross sectional study to examine the relationships of independent variables to a
dependent variable. It is observed that relationship of two variables can be measured
through a positivist approach. In this regard, a systematic research design was
developed to describe the hypothetico-method that leads to answering the research
questions and justifies the hypotheses. The research process started with an extensive
literature review to find gaps in the research and an understanding of the research
domain. After that, a conceptual approach was developed to represent the intended
empirical research. To test the model, data is required to validate the research
hypotheses. The type of data was determined as quantitative, the epistemology stance
determined, and a research strategy identified. Quantitative data can be collected by
survey questionnaire which was developed relating to the factors applied in the
conceptual model. Before the full scale study, a pilot study is to be conducted to
measure the reliability and the face validity of the questionnaire was done via field
experts at the university. Ethical issues were considered for data collection in which
participant participation was voluntary. At any time they could withdraw and were told
not to write their names on the questionnaires to ensure anonymity and confidentiality
throughout the research process.
130
6.2.7 Data Analysis
In this study quantitative data was collected from the employees of public sector higher
educational institutions of Pakistan. In the business research domain, the statistical
package for social sciences (SPSS) has been applied widely to infer results. Recently
many researchers in social sciences studies have applied this package and found
relationships of predictor variables (Cinite et al., 2009; Park and Kim, 2009, Elias,
2009). In this study, data was analysed by applying SPSS version 15.0 for Windows.
Through this package a number of statistical tests including descriptive statistics and
correlations test were analysed from the data of the study. In descriptive statistics,
frequencies, means, and standard deviations were used to describe the sample
(demographics) and general results. While for alpha reliability, Pearson’s correlations
and exploratory factor analysis package was also applied to infer results. This technique
is widely used to assess the relationship of predictor variables (Cinite et al., 2009; Elias,
2009). The pilot study concludes with an extensive discussion, findings and suggested
recommendations for future research.
6.3 Pilot Study Methodology
The pilot study was undertaken between June and July in 2008. The survey
questionnaire was distributed to fifty participants who were selected by random
sampling. The participants were academics employed by public sector universities in
Pakistan currently doing PhD or post doctorate studies in the United Kingdom (UK).
Before sending the survey questionnaire to participants, the researcher contacted them
for any queries regarding the instrument and privacy. Then a survey questionnaire was
handed over either during personal visits or sent by post or email. Addresses and contact
numbers of participants were obtained from colleagues doing PhD studies in different
universities in the UK. A postal or email questionnaire survey packet contained a copy
of the survey questionnaire and a covering letter prepared by the supervisors of the
study.
Pilot study data was analysed using SPSS (version 15.0 for Windows). Before analysing
data, the questionnaire items were coded in the SPSS programme. A few survey items
such that 24, 25, 26 and 30 were in the organisational commitment scale, item numbers
131
38, 40 and 44 were in career commitment and item number 73 on social relationships in
the workplace were coded in reverse. Descriptive statistics like as frequencies, mean,
and standard deviations were calculated for all variables.
6.4 Pilot Study Results and Data Analysis
The pilot study was completed within two months. Of the fifty questionnaires
distributed among faculty members from twelve different public sector universities in
Pakistan, forty seven were returned, which shows a response rate of 94%. Minimum
time taken was ten minutes and maximum sixty minutes. But the average time was
nineteen minutes to complete the survey questionnaire.
6.4.1 Demographic details
Demographic details of the participants (Table 6.1) show that 77% (n=36) participants
were male and 47 % (n=22) were between 31 to 40 years of age. A majority (75%,
n=35) of the participants were married and most of them (28%, n=13) had 3 to 4
dependents. The majority of respondents comprised lecturers (49%, n=23) and assistant
professors (34%, n=16). Some 70 percent (n=33) had a Master’s degree as highest
educational qualification. The majority of respondents (36%, n=17) had remained in
their present job for 6 to 10 years and most of them (32%, n=15) were working for their
present employer for the same period.
132
Table 6.1 Demographic Characteristics of Participants
Demographic Category Frequencies
Gender Male 36 Female 11 Age 21-30 14 31-40 22 41-50 8 51-60 3 Marital Status Single 12 Married 35 Present Employment Status Lecturer 23
Assistant Professor 16 Associate Professor 2 Professor 6
Highest Educational Level Masters Degree 33
MS/M. Phil Degree 9 Ph. D Degree 5
Number of Dependents 1-2 9
3-4 13 5-6 12 7 + 5 None 8
Years in present job < 1 year 4 1-5 years 13
6-10 years 17 11-15 years 6 16-20 years 4 21 and more 3
Years with present employer < 1 year 2 1-5 years 12
6-10 years 15 11-15 years 9 16-20 years 5
21 and more 4
133
6.4.2 Descriptive Statistics
In this pilot study, overall, participants perceived themselves as generally open and
ready for change with a statistical mean (M) of 5.44±0.86 on a seven point Likert scale
of Very Unlikely (1) to Very Likely (7). The participants appeared to be fully
committed to their organisations (M = 3.50±0.66) and career (M = 3.55±0.68) on a five-
point Likert scale of Strongly Disagree (1) to Strongly Agree (5). However, the variable
social relationships in the workplace was also good with a statistical mean (M =
3.78±0.37) on a five-point Likert scale of Strongly Disagree (1) to Strongly Agree (5).
6.4.3 Reliability
Overall reliability of scales used in this survey questionnaire was found 0.924 that
shows higher internal consistency among the scales. However, the reliability of
individual scales was found different from each other and varied from 0.698 to 0.887
(Table 6.2), which shows that each scale has an individual internal consistency. This
shows that the survey instrument has a high level of internal consistency (Field, 2006).
Thus, the survey instrument can be reliably used to examine employees’ attitudes and
behaviours for readiness to organisational change.
6.4.4 Pearson’s Correlations Analysis
Significant correlations between the scales were determined at two levels such that
p=0.05 and p=0.01 (Table 6.2). In this pilot study, the organisational commitment scale
is found to be significantly and positively correlated (P<.01) with career commitment,
and social relationships in the workplace (Table 5.2). The organisational commitment is
also significantly and positively correlated with readiness for organisational change
scale at the level of P<.05. The career commitment scale is significantly and positively
correlated with employees’ commitment to the organisation, social relationships in the
workplace and readiness for organisational change scales at the level of p<.01.
Pearson’s correlation value of career commitment scale is highly correlated with
organisational commitment and social relationships in the workplace.
134
The social relationships in the workplace scale is significantly and positively correlated
(p<.001) with all other scales except employee readiness for organisational change,
which had no correlation whatsoever with this scale.
Table 6.2 Coefficient Alpha and Correlations of Scales for Pilot Study
Variable Cronbach’s Alpha 1 2 3 4
1. Organisational Commitment 0.803 ----
2. Career Commitment 0.887 .612** ----
3. Social Relationships 0.698 .441** .642** ----
4 Readiness to Change 0.753 .355* .475** .283 ----
Notes: Total N = 47; *p < .05; **p < .01 (two-tailed);
6.5 Discussion
The purpose of this pilot study was to know the reliability of various scales included in
this survey questionnaire, which was to be applied in the main field study to examine
employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. The
questionnaire was developed with five main scales such that demography,
organisational commitment, career commitment, social relationships in the workplace
and readiness for organisational change.
Madsen et al. (2005) recommended that organisational commitment and social
relationships in the workplace predictor variables can be used to understand employee
attitudes and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. This was supported by
Penely and Gould (1988) and Yoon and Thye (2002) to ascertain employee attitudes
and behaviours through employee commitment to the organisation. In addition, Blau
(1985); Collarelli and Bishop (1990) and Chang (1999) have reported that employee
attitudes, behaviours and beliefs can be measured by their commitment to their career.
Therefore the present survey questionnaire was developed on the basis of studies
mentioned above and pilot tested it.
In this pilot study, overall results of the scales were found highly reliable, as indicated
by Cronbach’s α (.924), which shows high internal consistency among the various
135
scales included in this survey questionnaire. However, reliability of individual scales
differed from each other.
6.5.1 Employee Commitment to the Organisation
Employee commitment to the organisation scale was found reliable which reveals that
this scale has internal consistency for examining employee reaction to change. This
finding is in agreement with previous studies (Madsen, et al., 2005; Penely and Gould,
1988; Yoon and Thye, 2002). The statistical mean of this scale also showed employee
openness and readiness for organisational change. Thus, the scale can be applied to
ascertain employee attitudes and behaviours regarding readiness for change.
Madsen et al. (2005), Gaertner and Nollen (1989) and Gautam et al. (2001) reported
that employee attitudes and behaviours can be examined by his or her commitment to
the organisation. The results of this pilot study also show that employee commitment to
the organisation scale is significantly and positively correlated with other scales such
that career commitment, social relationships in the workplace, and employee readiness
for organisational change.
6.5.2 Employee Commitment to the Career
This scale has been applied by many researchers such as Goulet and Singh (2002) and
Chang (1999) to know an individual’s intentions and beliefs for career and they found
positive results. We also used this scale in this pilot and found that the reliability of
employee career commitment scale was high which revealed higher internal consistency
of the instrument items. In addition, the statistical mean of this scale also showed that
employee of organisations can be ready and open to change when they are committed to
their career.
In this scale participant’s response to the factors are related to situational and individual
commitments. According to Judges et al. (1995); Goulet and Singh (2002) and Poon
(2004) employee can develop positive attitudes and behaviours for an organisation on
the basis of the situational factor. In addition, the literature also shows that employee
can develop positive attitudes on the basis of individual commitment (Penely and
136
Gould, 2002; London, 1985; Collarly and Bishop, 1990; Agho et al., 1992). This was
confirmed in our pilot study, which shows that employee career commitment has a
positive relationship to the readiness for organisational change.
6.5.3 Social Relationships in the Workplace
Employee can develop positive attitudes and behaviours through social relationships in
the workplace (Weber and Weber, 2001; Hanpachern et al., 1998; Eby et al., 2000;
Madsen et al., 2005). The researcher therefore studied the relationship of employee
social relationships in the workplace to readiness for organisational change.
Interestingly, the researcher did not find any significant correlation between this scale
and readiness for change. This means that social relationships in the workplace may not
facilitate an individual to be more willing and open to organisational change. However,
it was found that employee who had positive social relationships in their organisation
felt more commitment to the organisation and their career.
6.6 Participants Comments on the Survey Questionnaire
In this pilot study, a few suggestions were received from participants to make clearer
and strengthen the survey questionnaire. Participants suggested writing the term
‘university’ instead of ‘organisation’, which may make it clearer for participants to
provide a response for his or her university. In the demography scale, the option for
gender and marital status should be open. This suggestion can reduce gender bias. In the
item on highest educational level, Bachelor of Engineering (B.E) and Bachelor in
Medicine and Bachelor in Surgery (MBBS) were included. In fact, this study was to be
conducted in different universities in Pakistan including professional and general
universities. Thus for medical and engineering universities, the basic requirement for
appointment is a bachelor’s degree and so this option should be included in the relevant
question. In the readiness for organisational change scale the phrase ‘my willingness or
openness’ was applied once to all items at the beginning. Participants suggested putting
this phrase with all questions which might be more easily understandable. However,
participants agreed on the simple language in the survey instrument and format of the
questionnaire items.
137
6.7 Conclusion
This pilot study revealed higher internal consistency of all scales and positively
significant correlations between different scales included in the developed and piloted
survey questionnaire, which therefore can be applied to examine employee attitudes and
behaviours to readiness for organisational change. Of particular interest was the finding
that social relationships in the workplace, despite satisfactory coefficient alpha
reliability, may not be significantly correlated with readiness for organisational change
as revealed in this pilot study. However, there was a need to confirm these findings
using this survey instrument in a full scale study in the field.
138
Chapter Seven Main Study Analysis and Findings
7.1 Introduction
In order to achieve the research objectives this chapter is concerned with analysing and
uncovering the relationships between independent and dependent variables. The
previous chapters provided the details about the research methodology and significant
portion was dedicated to methods used in the study. Since the study adopted
quantitative methods in which a survey questionnaire was applied to obtain the data.
This chapter consist on analysing the data with subsequent discussions. Based on
quantitative data, various statistical techniques based on statistical package for social
sciences (SPSS) version 15.0 and structural equation modelling (SEM) based on AMOS
(version 16.0) software were used to analyse the data. This chapter comprises the
following sections such that introduction, data management, data screening prior to
analysis, demographic characteristics, factor loading and data analysis, hypotheses
testing, and conclusions.
7.2 Data Management
This study was undertaken from September 2008 to January 2009. The survey
questionnaire was distributed by post, email and personal visits to 1000 participants
who were selected by random sampling from thirty three public sector universities of
Pakistan. The participants were all academics (faculty members) such that Professors,
Associate Professors, Assistant Professors, and Lecturers. In the random sampling, all
categories of employees were considered proportionately. During data collection, due
process was followed like sending reminders (at least three) to non respondents after
fifteen days. No any participants were forced to fill the form at particular time or in a
particular place. All participants were free to respond at any time and anywhere.
However, the ratio of male and female participants was considered in random sampling.
This study is primarily based on statistical package for social sciences (SPSS) version
15.0 for Windows to assess the descriptive statistics and exploratory factor analysis.
After exploratory factor analysis, factors were confirmed via confirmatory factor
analysis on the basis of structural equation modelling (SEM). Then analysis of moment
139
(AMOS) version 16.0 software was applied to assess the model fit of the study. SPSS
programmes, deal with quantitative data to run the objects, thus all responses of
participants were entered according to the numeric response value. Before entering the
data into SPSS spreadsheet columns and rows were developed by coding of question
items (Appendix 4). Therefore, any information about the case can be identified across
the data editor. In the name column of SPSS, questionnaire items were coded with
numbers along with an abbreviation of the variable. Similarly, in the label column
question items were written in abbreviated format. The value section of the column was
developed from “0” showing information not provided and then “1” for “Very
Unlikely” to “7” “Very Likely” on a seven-point Likert scale and “0” showed
information not provided and then “1” for “Strongly Disagree” to “5” “Strongly Agree”
on a five-point Likert scale.
After entering data, coding was done for variables, which consisted of a series of
grouped question items (Appendix 5). These variables are representing as independent
and dependent variables used in the analysis
Finally data was cleaned by descriptive statistics tests to know the responses to each
question according to column section entry to confirm the proper figure was entered.
7.3 Data Screening Prior to Analysis
Accuracy of data is necessary for analysing the responses of participants. Many issues
are concerned with the accuracy with which data are entered into the data file. Issues
like missing data, outliers, linearity, normality and Homoscedasticity have an impact on
the relationships of variables or for the outcome of variables. Indeed, the objective of
data screening is as much to reveal what is not apparent as it is to portray the actual
data, for the “hidden” effects are easily overlooked (Hair et al., 2006, p-37). Thus, for
honest analysis of main data, these issues must be a prior consideration and resolved
(Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007).
140
7.3.1 Missing Data
Missing data is one of the most pervasive problems in data analysis. It is a fairly
common occurrence in certain areas of research which can affect the results of research
objectives. Missing data occurs for a variety of reasons but the most common reasons in
social science research are long questionnaires and/or participants who accidently miss
out questions. According to Tabachnick and Fidell (2007, p-62), missing data
seriousness depend on the pattern of missing data, how much is missing, and why it is
missing. However, the pattern is more important than the number missing. In social
science research, there are various suggestions like using the mean of the scores on the
variance (Stevens, 1992) or removing sample(s) who do not responding to a question
(Norusis, 1995). According to Tabachnick and Fidell (2007, p-63), if only few data
points, say, 5% or less, are missing in a random pattern from a large data set, the
problem are less serious and almost any procedure for handling missing values yields
similar results. To find the missing data, this study applied SPSS package of missing
value and found all question data less than 5% of the total data (Appendix 6). Thus, the
removal of all missing data such that 25 samples out of 556 samples is 4.49% which
does not cause problems with the outcome of the analysis.
7.3.2 Outliers
An outlier is a score with a distinct characteristic from the rest of the data. It occurs with
an extreme value on one variable or a combination of scores on two or more variables to
deviate the statistics (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). According to Hair et al. (2006, p-
73) an outlier is judged to be an unusually high or low value on a variable, or a unique
combination of values across several variables that make the observation stand out from
the others. Hair et al. (2006, p-73) have classified outliers into one of four classes based
on the source of their uniqueness.
a. It can arise from a procedural error, such as a data entry error or mistake in
coding.
b. It is an observation that occurs as the result of an extraordinary event, which
accounts for the uniqueness of the observation.
141
c. It comprises extraordinary observations for which the researcher has no
explanation.
d. It contains observations that fall within the ordinary range of values on each of
the variables.
There are three methods to detect outliers (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al.,
2006, p-73 and Field, 2006). Such as:
a. Univariate detection
b. Bivariate detection
c. Multivariate detection
Univariate outliers are cases with an extreme value on one variable which can be
identified by examining the distribution of observations for each variable (Hair et al.,
2006). By applying a distribution test, outliers can be detected with those cases falling
at the outer ranges of the distribution or by applying z scores test in which cases with
standardised scores in excess of 3.29 (p<.001, two tailed test) are potential outliers
(Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). According to Tabachnick and Fidell, (2007, p-73) the
extremeness of a standardised score depends on the size of the sample; with a very large
N, a few standardised scores in excess of 3.29 are expected.
Bivariate outliers can be identified by applying a pair of variables jointly in a scatter
plot in which if case(s) fall markedly outside the range of the other observations will be
seen as isolated points (Hair et al., 2006).
Multivariate outliers are a combination of scores on two or more variables. It is a better
solution than bivariate because of a large number of graphs and limited numbers of
variables observations. Thus for multidimensional position of variables, the multivariate
detection method of dealing with outliers is more useful. According to Hair at el. (2006)
and Field (2006) multivariate outliers can be identified by Mahalanobis D2 measure in
which assessment of each observation can be done across a set of variables. In this test
if D2/df (degree of freedom) value exceeds 2.5 in small samples and 3 or 4 in large
samples it can be designated as a possible outlier (Hair, at el., 2006, p-75). After
142
detecting multivariate outliers, these can be examined by univariate or bivariate
methods for fully understanding the nature of its uniqueness.
Outliers cannot be categorically characterised as either beneficial or problematic (Hair,
et al. 2006) but they can bias the mean and inflate the standard deviations (Field and
Hole, 2003). Thus, the researcher should be aware of such values because they bias the
model research fit to the data (Field, 2006). This research study applied a graphical
method for detecting the univariate outliers and Mahalanobis’s distance case was
applied for finding multivariate outliers to confirm their effect on the objectives of the
study. In box plot (Graph 7.1), 11 univariate outliers were found which marked with an
asterisk and also compared with the multivariate outlier tests by Mahalanobis’s distance
test which confirmed the samples (Table 7.1).
Graph 7.1 Inbox Plot
SORETSDESPREJOINJOSAPMTNCACOPAWAPSOEMATFOPRROCH
100
80
60
40
20
0
452
195
254510
72138
350
278285
363501
512513
522
236
130353
385
278 344
83255
35
408352 449
520
37440
460
397404
418
507
93107231235
440353
472496
497
448
196
451
195
368
410
492
249
105363504
418116
146
351
531236
440
495
496
452
138
334
143
Table 7.1 Univariate and Multivariate Outliers Results
Univariate Outliers Multivariate Outliers
Case with standard values Case with a value of D2/df Greater
exceeding + 2.5 than 2.5 (df = 13) a
Case D2 D2/df
ROCH 195 138 43.78 3.38 FOPR 452 195 35.02 2.69 EMAT No cases 334 35.68 2.74 PSO No cases 440 42.57 3.27 PAWA No cases CACO No cases PMTN No cases JOSA 350 JOIN No cases SPRE 72, 128, 138, 195, 254, 510 TSDE No cases SORE 363, 278
a. Mahalnobis D2 value based on the 13 variable perceptions.
Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PSO = personal sense of obligation, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, CACO = career commitment, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace
7.3.3 Normality, Linearity and Homoscedasticity
Before going on to infer results from the data, it should be ensured that data is normally
distributed and also to confirm the relationship between variables. In multivariate
analysis, a fundamental assumption is shaping the data to show the variation. According
to Tabachnick and Fidell (2007), variables related with each other must be normally
distributed. This research study is going to confirm the data by screening the normality,
linearity and homoscedasticity before inferring results from the data.
7.3.2.1 Normality
In statistics, normality refers to the data distribution which is a fundamental assumption
in measuring the variation of variables. For analysing the data, it is not always required
but is found better if the variables are normally distributed (Tabachnick and Fidell,
2007). According to Hair et al. (2006, p-79), if the variation from the data normal
144
distribution is sufficiently large, all resulting statistical tests are invalid, because
normality is required to use the F and t statistics.
Normality of data can be assessed by statistical methods (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007
and Hair et al., 2006). In statistical method, normality of data distribution can be
measured by Kurtosis and Skewness test and Kolmogorov and Shapiro method (Field,
2006; Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006). For that, initially descriptive
statistics were applied in SPSS 15.0 for Windows to know the skewness and kurtosis
(Table 7.2). All variables were found normally distributed; however, values for
skewness were found negative and for kurtosis values were mixed such that negative
and positive. In addition, Kolmogorov and Shapiro test (Field, 2006) was applied to find
the data normality. Results of this test (Table 7.3) were found significant for all
variables, which might be due to large sample size (e.g. n=518 in this study) because
this test is very sensitive to large sample size and minor deviation from normality show
this test as significant, hence, significant K-S test does not reveal departure from
normality of data (Field, 2006, p. 93).
145
Table 7.2 Descriptive Statistics
N Minimum Maximu
m Mean Std.
Deviation Skewness Kurtosis Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Std. Error Statistic Std. Error ROCH 518 40.00 96.00 77.5290 10.28896 -.925 .107 .317 .214 FOPR 518 7.00 15.00 12.3707 2.63250 -1.161 .107 -.091 .214 EMAT 518 5.00 15.00 11.6525 3.09597 -1.030 .107 -.460 .214 PSO 518 6.00 15.00 12.9170 1.59146 -.872 .107 1.287 .214 PAWA 518 5.00 25.00 18.8571 3.59008 -.588 .107 -.108 .214 CACO 518 12.00 40.00 32.5753 4.29037 -.454 .107 .412 .214 PMTN 518 3.00 15.00 11.5405 3.02621 -1.041 .107 -.271 .214 JOSA 518 10.00 35.00 27.8803 5.05876 -1.078 .107 .576 .214 JOIN 518 10.00 25.00 20.2432 3.36018 -.899 .107 .110 .214 SPRE 518 8.00 30.00 23.4981 4.63556 -1.196 .107 1.264 .214 TSDE 518 5.00 25.00 17.7143 3.94687 -.543 .107 .203 .214 SORE 518 6.00 20.00 15.9131 2.79924 -.895 .107 .237 .214
Valid N 518 (list wise) Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PSO = personal sense of obligation, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, CACO = career commitment, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace
146
Table 7. 3 Tests of Normality
Kolmogorov-Smirnov a Shapiro-Wilk Statistic Df Sig. Statistic df Sig. ROCH .126 518 .000 .929 518 .000 FOPR .295 518 .000 .770 518 .000 EMAT .286 518 .000 .790 518 .000 PSO .162 518 .000 .912 518 .000 PAWA .127 518 .000 .960 518 .000 CACO .088 518 .000 .975 518 .000 PMTN .263 518 .000 .820 518 .000 JOSA .174 518 .000 .900 518 .000 JOIN .201 518 .000 .901 518 .000 SPRE .182 518 .000 .897 518 .000 TSDE .098 518 .000 .971 518 .000 SORE .202 518 .000 .908 518 .000
a Lilliefors Significance Correction Note: df = degree of freedom, Sig. = Significance Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PSO = personal sense of obligation, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, CACO = career commitment, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
7.3.2.2 Linearity
Linearity means the correlation between variables which is represented by a straight
line. In data analysis, it is important to know the level of relationship of variables. An
implicit assumption of all multivariate techniques based on co-relational measures of
association, including multiple regression, logistic regression, factor analysis, and
structural equation modelling, is linearity (Hair et al., 2006, p-85). Thus, examining the
relationships of variables is important to identify any departures that may affect the
correlation. In statistics, linearity can be measured by Pearson’s correlations or a scatter
plot (Field, 2006; Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006). This study applied
Pearson’s correlations and found all independent variables significantly positively
correlated to the dependent variable (Table 7.4). Results of this test showed that all
variables are linear with each other.
147
Table 7.4 Pearson’s Correlations
ROCH FOPR EMAT PSO PAWA CACO PMTN JOSA JOIN SPRE TSDE SORE
ROCH 1
FOPR .239** 1
EMAT .146** -.087* 1
PSO .292** .248** .035 1
PAWA .345** .171** .114** .114** 1
CACO .138** .137** -.064 .243** .155** 1
PMTN .229** .068 -.049 .041 .228** .084 1
JOSA .467** .155** .114** .163** .360** .229** .146** 1
JOIN .209** .047 .055 .133** .167** .246** .052 .256** 1
SPRE .238** .077 .010 .123** .203** .164** .117** .168** .217** 1
TSDE .190** .079 .020 .146** .317** .129** .100* .169** .110* .455** 1
SORE .215** -.008 -.002 .040 .211** .191** .059 .290** .070 .125** .150** 1
*p < .05; **p < .01 Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PSO = personal sense of obligation, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, CACO = career commitment, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
148
7.3.2.3 Homoscedasticity
Homoscedasticity estimates the variance of dependent variables with independent
variables. In multiple regression analysis, the assumption of variation of variables
should be constant (Field, 2006). According to Hair et al. (2006, p-83) homoscedasticity
is the assumption that dependent variable(s) exhibit equal levels of variance across the
range of predictor variable(s). Thus, it refers to the assumption of normality because
when the assumption of multivariate normality is met, the relationships between
variables are homoscedasticity (Field, 2006; Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007).
Homoscedasticity can be measured by graphical and statistical methods (Hair et al.,
2006; Field, 2006). In research, when data are grouped, homoscedasticity is known as
homogeneity which can be measured by Levene’s test of homogeneity of variances
(Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). Thus, this study applied Levene’s test of homogeneity of
variance to confirm the results of variability of dependent variables with independent
variables (Table 7.5).
Table 7.5 Test of Homogeneity of Variances
Levene Statistic df1 df2 Sig.
ROCH Based on Mean .099 1 516 .753
Based on Median .020 1 516 .886
Based on Median and with adjusted df .020 1 511.747 .886
Based on trimmed mean .054 1 516 .816
FOPR Based on Mean 1.609 1 516 .205
Based on Median .560 1 516 .454
Based on Median and with adjusted df .560 1 514.542 .454
Based on trimmed mean 1.578 1 516 .210
EMAT Based on Mean .011 1 516 .918
Based on Median .022 1 516 .883
Based on Median and with adjusted df .022 1 515.668 .883
Based on trimmed mean .006 1 516 .939
PSO Based on Mean 7.035 1 516 .008
Based on Median 5.079 1 516 .025
Based on Median and with adjusted df 5.079 1 508.893 .025
Based on trimmed mean 4.477 1 516 .035
PAWA Based on Mean 3.746 1 516 .053
Based on Median 2.686 1 516 .102
149
Based on Median and with adjusted df 2.686 1 513.107 .102
Based on trimmed mean 3.684 1 516 .055
CACO Based on Mean .210 1 516 .647
Based on Median .099 1 516 .753
Based on Median and with adjusted df .099 1 500.926 .753
Based on trimmed mean .140 1 516 .709
PMTN Based on Mean .052 1 516 .820
Based on Median .015 1 516 .903
Based on Median and with adjusted df .015 1 513.836 .903
Based on trimmed mean .009 1 516 .924
JOSA Based on Mean .571 1 516 .450
Based on Median .636 1 516 .425
Based on Median and with adjusted df .636 1 513.593 .425
Based on trimmed mean .501 1 516 .479
JOIN Based on Mean 2.737 1 516 .099
Based on Median 1.291 1 516 .256
Based on Median and with adjusted df 1.291 1 515.991 .256
Based on trimmed mean 2.449 1 516 .118
SPRE Based on Mean 3.680 1 516 .056
Based on Median 2.670 1 516 .103
Based on Median and with adjusted df 2.670 1 515.866 .103
Based on trimmed mean 3.358 1 516 .067
TSDE Based on Mean 9.720 1 516 .002
Based on Median 9.360 1 516 .002
Based on Median and with adjusted df 9.360 1 507.424 .002
Based on trimmed mean 9.765 1 516 .002
SORE Based on Mean 2.545 1 516 .111
Based on Median .704 1 516 .402
Based on Median and with adjusted df .704 1 515.534 .402
Based on trimmed mean 2.664 1 516 .103
Note: df = degree of freedom, Sig. = Significance Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PSO = personal sense of obligation, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, CACO = career commitment, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
The results in the above table show that many variables ensured that the assumption of
homogeneity has not been violated. However, PSO and TSDE are significant which
mean a lack of homogeneity in these two variables. Nevertheless, it can be noted that
like K-S Test, the Levene’s test is also sensitive to sample size, hence, it can be
significant when the sample size is large (such as n=518 in the present study), which
150
does not mean that there is substantial departure from normality of data (Field, 2006,
p.98).
7.4 Demographic Characteristics and Relationships
The main study was completed within five months which shows the interest of
participants in the issue being studied. As mentioned in previous chapter, the data for
the main study was collected from Pakistan. Of the 1000 questionnaires distributed
among faculty members from 33 different public sector universities in all four provinces
of the country, 556 were returned, which shows a response rate of 55.6%. This response
rate could be due to the fact that the questionnaire was mostly handed over face-to-face
and followed a procedure in which at least three reminders were sent out after two
weeks. Data was recorded with coding and cleaned before inferring findings. However,
a few missing data were found which were excluded as discussed in an earlier section
(section 7.3.1). The researcher also found a few outliers from the data, which were also
excluded from the study (section 7.3.2).
The characteristics of the respondents such as age, gender, marital status, present
employment status, higher education level, number of dependents, years in present job,
and years with present employer were asked in the questionnaire. Demographic details
of the participants (Table 7.6) show that 61.8% (n=315) of participants were male and
35.9 % (n=186) were between 31 to 40 years of age. A majority (60.2%, n=312) of the
participants were married and most of them (30.1%, n=154) had 3 to 4 dependents. The
majority of respondents comprised lecturers (40.7%, n=211) and assistant professors
(31.5%, n=163). About 42 percent (n=217) had a Master’s degree as the highest
educational qualification. The majority of respondents (36.5%, n=189) had remained in
their present job for 1 to 5 years and most of them (26.8%, n=139) were working with
their present employer for the same period.
151
Table 7.6 Demographic Characteristics of Participants
Demographic Category Frequencies
Gender Male 315 Female 203 Age <21 02
21-30 154 31-40 186 41-50 90
51-60 77
>60 09 Marital Status Single 177 Married 312 Divorced or Widowed 29 Present Employment Status Lecturer 211
Assistant Professor 163 Associate Professor 78 Professor 66
Highest Educational Level B.E/MBBS/Masters Degree 217
MS/M. Phil Degree 152 Ph.D Degree 149
Number of Dependents 1-2 117
3-4 154 5-6 87 7 + 42 None 118
Years in present job < 1 year 77 1-5 years 189
6-10 years 109 11-15 years 50 16-20 years 45 21 and more 48
Years with present employer < 1 year 70 1-5 years 139
6-10 years 81 11-15 years 72 16-20 years 71
21 and more 85
152
A multi analysis of variance (MANOVA) was used to analyse the relationships between
demographic variables such that gender, age, marital status, highest education level,
number of dependents and years with present employer and study variables such that
readiness for change, emotional attachment, feeling of pride, pay/wages/rewards,
promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, training and
skills development, and social relationships in the workplace. Result of MANOVA
(Table 7.7) shows significant relationships between number of dependents and readiness
to change (p = .009), gender and feeling of pride (p = .019), gender and training and
skills development (p = .005), age and feeling of pride (p = .002), marital status and job
satisfaction (p = .015), marital status and supervisor and peer relations (p = .036), higher
education level and training and skills development (p = .015), years with present
employer and emotional attachment (p = .027), years with present employer and feeling
of pride (p = .004), years with present employer and job involvement (p = .045).
153
Table: 7.7 Demographic Multi Analysis of Variances (MANOVA)
Demographics ROCHa
F P
EMATb
F P
FOPRc
F P
PAWAd
F P
PMTNe
F P
JOSAf
F P
JOINg
F P
SPREh
F P
TSDEi
F P
SOREj
F P
Gender .105 .746 .299 .585 2.446 .019* .297 .586 .314 .576 .046 .830 .384 .536 1.168 .280 4.487 .005** .184 .669
Age 1.510 .187 1.553 .174 3.998 .002** .935 .459 .549 .739 1.011 .412 .439 .821 .830 .529 .507 .771 .613 .690
M.S
H.E.L.
1.784 .151
1.492 .227
.618 .604
.564 .569
.738 .530
.344 .709
828 .479
1.783 .170
1.574 .196
.319 .727
3.534 .015*
.224 .800
.426 .735
.314 .730
2.883 .036*
.481 .619
.073 .974
4.248 .015*
2.293 .078
1.079 .342
N.D
Y.P.E.
3.451 .009**
1.208 .306
.642 .633
2.572 .027*
1.086 .364
3.526 .004**
1.031 .392
1.947 .087
1.525 .195
1.615 .156
1.227 .300
1.264 .280
1.124 .346
2.301 .045*
2.086 .083
1.783 .117
1.052 .381
.065 .997
.357 .839
.799 .551
aR2 = .509, ∆ R2 = .024; bR== .508, ∆ R2 = .022; cR
2 =.534, ∆ R2 = .073; dR2 =.553, ∆ R2 =.073; eR
2 = .499, ∆ R2 =.003; fR2 =.528, ∆ R2 =.060; gR
2 = .526, ∆ R2 =.057; hR2 =.512,
∆ R2 =.029; iR2 =.540, ∆ R2 =.085; jR
2 = .475, ∆ R2 =-.044 *p < .05; **p < .01 Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace, M.S = marital status, H.E.L. = higher educational level, N.D = number of dependent, Y.P.E. = years with present employer
154
7.5 Factor Loading and Data Analysis
Factor analysis techniques were used for data reduction which identifies groups or
clusters of variables. The factor which produces group variables shows the relationship
of variables to the factor. Field (2006, p-619) defines three main uses of factor analysis.
1. To understand the structure of a set of variables
2. To construct a questionnaire to measure any underlying variables
3. To reduce a data set to a more manageable size while retaining as much of the
original information as possible.
Factor analysis includes underlying dimensions at which variables seems in group
together in a meaningful way. This can be achieved by looking for variables that
correlate highly with a group of other variables, but do not correlate with variables
outside that group (Field, 2006, p-621). In fact, factor analysis provides the tools for
analysing the structure of the interrelationships (correlations) among a large number of
variables by defining sets of variables that are highly interrelated, known as factors
(Hair et al., 2006, p-104). Different techniques such that exploratory or confirmatory
factor analysis can be used to achieve this purpose. Both are using for structuring
groups of variables or data reduction. However, the exploratory factor analysis
technique is used for “take what the data give you”, but confirmatory factor analysis
techniques involves grouping variables together on a factor or the precise number of
factors for testing hypotheses (Hair et al., 2006, p-104). Initially, this study applied
exploratory factor analysis to take data in a group for a factor and then applying
confirmatory factor analysis techniques to confirm the group of measurement variables
related to a factor for examining the hypotheses. The existence of clusters of large
correlation coefficients between subsets of variables suggests that those variables could
be measuring aspects of the same underlying dimension (Field, 2006, p-620). For
exploratory factor analysis SPSS version 15.0 for Windows was applied.
155
7.5.1 Exploratory Factor Analysis
Numerous procedures are available for factor extraction and rotation in SPSS. Among
these, the principal component extraction method is most common and a default in
SPSS programmes to extract maximum variance from the data set with each component
(Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007). Principal component extraction is the linear combination
of observed variables that separate subjects by maximising the variance of their
component score (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007, p-635).
Several ways are available to assess the adequacy of extraction and the number of
factors but the most common are Eigenvalues and Scree plot. Before, going on to
extract factors, it is important to calculate the variability in scores (the variance) for any
given measures (or variables) (Field, 2006). According to Hair et al. (2007, p-102)
communality is the total amount of variance an original variable shares with all other
variables included in the analysis. A variable that has no specific variance (or random
variance) would have a communality of 1; a variable that shares nothing with other
variables would have a communality of 0 (Field, 2006, p-630). Communality can be
calculated from factor loading in which model containing multiple constructs with
communalities of less than .5 are required and for larger sample size, less than .7 are
required (Hair et al., 2007). This research applied variables with a communality value
above .5 (Table 7.8). Results showed that all variables retained in the factor loading
have communality values above .5. Results confirmed the high variation from .671 to
.828 which showed high variance among the variables.
156
Table 7.8 Communalities
Variables Initial Extraction Variables Initial Extraction ROCH2 1.000 .765 JOSA3 1.000 .715 ROCH3 1.000 .737 JOSA6 1.000 .824 ROCH4 1.000 .784 JOSA7 1.000 .730 ROCH6 1.000 .778 JOSA4 1.000 .686 ROCH7 1.000 .709 JOSA5 1.000 .675 ROCH10 1.000 .758 JOIN2 1.000 .824 ROCH12 1.000 .703 JOIN3 1.000 .710 EMAT1 1.000 .802 JOIN4 1.000 .747 EMAT2 1.000 .773 JOIN5 1.000 .786 EMAT3 1.000 .798 SPRE1 1.000 .737 FOPR1 1.000 .820 SPRE3 1.000 .746 FOPR2 1.000 .772 SPRE4 1.000 .755 FOPR3 1.000 .806 SPRE5 1.000 .680 PAWA1 1.000 .671 TSDE2 1.000 .749 PAWA2 1.000 .740 TSDE3 1.000 .780 PAWA3 1.000 .706 TSDE4 1.000 .828 PAWA4 1.000 .679 SORE1 1.000 .788 PMTN1 1.000 .805 SORE3 1.000 .774 PMTN2 1.000 .808 SORE4 1.000 .827 PMTN3 1.000 .821
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis.
Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
7.5.1.1 Eigenvalue
In principal component extraction method eigenvalues are associated with a variance
which indicates the substantive importance of that factor. A quick estimate of the
number of factors is obtained from the size of the eigenvalues reported as part of an
initial run with principal component extraction (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007, p-644).
With component analysis variance of each variable contributing 1, a component with an
eigenvalue less than 1 is not important (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Field, 2006; Hair
et al., 2006). Thus, only the factors having eigenvalues greater than 1 are significant; all
factors with latent roots less than 1 are considered insignificant and are disregarded
(Hair et al., 2006, p-120). For extracting factors from the data this study found ten
factors having an eigenvalue greater than 1 (Table 7.10). The first factor was a high
value and then successively smaller eigenvalues were found.
157
Table 7.9 Total Variance Explained
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis
Component Initial Eigenvalues Extraction Sums of Squared Loadings
Rotation Sums of Squared Loadings
Total Variance Cumulative (%)
Total Variance (%)
Cumulative (%)
Total Variance (%)
Cumulative (%)
1 9.009 23.100 23.100 9.009 23.100 23.100 5.367 13.761 13.761
2 3.679 9.434 32.535 3.679 9.434 32.535 3.570 9.154 22.915
3 2.986 7.655 40.190 2.986 7.655 40.190 3.059 7.844 30.759
4 2.759 7.075 47.265 2.759 7.075 47.265 2.980 7.642 38.401
5 2.365 6.065 53.329 2.365 6.065 53.329 2.746 7.041 45.442
6 2.210 5.667 58.997 2.210 5.667 58.997 2.448 6.277 51.719
7 1.879 4.818 63.815 1.879 4.818 63.815 2.389 6.125 57.844
8 1.843 4.726 68.541 1.843 4.726 68.541 2.360 6.052 63.896
9 1.468 3.764 72.305 1.468 3.764 72.305 2.358 6.045 69.941
10 1.398 3.583 75.888 1.398 3.583 75.888 2.319 5.947 75.888
11 .582 1.492 77.380
12 .509 1.306 78.686
13 .491 1.259 79.944
14 .455 1.167 81.112
15 .441 1.132 82.243
16 .423 1.084 83.327
17 .413 1.058 84.386
18 .404 1.036 85.422
19 .381 .976 86.398
20 .366 .937 87.335
21 .347 .889 88.224
22 .339 .868 89.092
23 .329 .844 89.936
24 .319 .819 90.755
25 .312 .800 91.555
26 .299 .766 92.321
27 .291 .746 93.068
28 .284 .727 93.795
29 .263 .675 94.470
30 .254 .651 95.121
31 .251 .644 95.765
32 .242 .619 96.385
33 .235 .603 96.987
34 .225 .577 97.564
35 .220 .565 98.129
36 .213 .546 98.675
37 .197 .505 99.180
38 .163 .419 99.599
39 .156 .401 100.000
158
Table 7.10 Factor Loading
Variables 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
ROCH4 .850
ROCH6 .823
ROCH2 .822
ROCH10 .821
ROCH3 .807
ROCH12 .794
ROCH7 .779
JOSA6 .847
JOSA4 .782
JOSA7 .778
JOSA5 .769
JOSA3 .754
JOIN2 .882
JOIN5 .876
JOIN4 .849
JOIN3 .829
SPRE4 .850
SPRE1 .844
SPRE3 .844
SPRE5 .805
PAWA2 .808
PAWA3 .793
PAWA4 .777
PAWA1 .720
PMTN3 .886
PMTN1 .882
PMTN2 .869
SORE4 .890
SORE3 .860
SORE1 .834
EMAT3 .883
EMAT1 .870
EMAT2 .862
FOPR1 .891
FOPR3 .884
FOPR2 .827
TSDE4 .884
TSDE3 .847
TSDE2 .812
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis. Rotation Method: Varimax with Kaiser Normalization. a Rotation converged in 6 iterations. Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
159
7.5.1.2 Scree Plot
In identifying the extraction factors by eigenvalues, a scree plot is commonly used to
confirm the maximum number of factors. Logically, factors should be extracted with
high eigenvalues but this decision can be made by plotting a scree graph. The scree test
is derived by plotting the latent roots against the number of factors in their order of
extraction, and the shape of the resulting curve is used to evaluate the cut off point (Hair
et al., 2006, p-120). Usually the scree plot negatively decreases, the eigenvalue is
highest for the first factor and moderate but decreasing for the next few factors before
reaching small values for the last several factors (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007, p-644).
By applying a scree plot test on data to confirm the extracted factors through
eigenvalues, the researcher confirmed the same number of factors (Graph 7.2).
Graph 7.2 Scree Plot
Component Number
393837363534333231302928272625242322212019181716151413121110987654321
Eig
en
va
lue
10
8
6
4
2
0
Scree Plot
160
Once factors have been extracted, it is necessary to know to what degree variables load
onto these factors. Rotation is important for improving the interpretability and scientific
utility of the solution. It is used to maximise high correlations between factors and
variables and minimise low ones. Different techniques can be used to develop factors
from variables but the rotation technique is very helpful (Field, 2006). There are two
types of rotation method such that orthogonal and oblique rotation (Field, 2006;
Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006). Orthogonal rotation method is useful
when variables are independent means factor rotated when variables are non co-
relational while oblique rotation is useful for co-relational variables. Orthogonal
solutions offer ease of interpreting, describing, and reporting results, yet they strain
reality unless the researcher is convinced that the underlying process is almost
independent while oblique is vice versa (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007, p-638-639).
However, as different methods of extraction give similar results with a good data set, so
also different methods of rotation tend to give similar results if the pattern of
correlations in the data is fairly clear (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007, p-637). This study
applied Varimax orthogonal techniques which are most commonly used in rotation. It is
used for maximising variance. According to Tabachnick and Fidell (2007, p-620) the
goal of Varimax rotation is to maximise the variance of factor loading by making high
loadings higher and low ones lower for each factor.
The Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin value was .880, exceeding the recommended value of 0.6 and
the Bartlett Test of Sphericity reached a statistical significance, thus supporting the
forcibility of correlation matrix. Table 7.9 reveals the rotated component matrix of the
scale. Principal Component Analysis showed the presence of ten components with
eigenvalues exceeding 1, explaining 23.10%, 9.43%, 7.65%, 7.06%, 6.07%, 5.67%,
4.82%, 4.73%, 3.76%, and 3.58% of the variance respectively (Table 7.9). The scree
plot revealed a clear cut off of these components. To aid in the interpretation of the ten
components a Varimax Rotation was performed. The rotated solution revealed the
presence of a simple structure showing a number of strong loading, with all variables
loading on components.
After developing the factors internal consistency, each loaded factor was assessed by
Cronbach’s alpha measure. The following clusters of the items were specified for the
most relevant dimensions of the elements.
161
Factor 1 – Readiness for Organisational Change (ROCH): This factor covers the
information regarding employees’ response to the organisational change (Miller et al.,
2006; Madsen et al., 2005). Fourteen items were applied based on Hanpachern’s
original scale for readiness to organisational change (with slight alterations), which was
based in part on McNabb and Sepic (1995) for the construct. Applying factor loading
and deleted seven items which loaded less than .5 (Field, 2006) were excluded (Table
7.11).
Table 7.11 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Readiness for
Organisational Change Scale
Factors and Related Items Factor
Loading Cronbach’s Alpha
Readiness for Change My willingness or Openness to solve university problems is My willingness or Openness to be a part of the new project is My willingness or Openness to create new ideas is My willingness or Openness to do things in a new or creative way is My willingness or Openness to change the way I work because of the change is My willingness or Openness to learn new things is My willingness or Openness to support change is
.824 .808 .802 .779 .774 .745 .730
.942
Factor 2 – Emotional Attachment (EMAT): This factor encompasses the employees’
psychological expression to organisational change (Miller et al., 2006; Madsen et al.,
2005). A three item scale was applied which was developed by Cook and Wall (1980)
and factor analysis conducted by Mathews and Shepherd (2002). Applying factor
loading at .5 (Field, 2006) all three items were included (Table 7.12).
Factor 3 – Feeling of Pride (FOPR): This factor covers employees’ psychological
attachment to organisational change (Miller et al., 2006; Madsen et al., 2005). A three
item scale was applied developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and factor analysis
conducted by Mathews and Shepherd (2002) in factor loading. Applying factor loading
at .5 (Field, 2006) no item was excluded (Table 7.12).
Personal Sense of Obligation (PSO): This factor covers employees’ psychological
attachment to organisational change (Miller et al., 2006; Madsen et al., 2005). A three
item scale developed by Cook and Wall (1980) and factor analysis conducted by
162
Mathews and Shepherd (2002) was applied. Applying factor loading at .5 (Field, 2006)
no manifest variable loaded to any factor. Thus, this factor was excluded from the study.
Factor 4 – Pay/Wages/Rewards (PAWA): This factor covers employees’ instrumental
commitment to the organisation (Penley and Gould, 1988). A five item scale applied by
Price and Muller (1986) and modified by Yoon and Thye (2002) was applied and
provided information about employees’ attachment in order to establish financial
aspects about the organisational change. Applying factor loading at .5, only one item
was excluded and the factor was loaded with four factors (Field, 2006) (Table 7.12).
Table 7.12 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Commitment to
the Organisation Scale
Factors and Related Items Factor
Loading Cronbach’s Alpha
Emotion Attachment (EMAT) I am quite proud to be able to tell people who it is I work for I feel myself to be part of the university I would not recommend a close friend to join our staff Feeling of Pride (FOPR) I sometimes feel like leaving the employment for good Even if the university were not doing too well financially, I would be reluctant to change to another employer The offer of a bit more money with another employer would not seriously make me think of changing my job Pays and Wages (PAWA) Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my training and education Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my effort that I input. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work experience Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work responsibilities
.777 .816 .803 .767 .745 .797 .703 .791 .771 .782
.861 .866 .851
Factor 5 – Promotion (PMTN): This factor covers employees’ situational commitment
to the organisation (Goulet and Singh, 2002). A three-item scale developed by Gaertner
and Nollen (1989) and Chang (1999) was applied measuring the employees’ perception
regarding promotion. All items were included applying factor loading at .5 (Field, 2006)
(Table 7.13).
163
Factor 6 – Job Satisfaction (JOSA): This factor encompasses employees’ individual
commitment to the organisation (Agho et al., 1992). A seven-item scale developed by
Brayfild and Rothe (1951) was applied measuring the employees’ satisfaction with the
job during organisational change. Five items were included applying factor loading at .5
(Field, 2006) (Table 7.13).
Factor 7 – Job Involvement (JOIN): This factor encompasses employees’ individual
attachment to the organisation (Blau, 1999; McGinnis and Morrow, 1990). A five-item
scale developed by Kanungo (1982) was applied to measure job involvement. One item
was excluded applying factor loading at .5 (Field, 2006) (Table 7.13).
Career Commitment (CACO): This factor covers employees’ psychological attachment
to their career (Blau, 1999; McGinnis and Morrow, 1990). Eight items with a five-point
Likert Scale (Strongly Disagree, Strongly Agree) from Blau (1985) were used to
measure employee career commitment. Applying factor loading at .5 (Field, 2006) no
manifest variable loaded to any factor. Thus, this factor was excluded from the study.
Factor 8 – Supervisor and Peer Relation (SPRE): This factor encompasses employee
individual attachment to the organisation (Morrow, 1993). Five well-known items
concerning employee perception of supervisor support and advice on employee career
development or progression measured by Chang (1999) based Gaertner and Nollen
(1989) was applied. Two items were excluded applying factor loading at .5 (Field,
2006) (Table 7.13).
Factor 9 – Training and Skills Development (TSDE): This factor covers employees’
psychological attachment to the organisation (Gaertner and Nollen, 1989). A three-item
scale applied by Chang (1999) based on Mobley et al. (1978) and one item developed
by the researcher was applied to examine employees’ attitudes and behaviours. Three
items were included applying factor loading at .5 (Field, 2006) (Table 7.13).
164
Table 7.13 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Employee Commitment to
Career Scale
Factors and Related Items Factor Loading
Cronbach’s Alpha
Promotions (PMTN) This university prefers to promote from within rather than hire outsider for high level positions Over all, this university does a good job placing competent people in position This university does good job in moving people to new jobs when university require it
Job Satisfaction (JOSA) I feel fairly well satisfied with my present job I feel that my job is no more interesting than others I could get Each day of work seems like it will never end I find really enjoyment in my work I am disappointed that I ever took this job Job Involvement (JOIN) To me my Job is only a small part of whom I am I am very much involved personally in my job I live, eat and breathe my job I have very strong ties to job Supervisors and Peers Relations (SPRE) I can communicate well with my boss I respect my boss’s judgment on my issue My boss lets me know what is expected of me My boss encourages me to give my best efforts Training and Skills Development (TSDE) This university has a well defined training and skills development programmes for the employees I am given a real opportunity to improve my skills in this University I have been well trained by this university for my current job
.754 .769 .805 .701 .716 .792 .796 .692 .835 .741 .684 .689 .739 .820 .825 .834 .812 .825 .874
.883 .902 .894 .871 .857
Factor 10 – Social Relationships in the Workplace (SORE): This factor covers
employee social relationships in the workplace to measure the attachment to the
organisation (Hanpachern et al., 1997 and Madsen et al., 2005). A four-item scale was
adapted from the five item relationships subscales of Hanpachern’s Revised Margin in
Life scale (1998), which itself had been modified from the original published survey by
Stevenson in 1982. Three items were included applying factor loading at .5 (Field,
2006) (Table 7.14).
165
Table 7.14 Factor Loading and Cronbach’s Alpha of Social Relationships in the
Workplace Scale
Factor and Related Items Factor
Loading Cronbach’s Alpha
Social Relationships in the Workplace (SORE) My interpersonal relationships with my co workers are excellent My relationship to the leaders in my university is very positive The people I have met at my job are great
.708 .743 .817
.867
Factors structured above (Table 7.12, 7.13, 7.14) were conducted to establish
employees’ readiness for organisational change predictor variables. The factors which
had Eigenvalues greater than 1 were preserved. The measure of sampling adequacy
(MSA = .880) (Kaiser, 1974) and Bartlett Test of Sphericity (BTS = 12575.554, P =
0.000) demonstrated that exploratory factor analysis was applied correctly. The amount
of variance explained by these factors was 75.89% (Hair et al., 2006). Cronbach’s alpha
for each factor confirmed that the items in each factor were internally consistent
(Nunnally, 1978). This result indicated that these factors can be considered as the basis
for the confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) application. According to Anderson and
Gerbing (1988), casual relations between the underlying constructs and their related
indicators should be specified properly by confirmatory factor analysis before imposing
any casual relations among the constructs. In the next stage confirmatory factor analysis
was performed to assess the convergent and construct validity of scales.
7.5.2 Confirmatory Factor Analysis and Measurement Models
Confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) is a technique usually employed to confirm a priori
hypothesis about the relationship between a set of measurement items and their
respective factors (Netemeyer et al., 2003, p-148). Anderson and Gerbing (1988, p-422)
recommend a two-step approach in structural equation modelling which allows testing
of the significance of all pattern coefficients and provides a particularly useful
framework for formal comparisons of the substantive model of interest with the next
likely theoretical alternatives. Applying the measurement model assessment approach,
first the validity of the construct is tested by confirmatory factor analysis (Hair et al.,
2006). Following this approach, the relationships between the constructs were examined
by structural equation modelling.
166
The validity of a construct is an essential condition for further theory testing and
development (Carmines and Zeller, 1979; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991). Thus,
confirmatory factor analysis is used as a stricter assessment of construct validity to
ensure that the theoretical meaning of a construct is empirically captured by its
indicators (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991). Applying this approach,
the researcher assessed how well all the manifest variables of the same construct relate
to each other (Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Bagozzi et al., 1991; Anderson and Gerbing,
1988, Hair et al., 2006). Furthermore, measurement model assessment by confirmatory
factor analysis confirms the overall validity of the model such that nomological validity.
For that, goodness of fit indices of measurement models are used (Steenkamp and Trijp,
1991; Lages, 2000).
Assessing measurement model by confirmatory factor approach, maximum likelihood
(ML) estimation method was employed (Hair et al., 2006; Tabachnick and Fidell,
2007). This approach is applicable when the sample size does not meet the criterion of
having at least five observations for each variable (Bentler and Chou, 1987; Anderson
and Gerbing, 1988; Hair et al., 2006). The model fit indicators were utilised in model
validation in order to solve the likely problem of an unreliable χ2 (Chi-square) static and
standard errors due to ML application (Bentler and Chou, 1987). The researcher applied
separate measurement model estimation by confirmatory factor analysis for each scale
of the study.
Applying maximum likelihood estimation method for confirmatory factor analysis in
measurement model, first run the employees’ commitment to the organisation scale
elements. The model fit measures indicated a valid three factor solution. All of the items
for all three factors were retained. Table 7.15 shows the results of measurement model
structure results. Fit indices of model such that Chi-square (χ2) demonstrated a good fit,
root mean square error of approximation (RMSEA = .042), and goodness of fit measure
(GFI = .977) showed a good model fit (Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Bagozzi et al., 1991;
Hair et al., 2006). Further, incremental fit indices such that normated fit index (NFI =
.972), non normated fit index (NNFI = .983), normated comparative fit index (CFI =
.986) and adjusted goodness of fit index (AGFI = .963) also showed a good model fit
(Doll et al., 1994; Garver and Mentzer, 1999; Hair et al., 2006). It was concluded that
167
the measurement model of these three factors was nomologically valid (Steenkamp and
Trijp, 1991; Lages, 2000).
Table 7.15 Measurement Model of Employee Commitment to the Organisation
Variables Model Fit
Indicators* χ
2 Df RMSEA GFI NFI NNFI CFI AGFI
66.750 35 .042 .977 .972 .983 .986 .963 *χ2 – Chi square; df – degree of freedom; RMSEA – Root mean square error of approximation; GFI – Goodness of fit index; NFI – Normated fit index; NNFI – Non normated fit index; CFI – Comparative fit index; AGFI – Adjusted goodness of fit index
Assessing convergent validity of employees’ commitment to the organisation scale
measurement model, t value applied which showed as a critical ratio in the measurement
model (Table 7.16) (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Chau, 1997). All the t values of the items
were significantly greater than the critical value of 1.96 at the 0.99 confidence level and
all indicators showed higher individual squared multiple correlations (Reliabilities) than
0.50.
Table 7.16 Convergent Validity of Employee Commitment to the Organisation
Variables
Variables SMC* t-value
Emotional Attachment (EMAT) I am quite proud to be able to tell people who it is I work for I feel myself to be part of the university I would not recommend a close friend to join our staff Feeling of Pride (FOPR) I sometimes feel like leaving the employment for good Even if the university were not doing too well financially, I would be reluctant to change to another employer The offer of a bit more money with another employer would not seriously make me think of changing my job Pay/Wages/Rewards (PAWA) Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my training and education Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my effort that I input. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work experience Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work responsibilities
.717 .616 .694
.723
.621
.707
.572
.655
.579
.547
19.521 18.661
20.057
19.097
15.860
16.739
15.954
168
*SMC – Squared multiple correlation
Furthermore, all three constructs had high composite reliabilities (ρ > 0.70) (Table
7.17). The Cronbach’s alpha was above the criterion value (αEMAT = 0.861 > .70, αFOPR =
0.866 > .70, αPAWA = 0.851 > .70) (Nunnally, 1978) and the average variance extracted for
each construct was above 0.50 (Fornell and Larcker, 1981).
Table 7.17 Internal Consistency of Employee Commitment to the Organisation
Variables
Variables Composite Reliability (ρ)
Cronbach’s alpha (α)
Average Variance Extracted (AVE)
Emotional Attachment Feeling of Pride Pay/Wages/Rewards
.862
.866
.851
.861
.866
.851
.676
.684
.588
Next, employee career commitment scale elements were tested for measuring the uni-
dimensionality of factors by confirmative factor analysis. Overall, assessment of
measurement model showed that all five factors which extracted via exploratory factor
analysis were fit for the scale. For confirming the nomological validity of scale, element
fits tests were assessed and found fit (Table 7.18) (Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991; Lages,
2000). Fit indices of model (RMSEA = .046; GFI = .939) showed a good model fit
(Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Mueller, 1996; Bagozzi et al., 1991; Hair et al., 2006).
Further, incremental fit indices (NFI = .945; NNFI = .966; CFI = .970 and AGFI = .923)
also showed a good model fit (Doll et al., 1994; Garver and Mentzer, 1999; Hair et al.,
2006).
Table 7.18 Measurement Model of Employee Commitment to the Career
Variables
Model Fit Indicators*
χ2 Df RMSEA GFI NFI NNFI CFI AGFI
319.676 151 .046 .939 .945 .966 .970 .923 *χ2 – Chi square; df – degree of freedom; RMSEA – Root mean square error of approximation; GFI – Goodness of fit index; NFI – Normated fit index; NNFI – Non normated fit index; CFI – Comparative fit index; AGFI – Adjusted goodness of fit index
Convergent validity of employees’ career commitment scale measurement model was
assessed by t value (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Chau, 1997). In this model t value was shown
169
in critical ratio (Table 7.19). However, t values of all items were significantly greater
than the critical value of 1.96 at the 0.95 confidence level and all indicators showed
higher individual squared multiple correlations (reliabilities) than 0.50.
Table 7.19 Convergent Validity of Employee Career Commitment Variables
Variables SMC* t-value
Promotion (PMTN) This university prefers to promote from within rather than hire outsider for high level positions Over all, this university does a good job placing competent people in position This university does good job in moving people to new jobs when university require it
Job Satisfaction (JOSA) I feel fairly well satisfied with my present job I feel that my job is no more interesting than others I could get Each day of work seems like it will never end I find really enjoyment in my work I am disappointed that I ever took this job Job Involvement (JOIN) To me my job is only a small part of whom I am I am very much involved personally in my job I live, eat and breathe my job I have very strong ties to job Supervisor and Peer Relations (SPRE) I can communicate well with my boss I respect my boss’s judgment on my issue My boss lets me know what is expected of me My boss encourages me to give my best efforts Training and Skills Development (TSDE) This university has a well defined training and skills development programmes for the employees I am given a real opportunity to improve my skills in this University I have been well trained by this university for my current job
.593
.634
.788
.652
.707
.709
.604
.479
.807
.567
.611
.737
.634
.664
.678
.560
.593
.634
.788
21.569
21.889
16.427 23.531 16.413 15.570
26.059 19.739 26.056
17.151 17.969 18.056
18.520 19.036
*SMC – Squared multiple correlation
Furthermore, all five constructs had high composite reliabilities (ρ > 0.70) (Table 7.20).
The Cronbach’s alphas were above the criterion value (αPMTN = 0.883 > .70, αJOSA = 0.902
> .70, αJOIN = 0.894 > .70, αSPRE = 0.871 > .70, αTSDE = 0.857 > .70, (Nunnally, 1978) and
the average variance extracted for each construct was above 0.50 (Fornell and Larcker,
1981).
170
Table 7.20 Internal Consistency of Employees’ Career Commitment Variables
Variables Composite Reliability (ρ)
Cronbach’s alpha (α)
Average Variance Extracted (AVE)
Promotions Job Satisfaction Job Involvement Supervisor and Peer Relations Training and Skills Development
.880
.907
.894
.873
.859
.883
.902
.894
.871
.857
.672
.630
.680
.634
.671
The next scale was employee social relationships in the workplace which consisted of a
single factor with three latent variables. Measurement of the uni-dimensionality of the
factor by confirmative factor analysis test was conducted. Confirming the nomological
validity of scale element fits tests was assessed and found fit (Table 7.21) (Steenkamp
and Trijp, 1991; Lages, 2000). Fit indices of model (RMSEA = .0698; GFI = 1.00, NFI
= 1.00 and CFI = 1.00) showed a perfect model fit (Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Mueller,
1996; Bagozzi et al., 1991; Hair et al., 2006; Doll et al., 1994; Garver and Mentzer,
1999).
Table 7.21 Measurement Model of Social Relationships in the Workplace
Variable
Model Fit Indicators*
χ2 Df RMSEA GFI NFI NNFI CFI AGFI
.000 0 .069 1.000 1.000 --- 1.000 --- *χ2 – Chi square; df – degree of freedom; RMSEA – Root mean square error of approximation; GFI – Goodness of fit index; NFI – Normated fit index; NNFI – Non normated fit index; CFI – Comparative fit index; AGFI – Adjusted goodness of fit index
Convergent validity of social relationships in the workplace scale measurement model
was assessed by t value (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Chau, 1997). In this model t value was
shown in critical ratio (Table 7.22). However, t values of all items were significantly
greater than the critical value of 1.96 at the 0.95 confidence level and all indicators
showed higher individual reliabilities (Squared Multiple Correlations) than 0.50.
171
Table 7.22 Convergent Validity of Social Relationships in the Workplace Variable
Variables and Related items SMC* t-value
Social Relationships in the Workplace (SORE) My interpersonal relationships with my co workers are excellent My relationship to the leaders in my university is very positive The people I have met at my job are great
.659 .630 .773
20.037 19.667
*SMC – Squared multiple correlation
Furthermore, the construct had high composite reliability (ρ > 0.70) (Table 7.23). The
Cronbach’s alphas were above the criterion value (αSORE = 0.867 > .70) (Nunnally, 1978)
and the average variance extracted for each construct was above 0.50 (Fornell and
Larcker, 1981).
Table 7.23 Internal Consistency of Social Relationships in the Workplace
Variable
Variable Composite Reliability (ρ)
Cronbach’s alpha (α)
Average Variance Extracted (AVE)
Social Relationships in the workplace
.868
.867
.687
Finally, the dependent variable such that readiness for organisational change (ROCH)
was assessed by confirmatory factor analysis. The goodness of fit indices evidenced that
the measurement model was valid, thereby confirming nomological validity (Table
7.24) (Steenkamp and Trijp, 1991; Lages, 2000). The RMSEA measure was .051, which
is within the acceptable range of 0.05 and 0.08 (Garver and Mentzer, 1999), and NFI,
NNFI, CFI were above the 0.95 threshold value and GFI and AGFI were above critical
value (Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Mueller, 1996; Bagozzi et al., 1991; Hair et al., 2006;
Doll et al., 1994; Garver and Mentzer, 1999) (Table 7.24). All of the items for the
readiness for organisational change (ROCH) were retained.
172
Table 7.24 Measurement Model of Readiness for Organisational Change
Variable
Model Fit Indicators*
χ2 Df RMSEA GFI NFI NNFI CFI AGFI
32.676 14 .051 .982 .989 .990 .994 .965 *χ2 – Chi square; df – degree of freedom; RMSEA – Root mean square error of approximation; GFI – Goodness of fit index; NFI – Normated fit index; NNFI – Non normated fit index; CFI – Comparative fit index; AGFI – Adjusted goodness of fit index
The results of the confirmatory factor analysis application of this scale showed that the
convergent validity was satisfied. All t values of the manifest variables were higher than
the critical value of 1.96 at the 0.95 confidence level (Bagozzi et al., 1991; Chau, 1997)
(Table 7.25). Almost all indicators’ square multiple correlation such that individual
reliability were above the threshold value of 0.50.
Table 7.25 Convergent Validity of Readiness for Organisational Change
Variable
Items SMC* t-value
My willingness or Openness to solve university problems is My willingness or Openness to be a part of the new project is My willingness or Openness to create new ideas is My willingness or Openness to do things in a new or creative way is My willingness or Openness to change the way I work because of the change is My willingness or Openness to learn new things is My willingness or Openness to support change is
.725
.682
.735
.742 .647 .714 .643
22.638 21.679 22.859 23.017 20.881 22.379
*SMC – Squared multiple correlation
The readiness for organisational change construct showed high composite reliability (ρ
> 0.70) and the average variance extracted for the factor was above 0.50 (Fornell and
Larcker, 1981). Additionally, Cronbach alpha was above the criterion value (αROCH =
0.942 > .70), thereby exceeding the threshold value of .70 (Nunnally, 1978) (Table
7.26).
173
Table 7.26 Internal Consistency of Readiness for Organisational Change
Variable
Variable Composite Reliability (ρ)
Cronbach’s alpha (α)
Average Variance Extracted (AVE)
Readiness to organisational change
.941
.942
.698
7.5.2.1 Discriminant Validity
Construct validity examines the extent of measurement items to reflect the latent
construct which they are designed to measure. Discriminant validity is one part of
assessing construct validity in confirmatory factor analysis. It is the extent to which a
construct is truly distinct from other constructs (Hair et al., 2006, p-778). By using
average variance extracted, discriminant validity can be measured (Fornell and Larcker,
1981 and Hair et al., 2006).
Results of average variance extracted should be greater than the squared correlation
estimates (Fornell and Larcker, 1981; Hair et al., 2006, p-778). Using this approach, the
researcher found discriminant validity in all latent constructs (Table 7.27). The results
showed that values of all average variance extracted are greater than relevant squared
correlation estimates, thereby confirming discriminant validity.
In summary, the overall results of construct validity using nomological, convergent and
discriminant validity assessment of the measurement model provided statistically and
theoretically valid constructs. Thus the underlying latent variables for the structural
equation model testing stage were robustly established.
174
Table 7.27 Discriminant Validity
Variables 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
1.SORE .697
2.TSDE .147 .669
3.SPRE .080 .427 .632
4.JOIN -.002 .082 .124 .677
5.JOSA .349 .162 .093 .237 .646
6.PMTN .003 .138 .136 .037 .216 .716
7.PAWA .274 .283 .133 .159 .450 .287 .587
8.FOPR -.051 .093 .060 .036 .189 .098 .177 .682
9.EMAT .007 -.013 .020 .093 .171 -.052 .129 -.116 .675
10.ROCH .258 .114 .072 .240 .555 .278 .500 .289 .222 .697 Note: Average variance was extracted from the squared multiple correlation estimates as a formula given by (Fornell and Larcker, 1981).
Note: ROCH = readiness for change; EMAT = emotional attachment, FOPR = feeling of pride, PAWA = pay/wages/rewards, PMTN = promotion, JOSA = job satisfaction, JOIN = job involvement, SPRE = supervisor and peer relations, TSDE = training and skills development, SORE, social relationships in the workplace.
7.5.3 Assessment of Model Fit
A two step approach was adopted to proceed with the study as mentioned in section
7.5.2. Following the measurement model estimation, a structural equation modelling
technique was applied that allows a set of relationships between independent and
dependent variables. According to Hair et al. (2006, p-22) structural equation modelling
provides the appropriate and most efficient estimation technique for a series of separate
multiple regression equations estimated simultaneously.
Overall fit of the structural model confirm consistency of the theoretical model and the
estimated model which is based on the observed values (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw,
2000; Hair et al., 2006). So many methods are available to test the overall model fit,
however none of them alone can provide an absolute assurance of model fit. Kline
(1998, p-130) recommended at least four tests such that chi-square; GFI, NFI, or CFI;
NNFI; and SRMR. However, most common fit indices are chi-square (χ2), Goodness of
Fit Index (GFI), Adjusted Goodness of Fit Index (AGFI), and Root Mean Square Error
Approximation (RMSEA). During analysis no constraints were imposed to any
parameter relating to manifest and latent variables.
175
Overall fit of the model to the observed data was examined in order to assess whether
the model was valid. Table 7.28 shows the results for the goodness of fit indices.
Absolute and incremental fit indices were demonstrated and found that the model was
an adequate representation of the independent and dependent proposed constructs.
Applying root mean square error approximation to find model fit, the result was 0.039,
which is below the cut-off value of 0.05 (Hair et al., 2006; Garver and Mentzer, 1999).
The NFI, NNFI, and CFI measures were applied to measure the model goodness of fit.
The figures for these indices were .950, .953, and .956 respectively which were above
the 0.95 criterion value (Diamantopoulos and Siguaw, 2000; Doll et al., 1994; Hair et
al., 2006; Mueller, 1996). The GFI and AGFI were 0.89 and 0.87, respectively. There
appears to be some difference regarding the recommended threshold value of 0.90 (Hair
et al., 2006). However, Doll et al. (1994) and Durande-Moreau and Usunier (1999)
suggest that a criterion of 0.80 is considered acceptable. Since the values for GFI and
AGFI were within the acceptable range from 0.80 to 0.90, the model fit was considered
acceptable. Thus, the absolute fit measures indicate that the structural equation model
represents a satisfactory fit for the sample data collected. The χ2 statistic divided by the
degree of freedom also indicates a reasonable fit at 1.77. It can be concluded that the
proposed model maintains a good fit from the observed data.
Table 7.28 Model Fit Indicators
Model Fit Indicators*
χ2 Df RMSEA GFI NFI NNFI CFI AGFI
1225.903 692 .039 .888 .950 .953 .956 .874 *χ2 – Chi square; df – degree of freedom; RMSEA – Root mean square error of approximation; GFI – Goodness of fit index; NFI – Normated fit index; NNFI – Non normated fit index; CFI – Comparative fit index; AGFI – Adjusted goodness of fit index
7.6 Hypotheses Testing
An operational model is shown in Figure 4.1 in the theoretical framework chapter. The
base of analysis of the model is organisations (universities) as the variables to be
analysed at the organisation level. Based on the structural model, the research
hypotheses were tested from the standardised estimate and t value (critical ratio). For
data analysis, the researcher employed AMOS 16.0 for Windows software to run the
model for examining the hypotheses. Results are summarised in the following Table
176
7.29 and shown in the operational model (Figure 7.1). Using path estimates and t values
(critical ratio) nine hypotheses were examined in this study. Seven of the t values were
above the 1.96 critical values at the 0.01 significant levels. The remaining two construct
in relation to dependent variables, t values were not found significant (tcritical = -.480, p =
.631 and tcritical = -.971, p = .331).
The aim of this thesis is to predict the causal relationships between a dependent variable
such that readiness for organisational change (ROCH) and independent variables such
that emotional attachment (EMAT), feeling of pride (FOPR), pay/wages/rewards
(PAWA), promotion (PMTN), job satisfaction (JOSA), job involvement (JOIN),
supervisor and peer relations (SPRE), training and skills development (TSDE), and
social relationships in the workplace (SORE). In this study independent variables were
selected from three different scales such that employees commitment to the
organisation, employees career commitment and social relationships in the workplace.
The first three factors such that EMAT, FOPR, and PAWA are related to employee
commitment to the organisation. The remaining five elements such that PMTN, JOSA,
JOIN, SPRE, and TSDE are concerned with employee commitment to the career scales.
Only one predictor such that SORE is related to social relationships in the workplace
scale.
177
Figure 7.1 Model
178
Table 7.29 Regression Weights
Variables Estimate S.E. C.R. P
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Emotional Attachment .177 .043 4.086 ***
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Feeling of Pride .247 .049 5.069 ***
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Pay/wages/rewards .358 .066 5.397 ***
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Promotion .167 .044 3.778 ***
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Job Satisfaction .389 .053 7.299 ***
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Job Involvement .176 .057 3.066 .002
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Supervisor and Peer Relations -.025 .053 -.480 .631
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Training and Skills Development -.040 .042 -.971 .331
Readiness for Organisational Change <--- Social Relationship in the Workplace .130 .049 2.647 .008 Note: S.E = standard error, C.R = critical ratio, P = significance value
179
In the hypothesised model figure, the paths between independent variables and
dependent variables were found to be significant except two such that supervisor and
peer relations and training and skills development. It was found that emotional
attachment (EMAT), feeling of pride (FOPR), pay/wages/rewards (PAWA), promotion
(PMTN), job satisfaction (JOSA), job involvement (JOIN), and social relationships in
the workplace (SORE) had a statistically significant impact on readiness for
organisational change (ROCH). The first independent predictor variable of employee
commitment to the organisation scale elements such that emotional attachment was
found to be positively and significantly related to the dependent variable such that
readiness for organisational change (β = .177, p < 0.01, tEMAT = 4.086) (H1 accepted).
The influence of the second independent predictor on the same scale such that feeling of
pride was confirmed to be positively and significantly related to readiness for
organisational change (β = .247, p < 0.01, tFOPR = 5.069) (H2 accepted). Among the
employee commitment to the organisation scale elements, the pay/wages/rewards
construct had the highest impact on employees’ readiness for organisational change
construct (β = .358, p < 0.01, tPAWA = 5.397) (H3 accepted). The above results indicated
that all organisational commitment constructs applied in this study had positive and
significant relationships to readiness for organisational change. That means, when the
employees have a commitment to the organisation, they are more likely to openness or
readiness for organisational change.
As a result of this assessment the following hypotheses were accepted (Table 7.30).
There is a positive significant relationship between emotional attachment (EMAT) and
employee readiness for organisational change (ROCH) (H1), there is a positive
significant relationship between feeling of pride (FOPR) and employee readiness for
organisational change (ROCH) (H2), there is positive significant relationship between
pay and wages (PAWA) and employee readiness for organisational change (ROCH)
(H3).
The evaluation of the structural equation modelling regarding the relationships between
the construct of employee career commitment as an independent predictor and
employee readiness for organisational change as a dependent variable showed that first
three independent variables are determinants for the dependent variable. The
standardised estimates and t values (Table 7.29) showed that the paths of first three
180
independent factors to the dependent factor were positively and statistically significant.
The first independent predictor of this scale such that promotion was found to be
positively and significantly related to the dependent variable such that readiness for
organisational change (β = .167, p < 0.01, tPMTN = 3.778) (H4 accepted). Among the
employee career commitment scale elements, the job satisfaction construct had the
highest impact on employee readiness for organisational change construct (β = .389, p <
0.01, tJOSA = 7.299) (H5 accepted). The influence of the third independent predictor on
same scale such that job involvement (JOIN) to readiness for organisational change
(ROCH) was also found to be positively and significantly related (β = .176, p < 0.01,
tJOIN = 3.066) (H6 accepted). The examination of corresponding path estimates and t
values for the links between supervisor and peer relationships (SPRE) and readiness for
organisational change (ROCH) were not found to be positively and significantly related
(β = -.025, p > 0.05, tSPRE = -.480) (H7 rejected). The influence of the last independent
predictor on same scale such that training and skills development was not confirmed to
be positively and significantly related to readiness for organisational change (β = -.040,
p > 0.05, tTSDE = -.971) (H8 rejected).
The above results indicate that three predictors out of five of employee commitment to
their career scale had positive and significant relationships to readiness for
organisational change. Two predictors such that supervisor and peer relations (SPRE)
and training and skills development (TSDE) were not confirmed to be positive and
significant relationships to readiness for organisational change. That means, employees
who are committed to their career by promotion, job satisfaction and job involvement
are more likely to be open to accept organisational change. As a result of this
assessment the following hypotheses in the scale of employee career commitment was
accepted (Table 7.30). There is a significant relationship between promotion (PMTN)
and employee readiness for organisational change (ROCH) (H4), there is a significant
relationship between job satisfaction (JOSA) and employee readiness for organisational
change (ROCH) (H5), there is significant relationship between job involvement (JOIN)
and employee readiness for organisational change (ROCH) (H6). In this scale, two
constructs such that SPRE and TSDE were not confirmed to the dependent variable thus
the two hypotheses such that there is a significant relationship between supervisor and
peer relationship and employee readiness for organisational change (SORE) (H7), and
181
there is significant relationship between training and skills development and employee
readiness for organisational change (TSDE) (H8) were rejected.
In last scale, only one element (social relationships in the workplace) was hypothesised
as an independent variable in the model (Figure 4.1). The influence of this predictor had
the lowest impact on employee readiness for organisational change construct in this
study. However, the standardised estimates and t values (Table 7.29) showed that the
path between independent variable and dependent variable such that readiness for
organisational change was found to be positive and significant (β = .130, p < 0.01, tSORE
= 2.647) (H9 accepted). That means, employee who have positive social relationships in
the workplace are more likely to open or accept organisational change. As a result of
this assessment the hypothesis in this scale such that there is a significant relationship
between social relationships in the workplace (SORE) and employee readiness for
organisational change (ROCH) (H9) was accepted.
The explanatory power of the structural equation model was assessed on the basis of the
squared multiple correlations (SMC) for structural equations which indicate the amount
of variance in the dependent (endogenous) variable accounted for by the independent
(exogenous) variable. Overall variance in the dependent variable such that readiness for
organisational change (ROCH) construct was 67% by the independent variables such
that emotional attachment (EMAT), feeling of pride (FOPR), pay/wages/rewards
(PAWA), promotion (PMTN), job satisfaction (JOSA), job involvement (JOIN), and
social relationships in the workplace (SORE). All these predictors have positive and
statistically significant relationships to ROCH. The squared multiples correlations value
for the structural equation demonstrates the relationships between the predictor
variables. The relationship between EMAT, FOPR, PAWA, PMTN, JOSA, JOIN, and
SORE to ROCH construct was .20, .27, .45, .25, .52, .21, .47, .098, .24, respectively.
These values showed as 20%, 27%, 45%, 25%, 52%, 21%, 47%, 9.8%, and 24%
variance, respectively to the readiness for change construct. The overall model
accounted for 43% of the variance in readiness for organisational change scores.
Standardisedd beta scores for the model showed that job satisfaction and
pay/wages/rewards were the best predictors of readiness for organisational change
successively. To control multi-collinearity in the factors, the researcher followed Aiken
182
and West (1991) deviation score procedure. Inspection of variance inflation factor
scores (VIFs) indicated that there were no instances of problematic multi-collinearity
among any of the factors. Each VIF was less than 1.884, which is far less than the 10.0
threshold suggested by Neter et al. (1996). However, standardised beta score of social
relationships in the workplace was confirmed as a lesser predictor of readiness for
organisational change in the model. The summary of hypotheses testing is presented in
the following table.
Table 7.30 Summary of Results of Hypotheses Testing
Hypotheses Results
H1: There is a significant positive relationship between feeling of pride and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H2: There is a significant positive relationship between emotional attachment and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H3: There is a significant positive relationship between pay/wages/rewards and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H4: There is a significant positive relationship between promotion and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H5: There is a significant positive relationship between job satisfaction and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H6: There is a significant positive relationship between job involvement and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
H7: There is a significant positive relationship between supervisors and peers relationship and employee readiness for organisational change.
Rejected
H8: There is a significant positive relationship between training and skills development and employee readiness for organisational change.
Rejected
H9: There is a significant positive relationship between social relationships in the workplace and employee readiness for organisational change.
Accepted
7.7 Conclusion
In conclusion, this chapter presents the findings from final purified scales and
hypotheses testing. Initially, data was screened through pointing out missing data and
183
data outliers in order to prepare for further analysis. Accuracy of data was assessed
through linearity, normality and homoscedasticity tests to infer accurate results that data
portray. This section was followed by the explanation of factor loading to identify the
groups or clusters of variables. An exploratory factor analysis technique was used to
show the relationship of variables to factors. In this section factors were extracted with
the help of eigenvalues and scree plot. Applying Varimax of orthogonal technique in
principal component, factors were rotated which showed maximum variance of factor
loading. The finding showed significant results in which ten factors were extracted out
of twelve. The measurement scale for this research was subjected to confirmatory factor
analysis (CFA) after the exploratory factor analysis. The measurement model and
structural model was assessed in AMOS 16.0 version software on the basis of 518
cases. Before inferring results, reliability and construct validity tests were also
conducted in which all measurement scales were found satisfactory. As for hypotheses
testing, standardised estimates and t values were applied from the structural model. The
findings showed statistically significant positive relationships between independent
variables and the dependent variable. All independent variables related to employees’
commitment to the organisation scale such that emotional attachment, feeling of pride,
pay/wages/rewards were found positively and significantly correlated to the
independent variable such that readiness for organisational change. Further, in the
career commitment scale, three constructs such that promotion, job satisfaction and job
involvement was found positively and significantly related to readiness for
organisational change. But two factors such that supervisor and peer relations and
training and skills development was not found positively and significantly to readiness
for organisational change. In the third scale, only one factor such that social
relationships in the workplace was used and found positively and significantly related to
readiness for organisational change. Furthermore, results confirmed through squared
multiple correlations in which all factors possessed predictive power except supervisor
and peer relations and training and scale development which was found to be a
negatively predicted factor. The results of significant relationships between constructs
were as theoretically expected. However, more detailed discussion of the findings will
be provided in the next chapter.
184
Chapter Eight Discussion
8.1 Introduction
The objectives of this study was to examine the relationships and predictive influence of
independent variables such that emotional attachment, feeling of pride,
pay/wages/rewards, promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer
relations, training and skills development and social relationships in the workplace to a
dependent variable such that employee readiness for organisational change. These
independent elements were explored from the employee commitment perspectives to the
attitudes and behaviours. This was a cross sectional study in which data was received
from public sector universities of Pakistan.
In this study hypotheses were developed on the basis of relationships between
independent and dependent variables. The general findings in this study are that
supervisor and peer relations and training and skills development elements are not
considered to be a predictive factor to employee readiness for organisational change.
Whereas a direct relationship between emotional attachment, feeling of pride,
pay/wages/rewards, promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement and social
relationships in the workplace to readiness for organisational change was found. An
explanation about these unexpected results will be provided later on in this chapter.
The structure of this chapter is as follows. First, the population and sample issues are
presented and second part is concerned to the results of scale purification. Third, the
findings of all hypotheses tested are reviewed and compared with past research. Finally,
the results of social relationships in the workplace to readiness for organisational
change will be discussed.
8.2 Population and Sample Issue
This study was conducted in public sector higher educational institutions in Pakistan.
The total population of faculty members of public sector higher education institutions is
10,471 in all sixty eight universities (HEC, no date a). For data collection, a random
sampling was done (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al., 2006) from full time
185
faculty members in all categories such that professors, associate professors, assistant
professors, and lecturers. Of the 1000 questionnaires distributed among the faculty
members from thirty three different public sector universities including medical,
engineering, agricultural as well as general in all four provinces of Pakistan, 556 were
returned, which shows a response rate of 55.6%. A large enough sample was applied to
represent the population and underlying structure because of examining the reliable
correlations and prediction power of factors (Tabachnick and Fidell, 2007; Hair et al.,
2006). According to Comery and Lee (1992), a sample size of 50 - 100 is treated as
poor, 200 as fair, 300 as good and 500 as very good and 1000 is treated as excellent.
Thus, this study covered a large sample and provided a substantive representation of the
total population of public sector universities. However, the respondent rate was not so
good because they were asked to participate on a voluntary basis (Methodology
Chapter).
From the sample data, dealing with missing data is an important issue. In social science
research, there are various suggestions like using the mean of the scores on the variance
(Stevens, 1992) or removing the sample(s) who do not respond to any question
(Norusis, 1995). To find the missing data, this study found 25 samples of missing data
out of 556 samples which is 4.49% and does not make any difference to the outcome of
analysis. Thus, 25 samples were deleted from the data and then tested for finding
outliers. Outliers cannot be categorically characterised as either beneficial or
problematic (Hair et al., 2006) but they can bias the mean and inflate the standard
deviations (Field and Hole, 2003). Thus, the researcher should be aware of such values
because they bias the model research fit to the data (Field, 2006). The researcher applied
a graphical method for detecting the univariate outliers and Mahalanobis distance case
was applied for finding multivariate outliers to confirm their effect. In box plot, 11
univariate outliers which attached with asterisk (Table 7.1) were detached and also
compared with the multivariate outliers test by Mahalanobis’s distance test which
confirmed only four samples. After finding outliers this study was confined to 518
samples for the final study.
186
8.3 Measurement Scale Purification
The scale for the study such that employee readiness for organisational change,
employee commitment to the organisation, employee career commitment and social
relationships in the workplace was developed primarily on the basis of conceptual
articles. Thus, the first issue to be discussed is the operationalisation and validation of
the concepts in this study. The item pool for the scale was subjected to quantitative
refinement. Content and face validity was assessed in a pilot study in which participants
were asked to give their opinions about the items. In addition, the survey instrument
was assessed through expert field researchers in the university (Hardesty and Bearden,
2004) at the initial stage of research. Experts were asked to comment on the lists of
scale items. Moreover, the developed scales were subjected to two rounds of data
reduction such that exploratory factor analysis (EFA) and confirmatory factor analysis
(CFA) and several statistical tests like convergent validity (CV), discriminant validity
(DV), composite reliability (ρ), Cronbach’s alpha reliability (α) and average variance
extracted (AVE). As a result, theoretically and operationally valid and reliable scales
were developed and hypotheses testing were performed with the scale. However, some
inferences were made on the scale development and refinement issues which are
discussed as followed.
Overall, the finalised scales were found to possess satisfactory validity and reliability
and were consequently employed in the hypotheses testing. Besides, in the pilot study, a
few suggestions were received from the participants to strengthen and make clearer the
survey questionnaire. First, the word ‘university’ was inserted instead of ‘organisation’,
which have made it clearer to participants to provide response about his or her
university. Second, in the demography scale, the option for gender and marital status
should be open. This suggestion could reduce gender bias. Third, in the item on highest
educational level, Bachelor of Engineering (BE) and Bachelor in Medicine and
Bachelor in Surgery (MBBS) were included because this study was to be conducted in
all types of university in Pakistan including professional and general universities. Thus,
for medical and engineering universities the basic appointment requirement is a
bachelor’s degree which meant that this option should be included in the relevant
question. Finally, in the readiness for organisational change scale the phrase ‘my
willingness or openness’ was applied once for all items in the scale at the beginning.
187
Participants suggested putting this phrase with all questions items which might be more
easily understood.
The dimensionality of almost all constructs is consistent with those reported in the
literature. However, a few factors were not loaded into any factor or group of predictors
in the exploratory factor analysis technique. Thus, the researcher extracted “take what
the data give you” for testing hypotheses (Hair et al., 2006, p-104). Two factors, one
from each of the employee commitment to the organisation and career scales were not
loaded into a group in this test. The first factor such that personal sense of obligation
(PSO) was not grouped when the three item scale developed by Cook and Wall (1980)
and factor analysis conducted by Mathews and Shepherd (2002) were applied. This
predictor was used as an attitudinal attachment of employee for organisation (Mathews
and Shepherd, 2002; Madsen et al., 2005). In addition, it should be noted that two other
factors such that emotional attachment and feeling of pride used in this scale were
loaded to their respective predictor to show the employee psychological attachment for
organisational change (Miller et al., 2006; Madsen et al., 2005). This issue especially
concerns the concept of affective commitment in which all three factors were assessed
in past literature. The literature suggested that in less affluent societies, employees are
influenced by psychological and role related factors with commitment (Alvi and
Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999).
The second factor was career commitment from employee commitment to the career
scale. Eight items from Blau (1985) were used to measure the employee career
commitment. This was used because employee personal variables can affect the
individual’s loyalty and identification. In exploratory factor analysis no one group of
manifest variables formed. Thus, this factor was excluded from the study. All remaining
factors from independent predictor variables such that pay/wages/rewards, promotion,
job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, training and skills
development, and social relationships in the workplace and the dependent variable such
that readiness for organisational change were grouped in their respective group.
However, a few latent variables were excluded from these predictors due to less or cross
loading (Previous Chapter).
188
In summary, the findings from the scale purification reflect two main ideas. First, when
the scale is adapted and applied to another culture and region, it is necessary to assess
the relevance of the context of the scale to achieve the validity of inferences (Singh,
1995). The first and most fundamental question may be whether the same context exists
in another country. Moreover, if it exists, it may not have the same form or it may have
different elements in other countries (Craig and Douglas, 2000, p-256). Second, to
ensure the applicability of adapted scales, it is crucial to assess external validity in
addition to internal criteria such that reliability and validity (Craig and Douglas, 2000).
However, researcher assessed construct validity which is an essential condition for
further theory testing and development (Carmines and Zeller, 1979; Steenkamp and
Trijp, 1991; Bagozzi et al., 1991).
8.4 Determinants of Readiness for Organisational Change: Effects of Employee
Commitment to the Organisation
This study is concerned with examining employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours to
readiness for organisational change. Overall, employee commitment to the organisation
predictors has a statistically significant and positive relationship with readiness for
organisational change. The relationship between each element of employee commitment
to the organisation is also found to be statistically significant. This suggest that, other
things being equal, the more commitment to the organisation that is perceived, the more
open and ready for the organisational change.
In the literature, commitment has been conceptualised as an attitudinal and behavioural
aspect of employees towards an organisation or work in the domain of organisational
behaviour and social relations (Oliver, 1990; Meyer et al., 1989). An attitudinal
approach seeks the nature and quality of relationships, while a behavioural approach is
based on an individual’s sense of attachment not to an organisation but to their action
(Oliver, 1990). Researchers have directly or indirectly focused on commitment as
attitudinal and behavioural approaches to employee readiness for organisational change
(Madsen et al., 2005; Eby et al., 2000; Weber and Weber, 2001).
A central theme emerges from the conceptual framework (refer chapter five) that
employee develop positive attitudes and behaviours on the basis of expectations and
189
benefits provided by organisation. Alvi and Ahmed (1987); Chang (1999) supported the
view that in organisation, employee can be satisfied by fulfilling their psychological and
financial needs. Thus, this study applied employee psychological predictor variables
such that emotional attachment (loyalty), personal sense of obligation (involvement)
and feeling of pride (identification) (Cook and Wall, 1980; Buchanan, 1974; Mathews
and Shepherd, 2002; Madsen et al., 2005) and a financial predictor such that
pay/wages/rewards to examine employee attitudes and behaviours to readiness for
organisational change. Allen and Meyer (1990); Gautam et al. (2001); Penley and
Gould (1988) empirically supported the concept by analysing the psychological and
financial perspective of employees to understand their attitudes and behaviours towards
the organisation. In the literature, affective, moral, alienative and normative elements
were used as psychological factors and instrumental or continuance components were
used as financial predictors (Allen and Meyer, 1990; Gautam et al., 2001; Penley and
Gould, 1988).
This researcher applied the predictors reported above as independent variables to
examine employees’ attitudes and behaviours towards change in higher educational
institutions in Pakistan. Applying exploratory factor analysis using SPSS 15.0 version
for Windows, three factors (emotional attachment, feeling of pride and
pay/wages/rewards) were loaded. In this study, the sense of obligation (involvement)
factor was not loaded independently or with any other factor. This suggested reassessing
the dimensionality of the instrument using confirmatory factor analysis (Mathews and
Shepherd, 2002). Applying confirmatory factor analysis in AMOS 16.0 version
software, the result confirmed same three factors for organisational commitment. This
appeared to confirm that employees of higher educational institutions are concerned to
help their organisation for personal gain and psychological attachment.
The results were assessed for the relative influence of the three predictor variables such
that emotional attachment, feeling of pride and pay/wages/rewards to readiness for
organisational change by their standard coefficients (β coefficient) (Table 7.22). The
results indicated a positive prediction to the dependent variable such that readiness for
organisational change. A Beta coefficient of emotional attachment (β = .177, p < 0.01,
tEMAT = 4.086) indicated a positive contribution to readiness for organisational change.
This seemed reasonable, at least in higher educational institutions, where employee
190
develop their attitudes and behaviours on the basis of emotional attachment. Indeed,
employee intends to stay or show a sense of attachment (Cook and Wall, 1980) to their
institutions. In previous research, emotional attachment has been assessed to understand
the attitudes and behaviours of employees (Madsen et al., 2005; Mathews and
Shepherd, 2002; Cook and wall, 1988) and found positive results. In this research, the
results supported H1 (There is a significant positive relationship between emotional
attachment and employees’ readiness for organisational change) and provided evidence
of employee affection for their organisation as has been claimed. Moreover, this finding
also confirms and expands existing knowledge for organisations in Pakistan (Alvi and
Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999).
The results of the second predictive variable such that a feeling of pride in the
organisational commitment scales predicted more than emotional attachment. A beta
coefficient of feeling of pride (identification) (β = .247, p < 0.01, tFOPR = 5.069)
indicated a positive contribution to readiness for organisational change. The results
showed that employees of higher educational institutions contribute more towards
change because of a feeling of pride. Again, this seemed reasonable, at least in higher
educational institutions, where employees tend to understand the organisation’s goals
and values (Cook and Wall, 1980). In previous research, a feeling of pride was assessed
to understand employee attitudes and behaviours (Madsen et al., 2005; Mathews and
Shepherd, 2002; Cook and Wall, 1988) and found positive results. In this research, the
results supported H2 (There is a significant positive relationship between a feeling of
pride and employees’ readiness for organisational change) and provided evidence of
employee commitment to the goals and values of the organisation. Moreover, this
finding also confirms and expands existing knowledge for organisations in Pakistan
(Alvi and Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999).
In the scale of employee commitment to the organisation, the pay/wages/rewards
construct had the highest impact on employee readiness for organisational change
construct (β = .358, p < 0.01, tPAWA = 5.397) (H3 accepted). The results supported H3
(There is a significant positive relationship between pay/wages/rewards and employee
readiness for organisational change) and provided evidence of the employee satisfaction
with the organisation. A beta coefficient indicated a positive contribution to the
endogenous factor. The results showed that employees of higher educational institutions
191
contribute more to this factor than to others in the same scale for change readiness. It
can be claimed that on the basis of financial rewards, employee entrenchment increased
and they become more loyal and involved in the organisation. It may also be concluded
that employees are more open and ready as a result of intrinsic rewards than extrinsic.
Mottaz (1988) advocated that tangible rewards are the most useful way to facilitate and
motivate employees to perform tasks and remain with an organisation. This also
confirms the finding that employees are more satisfied by intrinsic job rewards revealed
by Yoon and Thye (2002). This suggests that employee who receive encouragement and
rewards for change are more likely to act voluntarily in support of organisational change
goals and contribute to overall organisational effectiveness (Organ, 1988; Van yperen et
al., 1999). This finding is also confirmed from a policy document of Higher Education
Commission of Pakistan, which suggests that financial rewards for faculty members can
improve their performance (HEC, 2005, no date b).
In summary, providing an environment that encourages emotional attachment, a feeling
of pride and good pay/wages/rewards can help organisations to effectively influence
employee attitudes and behaviours. The above results indicate that all organisational
commitment constructs applied in this study had positive and significant relationships
with the readiness for change construct. That means, in public sector higher educational
institution of Pakistan, when employees are committed to the organisation, they are
more likely to be open or readiness for organisational change. This conceptualisation
suggests that committed employees have a strong belief in and acceptance of the
organisation’s goals and values, show a willingness to exert considerable efforts on
behalf of the organisation and have a strong desire to maintain membership of the
organisation (Mathews and Shepherd, 2002, p-369). One predictor factor such that
sense of obligation was not loaded in the group and another factor such that
pay/wages/rewards predicted more to readiness for organisational change along with the
rest of organisational commitment factors are noteworthy for future research in other
contexts of organisations.
8.5 Determinants of Readiness for Organisational Change: Effects of Employee
Career Commitment
Career commitment of employee has been conceptualised to develop positive attitudes
192
and behaviours to work (Blau, 1985; Chang, 1999; Poon, 2004). This concept was
characterised by the development of personal career goals and the individual’s
attachment to, identification with and involvement in those goals (Collarelli and Bishop,
1990). As discussed in chapter four, employee of organisation can develop attitudes and
behaviours on the basis of career commitment which is reflected by individual and
situational factors (London, 1983; Blau, 1985; McGinnis and Morrow, 1990; Goulet
and Singh, 2002).
In this study, individual and situational factors have been applied to examine employee
attitudes and behaviours in higher educational institutions of Pakistan during
organisational change programmes. In the individual scale, career commitment, job
satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, and training and skills
development were applied and for situational only one factor such that promotion was
applied. Job satisfaction, job involvement and promotion predictor variables had
statistically significant and positive relationships to readiness for change. However, the
supervisor and peer relations and training and skills development variables were not
found to have a statistically significant relationship to readiness for change. This
suggests that, all things being equal, the more career commitment that is perceived, the
more openness and readiness for organisational change will be noted in the public sector
higher educational institutions of Pakistan.
Applying exploratory factor analysis using SPSS 15.0 version for Windows, all factors
except one (career commitment) were not loaded. This suggested reassessing the
dimensionality of the instrument using confirmatory factor analysis (Mathews and
Shepherd, 2002). Applying confirmatory factor analysis in AMOS 16.0 version
Software, the results did not confirm the same factors for employee career commitment.
In organisations, employee has no lifelong contract with their employer and this may
create uncertainty among employees. This feeling grows among employees during
periods of economic turbulence, which result in downsizing and restructuring (Morrow,
1993; Hall and Associates, 1986). Many elements of the work environment like job
contract, fear of job loss, job fit and organisational uncertainty are likely to be important
to develop career motivation. In situational factors, researchers (Goulet and Singh,
2002) have used variables like organisational uncertainty, fear of job loss and job fit
193
factors to know the employee’s cognition level towards their career commitment. In this
research study, the researcher examined one situational factor such that promotion to
measure employee attitudes and behaviours to career commitment. This may lead to
employee readiness for organisational change programmes.
Situational factors are related to the relationship between employee and organisation on
the basis of an agreement to provide services. Thus, this can affect an individual’s
attitudes and behaviours for organisational change. In the theoretical framework of this
study, promotion was conceptualised as an independent predictor variable to readiness
for organisational change. Because, employee believes that an organisation pursues
promotion as internal policy, they are more committed (Gaertner and Nollen, 1989). In
this study, three items used by Chang (1999) based on Gaertner and Nollen (1989) study
was adapted to examine the employee’s perception about promotion. A beta coefficient
of promotion (β = .167, p < 0.01, tPMTN = 3.778) indicated a positive contribution to
change readiness. This statistical finding shows that internal promotion policy can
influence employee attitudes and behaviours towards organisational change. Hence, the
results support H4: There is a significant positive relationship between promotion and
employee readiness for organisational change, which is also evidence of employee
satisfaction with their career.
In the current situation where economic, financial, developmental, competitive and
environmental dimensions are fragile, particularly in Pakistan, it may be claimed that on
the basis of promotion, employee sense of security can increase and they become more
loyal and involved with the organisation. In literature, the predictor has been applied
and found positively significant to employee commitment for career (Gaertner and
Nollen, 1989; Chang, 1999). This suggests that employee who receive encouragement
in the form of promotion according to policy are more likely to act voluntarily in
support of organisational change goals and contribute to overall organisational
effectiveness (Organ, 1988; Van yperen et al., 1999). This finding discovered that
internal promotion policy can encourage individuals to be more open and ready for
organisational change in Pakistan especially for higher education sector. This finding is
evident from the review of official document of the Higher Education Commission of
Pakistan (HEC) that the retention of productive faculty members in higher education
system is necessary and important; therefore, the HEC has announced a tenure track
194
system of faculty appointment on an attractive salary package comparable to that
offered by the private sector (HEC, 2009).
According to Table (7.29), the effect of the individual job satisfaction factor was found
to be strong as was expected. Results were assessed by their standard coefficients (β
coefficient). A beta coefficient of job satisfaction (β = .389, p < 0.01, tJOSA = 7.299)
indicated a positive contribution to readiness for organisational change. This statistical
finding showed that job satisfaction can influence employee attitudes and behaviours
towards organisational change. Among the individual factors of employee commitment
to the career scale elements, the job satisfaction construct had the highest impact on the
employee readiness for organisational change construct (H5 accepted). As noted in the
results, there was support for a positive relationship between readiness for
organisational change and job satisfaction. Thus, H5: there is a significant positive
relationship between job satisfaction (JOSA) and employee readiness for organisational
change was accepted.
Job satisfaction has been defined as the degree to which employee likes their work
(Agho et al., 1992). It is related with employee personal factors (Goulet and Singh,
2002) for active feelings towards his or her job. These feelings can be generated when
an organisation provides all the facilities and benefits to promote employee
development and progression. The results indicated that employees of public sector
educational institutions like the jobs and the organisation and this supported previous
results in which employees are satisfied by his or her job. A satisfied employee is
expected to like his or her job and the organisation and will probably be committed to
his or her career (Goulet and Singh, 2002, p-78). Many researchers have applied this
factor to examine the attitudes and behaviours of employee and found this variable to be
positively related at a significant level (McGinnis and Morrows, 1990; Cherniss, 1991;
Blau’s, 1999; Goulet and Singh, 2002). This study also supports previous studies and
the researcher has extended the research by examining the job satisfaction predictor
variable to examine employees’ attitudes and behaviours for organisational change in
educational institutions of Pakistan.
Employee develops their beliefs, behaviours and attitudes on the basis of benefits and
prior expectations. According to Chang (1999), individuals bring sets of expectations to
195
their employment situation, and attitudes and behaviours are outcomes of a process in
which individuals compare their level of expectations with their reality. The job
involvement factor is defined as an employee’s attachment to a job (London, 1993), in
which employee can be identified by his or her job which shows the importance of the
job relative to the individual’s life. This factor is involved with the individual’s
psychological behaviour which can show individual’s attitudes and behaviours. Based
on a beta coefficient in structural equation modelling results, it is evident that job
involvement is a predictor of employee readiness for organisational change. The
influence of job involvement in developing attitudes and behaviours was found to be
positively and significantly related (β = .176, p < 0.01, tJOIN = 3.066). Hence hypothesis
H6: there is a significant positive relationship between job involvement and employee
readiness for organisational change was accepted. This finding supports results found in
previous research in which job involvement was connected to attitudes and behaviours
towards careers (Goulet and Singh, 2002; Blau, 1999; McGinnis and Morrow, 1990). In
this study, the researcher extended job involvement to examine employee attitudes and
behaviours for organisational change in the public sector universities. Findings of above
variables are confirmed from the latest policy announced by the Higher Education
Commission of Pakistan that numerous schemes such that scholarships for higher
education, funds for attending conferences abroad, funds for running research project(s)
and so many other incentives and facilities are going to be provided to faculty members
to encourage them to enhance their performance (HEC, 2005; no date b). Thus, this
predictor can be used as source of employee readiness for organisational change in
general, and in public higher educational institutions in Pakistan in particular.
Individuals enter into an organisation with their own plans and expectations for
satisfying their needs. Organisation can attract more employees by satisfying
psychological demands. Supervisor and peer relationships were found to be one of the
important psychological predictors in the commitment domain to manage employees
(Greenhaus et al., 1990; Kim, 1995). It is commonly regarded as one’s belief in the
importance of hard work and frugality (Morrow, 1993). This relationship was developed
by Morrow (1993) to understand employee intentions when he or she remapped the
relationships in the work environment. By applying five well known items used by
Gaertner and Nollen (1989); Chang (1999), the results of this study were confirmed
through a beta coefficient (β = -.025, p > 0.05, tSPRE = -.480) as non significant. The
196
examination of corresponding path estimates and t values for the links between
supervisor and peer relationships (SPRE) and readiness for organisational change
(ROCH) were not found to be positively and significantly related. Thus, hypothesis H7:
there is a significant positive relationship between supervisor and peer relationships and
employee readiness for organisational change was rejected.
In the literature, the supervisor and peer relations predictor was used as developing
attitudes and behaviour to share information and advice on career opportunities (Chang,
1999; Gaertner and Nollen, 1989; Mottaz, 1988). However, in this research findings
discovered that subordinates and supervisors did not share or advise individuals to
enhance their career in public sector higher educational institutions of Pakistan.
Generally, the results suggest that a thorough understanding of supervisor and peer
relations requires that attention be given to developing individual attitudes and
behaviours to readiness for organisational change in public sector higher educational
institutions of Pakistan.
Individuals with a strong degree of career commitment may show higher levels of
expectations and requirements from the organisation with which they may forge
relationships. It also implies that highly career committed individuals may be more
motivated when their expectations are satisfied than those who are less committed.
Training is known to be an important factor in developing individual skills (Gaertner
and Nollen, 1989). Four items were applied, in which three items were adapted from
Chang (1999) based on Mobley et al. (1978) and one item was developed by researcher
with five-point Likert scale (from strongly agree to strongly disagree) to examine the
employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change. Results were assessed by
their standard coefficients (β coefficient). The influence of training and skills
development as an independent predictor was not confirmed to be positively and
significantly related to readiness for organisational change (β = -.040, p > 0.05, tTSDE = -
.971). This statistical finding indicates that a training and skills development factor may
not influence employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change, particularly
in academic institutions of Pakistan. Among the individual factors of employee
commitment to the career scale elements, the training and skills development construct
had no impact on the employee readiness for organisational change construct. Hence
H8: there is a significant positive relationship between training and skills development
197
and employee readiness for organisational change was rejected.
In fact, training and skills of employee follow competence and development in an
organisation. This factor has been widely applied by numerous researchers and found
positive results (Chang, 1999; Gaertner and Nollen, 1989). In this study, results suggest
that attention must be given to training and skills development and vast training
programmes should be launched in public sector higher educational institutions of
Pakistan. This finding is confirmed from the higher education commission of Pakistan’s
document that suggests that poor standard of faculty is due to a lack of training (HEC,
2005). Thus, training and professional development programmes for faculty members
are essential, which have also been officially recommended (HEC, 2005).
In conclusions, the findings from the hypotheses testing suggest that employees of
higher educational institutions of Pakistan can develop their attitudes and behaviours as
a result of institutional and individual predictors. Higher educational institutions can
actively use internal promotion policy, job satisfaction and job involvement to influence
the individual’s mind for organisational change. Additionally, respondents made some
observations on two factors such that supervisor and peer relationship and training and
skills development, which were not discovered to be positively and significantly related
to readiness for organisational change.
8.6 Social Relationships in the Workplace: A Determinant of Readiness for
Organisational Change
The literature suggests that social relationships in the workplace can lead to developing
employee attitudes and behaviours for organisational change. In organisation, employee
interacts with their colleagues such that subordinate, peer or supervisor but these
feelings, attitudes and perceptions may be positive or negative. This study applied social
relationships in the workplace as a predictive variable for examining employee attitudes
and behaviours for organisational change. Standardised estimates and t values (Table
7.29) showed that the path between social relationships in the workplace predictor
variable and readiness for organisational change was found to be positive and
significant (β = .130, p < 0.01, tSORE = 2.647). From the respondent point of view,
positive social relationships in the workplace factor mean they are more likely to be
198
open or ready for organisational change. Thus, H9: there is a significant positive
relationship between social relationships in the workplace and readiness for
organisational change was accepted.
In the social sciences domain, social relationships in the workplace factor is used to
ascertain employee likes, dislikes and enjoyment related to talking, interacting and
working with their subordinate, supervisor and peer. In previous studies, researchers
directly or indirectly used it for examining employee attitudes and behaviours for
organisational change (Hanpachern et al., 1997; Eby et al., 2000; Weber and Weber,
2001; Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005). Generally, the results suggest that
a thorough understanding of social relationships in the workplace require that attention
be given to developing individual attitudes and behaviours to readiness for
organisational change in the public sector universities of Pakistan.
8.7 Conclusion
In conclusion, this chapter has provided discussion on the results of the scale and
population, measurement scales purification and hypotheses testing. All hypotheses
developed in the framework were discussed with previous literature and found
inferences for the future. The flow of factors used in this study might be enriched by
considering individual attitudes and behaviours towards organisational change. Two out
of nine independent predictor variables were not positively and significantly related to
readiness for organisational change. Supervisor and peer relations and training and
skills development was not suggested to develop individual attitudes and behaviours in
higher educational institutions of Pakistan. Moreover, pay/wages/rewards and job
satisfaction predictor variables were found more related to readiness for organisational
change.
In the next chapter, policy implications will be presented. Research limitations will also
be noted and other potential research directions will be discussed in more detail.
199
Chapter Nine Conclusions
9.1 Introduction
Research on the determinants of employee readiness for organisational change was
stimulated by new interest evinces due to recent change reforms in the public sector
higher educational institutions of Pakistan. Increased attention on competition,
advanced technology, mergers, expansion, product quality maintenance, enhancing
employee efficiency rapid growth, new business ventures, exciting opportunities,
innovations, and new leadership and management approaches led to number of
countries knowing employee attitudes and behaviours of organisation change.
The scope of this study was to examine employee readiness predictors for
organisational change. Based on different review of extant literature and different
theoretical perspectives, an integrative theoretical framework was developed which is
composed of employee commitment to the organisation, career and social relationships
in the workplace factors. Alongside the theoretical framework, a set of hypotheses have
been developed.
The study applied a positivist approach methodology in which a survey questionnaire
was used to obtain quantitative data to test hypotheses. The data for this study was
obtained from public sector higher educational institutions of Pakistan. The sample
consists of one thousand faculty members from thirty three public sector universities
from all over the country. Structural equation modelling techniques including analysis
of moment structure (AMOS) software applied to test the hypothesised relationships. In
this chapter, first the theoretical contribution of the thesis in terms of gaps in the field is
discussed. Second, the practical or managerial implications of the study’s findings are
described. This is followed by a discussion of the methodological and theoretical
limitations of the research. Finally, some future research avenues are suggested.
200
9.2 Research Implications
9.2.1 Theoretical Implications
After reviewing extant literature in the domain of change management, a conceptual
framework was developed on the basis of employee attitudes, beliefs, and behaviours.
This study was conducted in Pakistan where it was proposed that employees of
organisations can develop their attitudes and behaviours on the basis of psychological
and financial needs. In the framework, the direct influence of employee commitment to
the organisation and career and social relationships in the workplace factors on
employee readiness for organisational change was investigated. This understanding was
conceptualised on the basis of prior studies (Penley and Gould, 1988; Gaertner and
Nollen, 1989; Chang, 1999; Goulet and Singh, 2002; Madsen et al., 2005). With the
employee commitment to the organisation and career this study examined the
relationships between emotional attachment, feeling of pride, pay/wages/rewards,
promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, training and
skills development and social relationships in the workplace and employee readiness for
organisational change.
Statistical results showed that all hypotheses except two were accepted. Overall,
employee commitment to the organisation factors were found to be significantly and
positively correlated to readiness for organisational change. The relative power of
employee career factors was found to be positive and significant to readiness for
change. However, two factors such that supervisor and peer relations and training and
skills development were not found to be significant and positive to readiness for change.
Furthermore, employee social relationships in the workplace were also found to be
positively and significantly correlated to readiness for organisational change. This
finding also supports the development of employee attitudes and beliefs, particularly in
Pakistan.
The novelty of this research is based on the development of comprehensive theoretical
framework that examines the factors that influence the employee attitudes and
behaviours in public sector higher educational institutions of Pakistan. Previous studies
that have been conducted in the area of change management did not focus on the
201
employee psychological and financial factors to examine the employee response for
organisational change. Thus it can be claimed that this is the first time that this
theoretical framework tested empirically and theoretically. Several theoretical
contributions emerge from this research.
First, to the knowledge of researcher this research is the first empirical work that
synthesised concepts from two main theories such that Maslow’s need theory and
Armenakis’s five key message readiness component theory to assess individual attitudes
and behaviours in a more holistic manner, and in a Pakistan context. In the present
study, an integrative model was developed that combines factors associated with the
employee commitment and social relationships factors. However, a comprehensive
approach, which takes development of the cognition of employee through needs and
expectations into consideration, has not been tested. Although a few studies about
employee readiness for organisational change have been conducted (Eby et al., 2000;
Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simons, 2006; Cinite, et al.,
2009), they tend to focus on only specific factors such that psychological, workplace,
environmental, cultural and social factors but ignored employee commitment factors.
This study suggests an integrative model that combines employee commitment to the
organisation and career factors along with social relationships in the workplace factor in
response of employee psychological and financial needs.
Second, another contribution to knowledge is that, it is the first study of its kind
collecting valuable data from Pakistan. In addition, the study contributed to the limited
knowledge on how employees of Pakistan organisations become open and ready for
organisational change. In this regard, the researcher has addressed the questions which
are those factors that influence the employee attitudes and behaviours to support
organisational change. The researcher has combined a set of key factors such that
emotional attachment, feeling of pride, pay/wages/rewards, promotion, job satisfaction,
job involvement, supervisor and peer relations, training and skills development and
social relationships in the workplace and employee readiness.
Third, this research was conducted in educational sector which is another contribution
to knowledge that, it is the first study to report that has valuable data from public sector
higher educational institution. In addition, the study contributed to knowledge on how
202
employee of public sector universities of Pakistan develops their attitudes and
behaviours for organisational change. Although studies have been found in sales, health,
engineering, local governments, profit and non profit oriented organisations (Eby et al.,
2000; Cunningham et al., 2002; Burnes, 2003; Peach et al., 2005; Madsen et al., 2005),
the setting of this study was educational institutions, which is significant for a wider
validity of findings.
Finally, a key combination relates to the fact that it brings empirical evidence from a
relatively new cultural context, taking into account that most of the prior studies have
taken place in the Australia, Canada, UK and USA. This is the first study reported on
employee readiness for organisational change in public sector higher educational
institutions of Pakistan. This is significant in permitting a test of a wider validity of
findings derived from research conducted in South Asia context.
9.2.2 Practical Implications
The examination of factors that influence employee to readiness for organisational
change is an important endeavour. Eventually, change affects individual attitudes and
behaviours because of moving form a known to unknown situation. The findings of this
study have several practical implications however, few important implication for
managers and academics are followed.
First, this study highlighted the importance of employee psychological factors for
employee openness and readiness for organisational change. The results showed that
employees of public sector higher educational institutions of Pakistan develop their
positive attitudes and behaviours on the basis of psychological factor such that
emotional attachment, feeling of pride, job satisfaction and job involvement. When they
perceive that organisation fulfil employee psychological needs, they are more likely to
act positively and significantly. Results assessed the relative influence of emotional
attachment, feeling of pride, job satisfaction and job involvement to readiness for
organisational change. Findings indicated a positive influence to the dependent variable
such that readiness for organisational change. Moreover, these findings confirm and
expand existing knowledge for organisations in Pakistan. That means, when employees
have a psychological commitment to the organisation and career, they are more likely to
203
demonstrate readiness for organisational change. This conceptualisation suggests that
committed employees have a strong belief in and acceptance of the organisation’s goals
and values, show a willingness to exert considerable efforts on behalf of the
organisation and have a strong desire to maintain membership of the organisation.
Second, this study found that employees who have high financial attachment to their
organisation and career are more willing to accept new situations. This suggests that,
other things being equal, the more financial commitment to the organisation and career
that is perceived, so more openness and readiness for organisational change will be
noted. Currently, the economic, financial, developmental, competitive, and
environmental situation is fragile, particularly in Pakistan. Results assessed that on the
basis of intrinsic rewards such that pay/wages/rewards and promotion, employee can be
more open and ready for organisational change. It is considered positive that employees
in higher educational institutions of Pakistan are satisfied by intrinsic job rewards. This
suggests that employee who receives financial rewards and encouragement for
promotion are more likely to act voluntarily in support of organisational change goals
and can contribute to overall organisational effectiveness.
Third, Social relationships in the workplace can lead to developing employee attitudes
and behaviours for organisational change. From the respondent point of view, positive
social relationships in the workplace factor lead to openness or readiness for
organisational change. In public sector universities of Pakistan, this factor was found to
be proactive and pursue employee likes, dislikes and enjoyment related to talking,
interacting and working with their subordinates, supervisors and peers. Generally, the
results suggest that social relationships in the workplace may support to be more open
and ready for organisational change in public sector higher educational institutions of
Pakistan.
Fourth, the results of this study suggest that employee relationship with supervisor and
peer is critical. This finding discovered that subordinate and supervisor do not share or
advise individuals about career enhancement. Generally, the results advocate that a
thorough understanding of supervisor and peer relations requires that attention be given
to developing individual attitudes and behaviours to readiness for organisational change.
Indeed, employee needs valuable suggestions for developing their future career from
204
their colleagues. Results found that, in higher educational institutions of Pakistan,
supervisor and peer did not share information with others for enhancing career
development or promotion. Thus, this study suggests that supervisor and peer who have
prior experience, knowledge, or information should share it with others so as to enhance
confidence and the belief among employees towards the organisation in any unknown
situation. They should be honest in their dealings with peers and those under their
supervision.
Finally, regarding training and skills development, there is less evidence that employees
are open and ready for organisational change. It may be that in public sector higher
educational institutions of Pakistan, few if any training and skills development
programmes are in operation which is why the majority of employees did not develop
consent on the factor. In fact, training and skills of employee follows competence and
development in an organisation. The results of this study suggest that attention must be
given to training and skills development programmes in public sector higher educational
institutions to build up employee confidence when faced with any unidentified situation.
The major inference of the present research is that employees from public sector higher
education institution of Pakistan may develop positive attitudes and behaviours on the
basis of psychological and financial factors. This issue was raised some time ago (Alvi
and Ahmed, 1987; Chang, 1999), but since then there seems to be a lack of empirical
evidence supporting it.
9.2.3 Methodological Implications
The contribution of this study in terms of methodology is that this research is one of the
few studies that test employee readiness predictor variables outside the western cultural
set up, particularly in Pakistan. Readiness researchers such that Eby et al. (2000);
Cunningham et al. (2002); Madsen et al. (2005); Rafferty and Simons (2006); Cinite, et
al. (2009) highlighted employee readiness predictor variables in developed or western
cultural work settings. This research has filled gaps in global investigations by testing
predictor variables in cross-cultural work settings which may be useful for generalising
205
these predictors. Examining the predictor variables in Pakistan, could provide additional
insights into extant literature because Pakistani people and their cultural backgrounds
are substantially different from those of western countries (Fatima, 2002; Alvi and
Ahmed, 1987). The findings of the study suggest that employee attitudes and
behaviours are important and can develop in a similar way not only to western but also
to non-western cultures. Employees in Pakistan shows their similar beliefs about the
overall concept to those reported in the literature but placed more weight on future
needs and expectations. In addition, the conceptual framework explains the individual
determinants and consequences of employee readiness for organisational change,
indicating that the individual concept may be effectively used in management research
in other countries as well.
Additionally, this study verifies existing measurement scales in a country which is
culturally different from other work settings. For example employee relationship with
management, job knowledge and skills and job demands were tested in four profit-
oriented companies from north Utah (Miller et al., 2006). Rafferty and Simons (2006)
examined antecedents of employee readiness for fine-tuning and corporate
transformation change in an Australian organisation.
According to the findings, all scales generally appear valid in their general content but
the number of items in purified scales is not the same as those of original scales. For
instance, after testing the readiness scale that consisted of fourteen items was purified
with only seven items and found high reliability and constructs validity. Similarly in
employee commitment for the organisation and career scale one variable from each such
that personal sense of obligation and career commitment were completely not loaded.
However, a few scales such that emotional attachment, feeling of pride and promotion
were purified on their basic items whereas a few items were deleted from
pay/wages/rewards, job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer relations and
training and skills development scales and loaded with extracted items and found high
reliability and construct validity. Future cross-national research could benefit from
further investigation about the essential conditions in which comparability of scales
across countries is affected.
206
9.3 Research Limitations
9.3.1 Theoretical Limitations
Despite the promising results, some limitations of the study should be noted that could
be addressed in future research. Examining employees’ attitudes and behaviours only in
higher educational institutions may limit generalisability. It is possible that people who
seek employment in non educational organisations react differently. Thus, these
predictor variables of the theoretical framework should be tested in other organisations
in the same culture which may present confounding effect in those institutions. Thus,
more tests are necessary to strengthen its generalisability.
The second limitation of this research is that the present research did not consider the
phases of organisational change. In future research, researcher could examine the
differences in employee attitudes and behaviours depending on how long the change
process had taken.
The third limitation is the use of single source data. However, Crampton and Wagner
(1994) suggest the seriousness of this issue depends on the research question and nature
of variables under consideration. According to Eby et al. (2000) perceived readiness for
change is perceptual of individuals and assessing individual perception self reported
data can be used. In fact, previous research on employees’ readiness has relied almost
exclusively on self reported data to infer employees’ attitudes and behaviours for
readiness to organisational change (Eby et al., 2000; Cunningham et al., 2002; Madsen
et al., 2005; Rafferty and Simons, 2006).
The fourth limitation is that, since this study is one of the few studies which
simultaneously examine employees’ attitudes, beliefs and behaviours by employees’
commitment to the organisation and career along with social relationships in the
workplace factors, a large sample with diverse professions would strengthen and
support the research findings. With increasing mergers, downsizing, and layoffs,
individuals are now unable to depend on a single organisation for their entire careers,
and commitment to one’s own career, accordingly, becomes an important source of
occupational meaning (Chang, 1999, p-1275). Thus, factors related to individual careers
207
and future development is implicated as of importance in organisational change.
Therefore, more studies are required to better understand employees’ attitudes, beliefs
and behaviour for organisational change.
9.3.2 Methodological Limitations
The research design used in this study is not without certain methodological limitations.
It did not allow examining employees attitudes and behaviours for change readiness
over time that needs to be considered when interpreting the results. Several limitations
of the study should be noted. First, the fact that the data is reliant on using a single, self-
reported questionnaire at a single point in time is problematic. When self-reports are
used, concerns regarding common method bias being responsible for the observed
relationships often arise (Cole et al., 2006). A self-reported single data at a single point
in time may be highly affected. Such data may reflect the influence of employees’
commitment to the organisation and career and social relationships in the workplace,
thereby resulting in spuriously high relationships.
A second limitation is the cross-sectional design of the study. Because data was
collected at a single point in time, one is unable to establish cause-and-effect
relationships among the variables of interest. Future research that looks to develop a
longitudinal design in order to collect predictor and criterion variables before and after
the change would be much stronger. In the management domain, chaos and complexity
theory are widely applied which suggest that all systems are in a constant state of
change and are easily frightened into disequilibrium for any number of reasons. This
suggests that longitudinal studies may be particularly useful to understand employees’
attitudes and behaviours to readiness for organisational change. In organisational
change, individual’s perceptions may be equally dynamic if the system is constantly
redefining itself (Waldrop, 1992).
Third, the research analyses were based on public sector higher educational institutions
of Pakistan, therefore limiting the generalisability of the research findings (Cole et al.,
2006). Furthermore, this research was conducted in Pakistan, thus there is also a
limitation of the research findings for generalisation particularly for organisations in
developed or western countries.
208
The fourth limitation of this study is the contextual effect in the responses because this
study was undertaken on a voluntary participation basis and respondents were given a
choice of completing the questionnaire anywhere such that at work or outside work. In
this questionnaire, it was not required to state where the questionnaire had been
completed. Thus, it is possible that respondents could have been affected by the
environment or other factors when they completed the survey.
The fifth limitation may be that this study was based on the use of the questionnaire
method, which implies that common method bias might have occurred as in other
research using the same method (Blau, 1985). Data obtaining from a single source may
be problematic for causal prediction based on the survey since the measures are taken
on one occasion only. Thus multiple methods may be helpful to further clarify the plan
of this research. This limitation proposes that in-depth interviews with employees along
with quantitative date would be more useful.
Finally, there might be reliability and validity issues with the information obtained from
the questionnaires used in this study because they were self-reported by the respondents.
According to (Park and Kim, 2009, p-34) self-survey data may produce high
correlations among measures, in part, because the data shared common method variance
and thus errors in measurement are correlated with each other.
9.4 Future Research Avenue
The study findings contribute to the literature on human resource management (HRM),
organisational behaviour (OB), organisational development (OD) and change
management (CM). By providing an in-depth account of individual attitudes and
behaviours this study examined employees’ commitment to the organisation and career
and social relationships in the workplace predictors which are helpful the organisation
to get support and openness for successful and meaningful organisational change.
There are so many avenues for future research. This study examined direct relationships
between independent variables such that emotional attachment, feeling of pride,
pay/wages/rewards, promotion, job satisfaction, job involvement, supervisor and peer
209
relations, training and skills development and social relationships in the workplace to
the dependent variable such that employee readiness for organisational change. One of
the key issues for future researchers to address concerns the examination of more
sophisticated relationships between antecedent measures and readiness. In this regard,
future research could also further develop a theoretical model concerning change
readiness for different types of predictors’ relationships. This study investigated direct
relationships between change readiness and a variety of antecedent factors. However, it
is reasonable to suggest that a variety of more complicated relationships may exist.
Future research could also further develop a theoretical model concerning change
readiness for different types of change. In addition, while authors generally propose that
change attitudes, such as readiness, mediate the relationship between change
implementation and outcomes, this has not been the subject of extensive research.
Given the theoretical importance that attitudes such as change readiness play in
theoretical accounts of the change process, it is essential that more theoretical and
empirical work is conducted on this construct. In addition, the conceptual framework
developed for the study should be investigated in organisations other than higher
educational institutions which may support its generalisability. It is possible that people
who seek employment in non-educational organisations react differently. Thus, these
predictor variables should be tested in other organisations in same culture may present
confounding effects. Thus, more tests are necessary to strengthen its generalisability.
Future research beckons, since many questions are still unanswered. Longitudinal
studies may help determine if the relationships studied here differ depending upon the
stage of the organisational change process under evaluation since employee’s
perceptions concerning change intervention may themselves change over time
(Rousseau and Tijoriwala, 1999). In future research, researcher(s) could examine the
differences in employee attitudes and behaviours depending on how long the change
process had taken.
For future research, this study also suggests using in-depth interviews alongside survey
questionnaires which may infer more about individuals’ attitudes and behaviours for
readiness to organisational change.
210
This study suggests applying different individual and organisational factors along
employees’ commitment to the organisation and career aspects which may provide in-
depth findings for the future. And finally, a large sample including diverse professions
may provide more strength and support future findings. Therefore, more studies are
required to better understand employees’ attitudes, beliefs and behaviour for
organisational change.
211
References
Abrahamson, E. 2000, "Change without Pain", Harvard business review, vol. 78, no. 4,
pp. 75-79.
Agho, A.O., Price, J.L. & Mueller, C.W. 1992, "Discriminant Validity of Measures of
Job Satisfaction, Positive Affectivity and Negative Affectivity", Journal of
Occupational and Organizational Psychology, vol. 65, pp. 185.
Aiken, L.S. & West, S.G. 1991, Multiple Regressions: Testing and Interpreting
Interactions, Sage, London.
Alas, R. 2009, "The Impact of Work-Related Values on the Readiness to Change in
Estonian Organizations", Journal of Business Ethics, vol. 86, no. 2, pp. 113-124.
Alderfer, C. P. 1969, “An empirical test of a new theory of human needs”,
Organisational Behaviours and Human Performance, vol. 4, pp. 143-175.
Allen, N.J. & Meyer, J.P. 1990, "The measurement and antecedents of affective,
continuance and normative commitment to the organization", Journal of
Occupational Psychology, vol. 63, no. 1, pp. 1-18.
Alvi, S.A. & Ahmed, S.W. 1987, "Assessing Organizational Commitment in a
Developing Country: Pakistan, A Case Study", Human Relations, vol. 40, no. 5, pp.
267-280.
Amaratunga, D., Baldry, D., Sarchar, M. & Newton, R. 2002, "Quantitative and
qualitative research in the built environment: application of mixed research
approach", Work Study, vol. 51, no. 1, pp. 17-31.
Anderson, J. & Gerbing, D. 1988, "Structural Equation Modelling in Practice: A review
and Recommended Two-step Approach", Psychological bulletin, vol. 103, no. 3, pp.
411-423.
Anderson, J. & Gerbing, D. 1982, "Some Methods for Specifying Measurement Models
to Obtain Uni-dimensional Construct Measurement", Journal of Marketing
Research, vol. 19, no. 4, pp. 453-460.
212
Anonymous, 2003, "Emotional connections to work", The Work life Report, vol. 14, no.
4, pp. 6.
Anonymous, 2010, “Higher Education in Pakistan: Towards a Reform Agenda,
available from www.tfhe.net/resources/pakistan.htm, retrieved on 23-09-2009
Armenakis, A.A. & Bedeian, A.G. 1999, "Organizational Change: A Review of Theory
and Research in the 1990s", Journal of Management, vol. 25, no. 3, pp. 293-315.
Armenakis, A.A. & Fredenberger, W.B. 1997, "Organizational Change Readiness
Practices of Business Turnaround Change Agents", Knowledge and Process
Management, vol. 4, no. 3, pp. 143-152.
Armenakis, A.A. & Harris, S.G. 2002, "Crafting a change message to create
transformational readiness", Journal of Organizational Change Management, vol.
15, no. 2, pp. 169.
Armenakis, A. A., Harris, S. G., & Feild, H. S. 1999, “ Making change permanent: A
model for institutionalizing change interventions” . Research in Organizational
Change and Development, vol. 12, pp. 97-128
Armenakis, A.A., Harris, S.G. & Mossholder, K.W. 1993, "Creating readiness for
organizational change", Human Relations, vol. 46, no. 6, pp. 681.
Arnold, J., Cooper, C., & Robertson, I. 1995. Work Psychology: Understanding Human
Behaviour in the Workplace, Pitaman Publishing, London.
Aryee, S. & Tan, K. 1992, "Antecedents and outcomes of career commitment", Journal
of Vocational Behavior, vol. 40, no. 3, pp. 288-305.
Ashford, S.J. 1988, "Individual Strategies for Coping with Stress during Organizational
Transitions", Journal of Applied Behavioural Science, vol. 24, no. 1, pp. 19-36.
Au, N., Ngai, E. W. T., Cheng, T.C.E. 2002, “A critical review of end user information
system satisfaction research and a new research framework”, Omega, vol. 30, pp.
451-478.
213
Babin, B., Boles, J. & Robin, D. 2000, "Representing the Perceived Ethical Work
Climate among Marketing Employees", Journal of Academy of Marketing Sciences,
vol. 31, no. 5/6, pp. 366-382.
Bagozzi, R. & Philips, L. 1982, "Representing and Testing Organizational Theories: A
Holistic Construal", Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 27, pp. 459-489.
Bagozzi, R., Yi, Y., & Philips, L. 1991, "Assessing Construct Validity in Organizational
Research", Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 36, no. 3, pp. 421-458.
Baker, M. 2002, "Sampling", The Market Review, vol. 3, no. 1, pp. 103-120.
Baltes, B. B., Zhdanova, L. S., & Parker, C. C. 2009, "Psychological climate: A
comparison of organizational and individual level referents", Human Relations, vol.
62, no. 5, pp. 669-700.
Bareil, C., Savoie, A. & Meunier, S. 2007, "Patterns of Discomfort with Organizational
Change", Journal of Change Management, vol. 7, no. 1, pp. 13-24.
Barnet, R. 1990, The idea of higher education. Philadelphia, USA: The Society for
Research into Higher Education.
Barnett, W.P. & Carroll, G.R. 1995, "Modelling Internal Organizational Change",
Annual Review of Sociology, vol. 21, no. 1, pp. 217.
Bartol, K.M. 1979, "Professionalism as a Predictor of Organizational Commitment,
Role Stress, and Turnover: a Multidimensional Approach", Academy of
Management Journal, vol. 22, no. 4, pp. 815-821.
Baruch, Y. & Holtom, B. C. 2008, "Survey response rate levels and trends in
organizational research", Human Relations, vol. 61, no. 8, pp. 1139-1160.
Bechtel, R.L. & Squires, J.K. 2001, "Tools and techniques to facilitate change",
Industrial & Commercial Training, vol. 33, no. 7, pp. 249-254.
Beer, M. & Walton, E. 1990, "Developing the competitive organization: Interventions
and strategies", American Psychologist, vol. 45, no. 2, pp. 154-161.
214
Belson, W.A. 1986, Validity in survey research: with special reference to the
techniques of intensive interviewing and progressive modification for testing and
constructing difficult or sensitive measures for use in survey research: a report,
Aldershop, Gover.
Bennett J. L. 2001, "Change Hygiene", HR Magzine, vol. 46, no. 8, pp. 149.
Bentler, P. M., & Bonnett, D. G. 1980, "Significance tests and goodness of fit in the
analysis of covariance structures", Psychological bulletin, vol. 88, pp. 588-606.
Bentler, P. & Chou, C. 1987, "Practical Issues in Structural Modeling", Sociological
Methods and Research, vol. 16, no. 1, pp. 78-117.
Bernerth, J. 2004, "Expanding Our Understanding of the Change Message", Human
Resource Development Review, vol. 3, no. 1, pp. 36-52.
Blau, G.J 1999, "Early-Career Job Factors Influencing the Professional Commitment of
Medical Technologists", Academy of Management Journal, vol. 42, no. 6, pp. 687-
695.
Blau, G.J. 1985, "The measurement and prediction of career commitment", Journal of
Occupational Psychology, vol. 58, no. 4, pp. 277-288.
Blau, G.J. & Boal, K.B. 1987, "Conceptualizing How Job Involvement and
Organizational Commitment Affect Turnover and Absenteeism", Academy of
Management Review, vol. 12, no. 2, pp. 288-300.
Bovey, W.H. & Hede, A. 2001, "Resistance to organisational change: The role of
defence mechanisms", Journal of Managerial Psychology, vol. 16, no. 7/8, pp. 534.
Brayfield, A.H. & Rothe, H.F. 1951, "An index of job satisfaction", Journal of Applied
Psychology, vol. 35, no. 5, pp. 307-311.
Bridges, W. 1986, "Managing Organizational Transitions", Organizational dynamics,
vol. 15, no. 1, pp. 24-33.
215
Buchanan, B. 1974, "Building Organizational Commitment - the Socialization of
Managers in Work Organizations", Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 19, no. 4,
pp. 533.
Buller, P.F. 1988, "For Successful Strategic Change: Blend OD Practices With Strategic
Management", Organizational dynamics, vol. 16, no. 3, pp. 42-55.
Burnes, B. 2003, "Managing change and changing managers from ABC to XYZ", The
Journal of Management Development, vol. 22, no. 7/8, pp. 627.
Burrell, G. & Morgan, G. 1979, Sociological Paradigm and Organizational Analysis:
Elements of the Sociology of Corporate Life, Heinemann, London.
Carmines, E. & Zeller, R. 1979, Reliability and Validity Assessment, Sage Publications,
London.
Caroli, E. & Reenen, J.V. 2001, "Skill-Biased Organizational Change? Evidence from a
Panel of British and French Establishments", The Quarterly Journal of Economics,
vol. 116, no. 4, pp. 1449-1492.
Carson, K.D. & Bedeian, A.G. 1994, "Career Commitment: Construction of a Measure
and Examination of Its Psychometric Properties", Journal of Vocational Behavior,
vol. 44, no. 3, pp. 237-262.
Carson, K.D., Carson, P.P., Roe, C.W., Birkenmeier, B.J. & Phillips, J.S. 1999, "Four
Commitment Profiles and their Relationships to Empowerment, Service Recovery,
and Work Attitudes", Public Personnel Management, vol. 28, no. 1, pp. 1.
Cavana, R., Delahye, B.L. & Sekaran, U. 2001, Applied Business Research: Qualitative
and Quantitative methods, Wiley, Milton, Australia.
Chang, C. S. & Chang, H. H. 2007, "Effects of internal marketing on nurse job
satisfaction and organizational commitment: example of medical centres in
Southern Taiwan", Journal of Nursing Research, vol. 15, no. 4, pp. 265-274.
216
Chang, E. 1999, "Career Commitment as a Complex Moderator of Organizational
Commitment and Turnover Intention", Human Relations, vol. 52, no. 10, pp. 1257-
1278.
Chau, P. 1997, "Re-examining a Model for Evaluating Information Centre Success
Using Structural Equation Modelling Approach", Decision Science, vol. 28, no. 2,
pp. 309-334.
Chawla, A. & Kelloway, E.K. 2004, "Predicting openness and commitment to change",
Leadership & Organization Development Journal, vol. 25, no. 5/6, pp. 485.
Chen, I. C. L. 2005, The Societal Culture dimension within the Human Relation
Practice of Taiwanese management in the UK, Unpublished Thesis, Department of
Management and Organization, University of Sterling, UK. (Online Accessed on
14-03-2008)
Cherniss, C. 1991, "Career commitment in human service professional: A biographical
study", Human Relations, vol. 44, no. 5, pp. 419-437.
Childs, A. & Klimoski, R.J. 1986, "Successfully predicting career success: An
application of the biographical inventory", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 71,
no. 1, pp. 3-8.
Chonko, L.B. 2004, "Organizational readiness for change, individual fear of change,
and sales manager performance: an empirical investigation", Journal of Personal
Selling and Sales Management, vol. 24, no. 1, pp. 7-17.
Chreim, S. 2006, "Postscript to change: survivors' retrospective views of organizational
changes", Personnel Review, vol. 35, no. 3, pp. 315.
Chreim, S. 2002, "Influencing organizational identification during major change: A
communication-based perspective", Human Relations, vol. 55, no. 9, pp. 1117-
1137.
Christians, C 2000, Ethics and Politics in Qualitative Research. In Denzin, NK &
Lincoln,YS (eds.) Handbook of Qualitative Research. Sage. London. pp. 133-155.
217
Churchill, J.G.A. 1979, "A paradigm for developing better measures of marketing
construct", Journal of Marketing, vol. 16, pp. 64-73.
Cinite, I., Duxbury, L. E. & Higgins, C. 2009, "Measurement of Perceived
Organizational Readiness for Change in the Public Sector", British Journal of
Management, vol. 20, pp. 265-277.
Clark, G. (2005), Reform in Higher Education in Pakistan, In Hathaway, R. M. (Eds.)
Education Reform in Pakistan: Building for the Future’. (55-68). Woodrow Wilson
International Centre for Scholars, Washington D.C.
Clark, L.A. & Watson, D. 1995, "Constructing Validity: Basic Issues in Objective Scale
Development", Psychological Assessment, vol. 7, no. 3, pp. 309-319.
Coch, L. & French, Jr. J.R.P. 1948, "Overcoming Resistance to Change", Human
Relations, vol. 1, no. 4, pp. 512-532.
Cohen, A. 1999, "Relationships among five forms of commitment: An empirical
assessment", Journal of Organizational Behavior, vol. 20, no. 3, pp. 285.
Cohen, A. 1996, "On The Discriminant Validity of the Meyer and Allen Measure of
Organizational Commitment: How Does it Fit with the Work Commitment
Construct?", Educational and Psychological Measurement, vol. 56, no. 3, pp. 494-
503.
Cohen, L., Manion, L. & Morrison, K. 2000, Research Methods in Education, 5th edn,
Routeledge Falmer, London.
Colarelli, S.M. & Bishop, R.C. 1990, "Career Commitment Functions, Correlates, and
Management, Group & Organization Studies, vol. 15, no. 2, pp. 158-176.
Cole, M.S., Harris, S.G. & Bernerth, J.B. 2006, "Exploring the implications of vision,
appropriateness, and execution of organizational change", Leadership &
Organization Development Journal, vol. 27, no. 5, pp. 352.
218
Coleman, D. F., Irving, G. P., & Cooper, C. L. 1999, "Another look at the locus of
control-organizational commitment relationship: It depends on the form of
commitment", Journal of Organizational Behavior, vol. 20, pp. 995-1001.
Collis, J. & Hussey, R. 2003, Business Research: A Practical Guide for Undergraduate
and Postgraduate Student, 2nd edn, PALGRAVE MACMILLAN, New York.
Comery, A. L & Lee, H. B. 1992, A first course in factor analysis, 2nd edn, L. Erlbaum
Associates, Hillsdale, NJ.
Cook, J. & Wall, T. 1980, "New work attitude measures of trust, organizational
commitment and personal need non-fulfilment", Journal of Occupational
Psychology, vol. 53, no. 1, pp. 39-52.
Cortina, J. 1993, "Interaction, Nonlinearity, and Multicollinearity: Implications for
Multiple Regression", Journal of Management, vol. 19, no. 4, pp. 915-922.
Craige, C. & Dougla, C. 2000, International Marketing Research, 2nd edn, John Wiley
& Sons, Chichester.
Crampton, S.M. & Wagner, J.A. 1994, "Percept-Percept Inflation in Micro-
organizational Research: An Investigation of Prevalence and Effect", Journal of
Applied Psychology, vol. 79, no. 1, pp. 54-66.
Cresswell, J.W. 2003, Research Design: Qualitative, Quantitative and Mixed Methods
Approaches, 2nd edn, SAGE, London.
Cronbach, L. J. 1951, "Coefficient alpha and the internal structure of tests",
Psychometrika, vol. 16, pp. 297-334.
Cummings, T. G., & Worley, C. G. 2005, Organisation development and Change, 8th
edn, Cincinnati, OH: South-Western College Publishing.
Cummings, T.G. & Worley, C.G. 2001, Organization development and change, South-
Western College Publishing, Cincinnati, OH.
219
Cunningham, C.E., Woodward, C.A., Shannon, H.S. & MacIntosh, J. 2002, "Readiness
for organizational change: A longitudinal study of workplace, psychological and
behavioural correlates", Journal of Occupational and Organizational Psychology,
vol. 75, pp. 377.
Davis, R. 1979, "Interactive transfer of expertise: Acquisition of new interference
rules", Artificial Intelligence, vol. 12, pp. 121-157.
De Vaus, D.A. 2002, Surveys in social research, 4th edn, Routledge, London.
De Vellis, R. 2003, Scale Development, Sage Publication, London.
Denscombe, M. 2003, The Good Research Guide: For Small-scale Social Research,
2nd edn, Open University Press, Buckingham.
Denscombe, M. 2002, Ground Rules for Good Research, Open University Press,
Bukingham.
Dent, E.B. & Goldberg, S.G. 1999, "Challenging "Resistance to Change"", Journal of
Applied Behavioral Science, vol. 35, no. 1, pp. 25-41.
Desplaces, D. 2005, "A Multilevel Approach to Individual Readiness to Change",
Journal of Behavioral and Applied Management, vol. 7, no. 1, pp. 25.
Diamantopoulos, A. & Siguaw, J. 2000, Introducing LISERL, Sage Publication,
London.
Dirks K., Cummings L. & Piece J. 1996, "Psychological ownership in organizations:
Conditions under which individual promote and resist change", Research in
Organizational Change and Development, vol. 9, pp. 1-23.
Doll, W., Xia, W., & Torkzadeh, G. 1994, "A confirmatory Factor Analysis of the End-
User Computing Satisfaction Instrument", MIS Quarterly, vol. 18, no. 4, pp. 453-
461.
220
Dreher, G.F. & Bretz, R.D. 1991, "Cognitive ability and career attainment: Moderating
effects of early career success", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 76, no. 3, pp.
392-397.
Dunham, R.B., Grube, J.A. & Castañeda, M.B. 1994, "Organizational commitment: The
utility of an integrative definition", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 79, no. 3,
pp. 370-380.
Durande-Moreau, A. & Usunier, J. 1999, "Time Styles and the Waiting Experience: An
Exploratory Study", Journal of Service Research, vol. 2, no. 2, pp. 173-186.
Easterby-Smith, M., Thorpe, R. & Lowe, A. 1991, Management Research: An
Introduction, 2nd edn, Sage, London.
Eby, L.T., Adams, D.M., Russell, J.E.A. & Gaby, S.H. 2000, "Perceptions of
organizational readiness for change: Factors related to employees' reactions to the
implementation of team-based selling", Human Relations, vol. 53, no. 3, pp. 419-
442.
Elias, S.M. 2009, "Employee Commitment in Times of Change: Assessing the
Importance of Attitudes toward Organizational Change", Journal of Management,
vol. 35, no. 1, pp. 37-55.
Erturk, A. (2008). ‘A trust based approach to promote employees’ openness to
organisational change in Turkey’, International Journal of Manpower, 29, pp. 462-
483.
Etzioni, A. 1961, A comparative analysis of complex organizations, Free Press,
Glencoe, NY.
Ezzamel, M., Lilley, S. & Willmott, H. 1996, "The View from the Top: Senior
Executives' Perceptions of Change Management Practices in UK Companies",
British Journal of Management, vol. 7, no. 2.
Fatima, M. 2002, "Management of Quantum Change in Pakistan Organizations", The
Journal, vol. 7, no. 3, pp. 1-17.
221
Field, A. 2006, Discovering Statistics Using SPSS, Second Edition edn, SAGE
Publications, London.
Field, A. & Hole, G. 2003, How to Design and Report Experiments, SAGE, London.
Flick, U. 2002, An introduction to qualitative research. 2nd ed., London, Sage.
Floyd, F.J. & Widaman, K.F. 1995, "Factor analysis in the development and refinement
of clinical assessment instruments", Psychological Assessment, vol. 7, pp. 286-299.
Fornell, C. & Larcker, D.F. 1981, "Evaluating Structural Equation Models with
Unobservable Variables and Measurement Error", Journal of Marketing Research
(JMR), vol. 18, no. 1, pp. 39-50.
Gaertner, K.N. & Nollen, S.D. 1989, "Career Experiences, Perceptions of Employment
Practices, and Psychological Commitment to the Organization", Human Relations,
vol. 42, no. 11, pp. 975-991.
Galais, N. & Moser, K. 2009, "Organizational commitment and the well-being of
temporary agency workers: A longitudinal study", Human Relations, vol. 62, no. 4,
pp. 589-620.
Garver, M.S. & Mentzer, J.T. 1999, "Logistic research methods: Employing structural
equation modeling to test for construct validity", Journal of Business Logistic, vol.
20, no. 1, pp. 33-57.
Gattiker, U.E. & Larwood, L. 1988, "Predictors for Managers' Career Mobility,
Success, and Satisfaction", Human Relations, vol. 41, no. 8, pp. 569-591.
Gautam, T., van Dick, R. & Wagner, U. 2001, "Organizational Commitment in
Nepalese Settings", Asian Journal of Social Psychology, vol. 4, no. 3, pp. 239.
Gellatly, I.R. 1995, "Individual and group determinants of employee absenteeism: Test
of a casual model", Journal of Organizational Behavior, vol. 16, pp. 469-485.
Gilbert, N. 2001, Researching Social Life, 2nd edn, Sage, London.
Gleick, J. 1987, Chaos: Making a New Science, Sphere Book Ltd, London.
222
Goldstein, J. 1988, "A Far-from-Equilibrium Systems Approach to Resistance to
Change", Organizational dynamics, vol. 17, no. 2, pp. 16-26.
Good, L.K., Page, T.J., Jr. & Young, C.E. 1996, "Assessing Hierarchical Differences in
Job-Related Attitudes and Turnover among Retail Managers", Journal of the
Academy of Marketing Science, vol. 24, no. 2, pp. 148-156.
Goulet, L.R. & Singh, P. 2002, "Career Commitment: A Re-examination and an
Extension", Journal of Vocational Behavior, vol. 61, no. 1, pp. 73-91.
Government of Pakistan, 2002, ‘The Taskforce on Improving of Higher Education in
Pakistan: Challenges and Opportunities’, Ministry of Education, Islamabad.
Greenhaus, J., Pararsurman, S., & Wormley, W. 1990, "Effects of race on
organizational experiences, job performance evaluation, and career outcomes",
Academy of Management Journal, vol. 33, no. 1, pp. 64-86.
Greenhaus, J.H. & Beutell, N.J. 1985, "Sources of Conflict between Work and Family
Roles", Academy of Management Review, vol. 10, no. 1, pp. 76-88.
Gregory, D. M., Way, C. Y. LeFort, S., Barrett, B. J., & Parfrey, P. S. 2007, "predictors
of registered nurses' organizatinal commitment and intent to stay", Health Care
Management Review, vol. 32, no. 2, pp. 119-127.
Haider, S. Z. 2008, “Challenges in Higher Education: Special reference to Pakistan and
South Asian Developing Countries”, NONPARTISAN EDUCATION REVIEW,
vol. 4, no. 2, pp.1-12.
Hair, J. F. , Black, Jr. W.C., Babin, B.J., Anderson, R.E. & Tatham, R.L. 2006,
Multivariate Data Analysis, 6th , PEARSON Prentice Hall, USA.
Hall, D. T., & Associates 1986, Career development in organizations, Jossey-Boss, San
Francisco.
Hall, D.T. (1976), Careers in Organizations, Goodyear, Santa Monica, CA.
223
Hall, T.D. 1971,"A theoretical model of career subidentity in organizational settings",
Organizational Behavior and Human Performance, vol. 6, pp. 50-76.
Hampel P. S & Maris G. Martinsons 2009, "Developing international organizational
change theory using cases from China", Human Relations, vol. 62, no. 4, pp. 459-
499.
Hanpachern, C., Morgan, G.A. & Griego, O.V. 1998, "An extension of the theory of
margin: A framework for assessing readiness for change", Human Resource
Development Quarterly, vol. 9, no. 4, pp. 339.
Hardesty, D.M. & Bearden, W.O. 2004, "The use of expert judges in the scale
development: Implications for improving face validity of measures of unobservable
constructs", Journal of Business Research, vol. 57, no. 2, pp. 98-107.
Hart, C. 1998, Doing a Literature Review: Realising the Social Science Research
Imagination. London: Sage.
Hattie, J. 1985, "Methodology Review: Assessing unidimensionality of tests and items",
Applied Psychological Measurement, vol. 9, no. 2, pp. 139-164.
Hayes, I. D. 1990, The crises of education in Pakistan. Lahore, Pakistan: Vanguard
Books.
Healy, M. & Perry, C. 2000, "Comprehensive Criteria to Judge Validity and Reliability
of Qualitative Research within the Realism Paradigm", Qualitative Market
Research: An International Journal, vol. 3, no. 3, pp. 118-126.
Heracleous, L. & Langham, B. 1996, "Strategic change and organizational culture at
hay management consultants", Long Range Planning, vol. 29, no. 4, pp. 485-494.
Herscovitch, L. & J. P. Meyer, (2002). ‘Commitment to organizational change:
extension of a three-component model’, Journal of Applied Psychology, 87, pp.
474-487.
HEC, 2005, Medium Term Development Framework 2005-2010, Higher Education
Commission of Pakistan (HEC), Islamabad, Pakistan.
224
HEC, 2009, Model Tenure Track Process Statues, Document Version 1.8, Higher
Education Commission of Pakistan (HEC), Islamabad, Pakistan.
HEC, no date a, Statistical Booklet on Higher Education Pakistan (2001-02 to 2003-04).
Higher Education Commission of Pakistan (HEC), Islamabad, Pakistan.
HEC, no date b, Higher Education in Pakistan: Towards a Reform Agend, Higher
Education Commission of Pakistan (HEC), Islamabad, Pakistan.
Holloway, P.J. & Mooney, J.A. 2004, "What's a research protocol?", Health Education
Journal, vol. 63, no. 4, pp. 374-384.
Holt, D.T., Armenakis, A.A., Feild, H.S. & Harris, S.G. 2007, "Readiness for
Organizational Change: The Systematic Development of a Scale", Journal of
Applied Behavioral Science, vol. 43, no. 2, pp. 232-255.
Hom, P.W., Katerberg, R. & Hulin, C.L. 1979, "Comparative examination of three
approaches to the prediction of turnover", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 64,
no. 3, pp. 280-290.
Huselid, M.A. 1995, "The Impact of Human Resource Management Practices on
Turnover, Productivity, and Corporate Financial Performance", Academy of
Management Journal, vol. 38, no. 3, pp. 635-672.
Huselid, M.A. & Day, N.E. 1991, "Organizational commitment, job involvement, and
turnover: A substantive and methodological analysis", Journal of Applied
Psychology, vol. 76, no. 3, pp. 380-391.
Hussey, J. & Hussey, R. 1997, Business Research, A practical guide for undergraduate
and postgraduate students, Palgrave, New York.
Ilgen, D.R., & Pulakos, E.D. 1999. ‘Employee performance in today’s organizations. In
D. R. Ilgen, and E.D.Pulakos (Eds.) The changing nature of performance:
Implications for staffing, motivation, and development’. (1-8). San Francisco:
Jossey-Boss.
225
Jansen, K.J. 2000, "The emerging dynamics of change: resistance, readiness, and
momentum", Human Relations, vol. 23, pp. 53-55.
Jick, T.D. 1979, "Mixing Qualitative and Quantitative Methods: Triangulation in
Action", Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 24, no. 4, pp. 602-611.
Jimmieson N. L., Peach, M. & White, K. M. 2008, "Utilizing the theory of planned
behavior to inform change management: An investigation of employee intentions to
support organizational change", The Journal of Applied Behavioral Science, vol. 44,
no. 2, pp. 237-262.
Jimmieson, N.L., Peach, M. & White, K.M. 2008, "Utilizing the Theory of Planned
Behavior to Inform Change Management: An Investigation of Employee Intentions
to Support Organizational Change", Journal of Applied Behavioral Science, vol. 44,
no. 2, pp. 237-262.
Jokisaari, M. & Nurmi, J. 2009, "Changes in newcomers' supervisors support and
socialization outcomes after organizational entry", Academy of Management
Journal, vol. 52, no. 3, pp. 527-544.
Jones, R.A., Jimmieson, N.L. & Griffiths, A. 2005, "The Impact of Organizational
Culture and Reshaping Capabilities on Change Implementation Success: The
Mediating Role of Readiness for Change", Journal of Management Studies, vol. 42,
no. 2, pp. 361-386.
Joreskog, K. & Sorbom, D. 1996, LISREL 8: User's Reference Guide, Scientific
Software International Inc. Chicago, USA.
Judge, T.A. & Bretz, R.D., JR 1994, "Political Influence Behavior and Career Success",
Journal of Management, vol. 20, no. 1, pp. 43-65.
Judge, T.A., Cable, D.M., Boudreau, J.W. & Bretz Jr., R.D. 1995, "An Empirical
Investigation of the Predictors of Executive Career Success", Personnel Psychology,
vol. 48, no. 3, pp. 485-519.
226
Judge, T.A., Thoresen, C.J., Pucik, V. & Welbourne, T.M. 1999, "Managerial coping
with organizational change: A dispositional perspective", Journal of Applied
Psychology, vol. 84, no. 1, pp. 107-122.
Kaarst-Brown, M.L. 1999, "Five symbolic roles of the external consultant", Journal of
Organizational Change Management, vol. 12, no. 6, pp. 540-561.
Kaiser, H.F. 1974, "An Index of Factorial Simplicity", Psychometrika, vol. 39, pp. 31-
36.
Kangas, S., Kee, C.C. & & McKee-Waddle, R. 1999, "Organizational factors, nurses'
job satisfaction, and patient satisfaction with nursing care", Journal of Nursing
Administration, vol. 29, no. 1, pp. 32-42.
Kanungo, R.N. 1982, Work Alienation: An Integrative Approach, Praeger, New York.
Kiesler, R.M. 1971, The Psychology of Commitment, Academic Press, New York.
Kim, H. 1995, "An exploratory study on career development systems in Korean
business", The Korean Personnel Administration Journal, vol. 19, pp. 233-258.
Kim, W.C. & Mauborgne, R. 1998, "Procedural Justice, Strategic Decision Making, and
the Knowledge Economy", Strategic Management Journal (1986-1998), vol. 19, no.
4, pp. 323.
Kline, R.B. 1998, Principles and practice of structural equation modeling, Guilford,
New York.
Konovsky, M.A. & Cropanzano, R. 1991, "Perceived fairness of employee drug testing
as a predictor of employee attitudes and job performance", Journal of Applied
Psychology, vol. 76, no. 5, pp. 698-707.
Kopelman, R.E. 1985, "Job Redesign and Productivity: A review of the Evidence",
National Productivity Review, vol. 4, no. 3, pp. 237-255.
Kotter, J.P. 1996, Leading Change, Harvard Business School Press, Boston.
227
Kotter, J.P. 1995, "Leading Change: Why Transformation Efforts Fail. (cover story)",
Harvard business review, vol. 73, no. 2, pp. 59-67.
Kotter, J.P. & Schlesinger, L.A. 1979, "Choosing strategies for change", Harvard
business review, vol. 57, no. 2, pp. 106-114.
Kriel, P. J. 2006, The Relationship of Morality, Ethics and Justice to Quality of
Worklife, Unpublished PhD Thesis, Southern Cross University, NSW, Australia.
(Online accessed on 12-03-2008)
Lages, L. 2000, The Marketing Strategy-Performance Relationship: A Structural Model
Examination of Portuguese Export Market Ventures, Warwick Business School.
Lehman, W.E.K., Greener, J.M. & Simpson, D.D. 2002, "Assessing organizational
readiness for change", Journal of Substance Abuse Treatment, vol. 22, no. 4, pp.
197-209.
Lewin, K. 1951, Field Theory in Social Sciences, Harper and Row, New York.
Lewis-Beck, M. 1993, "Multiple Regression" in International Handbooks of Qualitative
Applications for the Social Sciences, 2nd edn, Sage, London, pp. 39-68.
Lincoln, Y.S. & Guba, E.G. 1985, Naturalistic inquiry, Sage Publication, Beverly Hills,
CA.
Line, R. 2005, "The structure and function of attitudes towards organizational change",
Human Resource Development Review, vol. 4, pp. 8-32.
Liou, K. & Nyhan, R.C. 1994, "Dimensions of Organizational Commitment in the
Public Sector: an Empirical Assessment", Public Administration Quarterly, vol. 18,
no. 1, pp. 99-118.
Litwin, M.S. 1995, How to measure survey reliability and validity. Sage Publication
Inc. London.
London, M. 1983, "Toward a Theory of Career Motivation", Academy of Management
Review, vol. 8, no. 4, pp. 620-630.
228
Madsen, S.R. 2003, "Wellness in the workplace: Preparing employees for change",
Organization Development Journal, vol. 21, no. 1, pp. 46.
Madsen, S.R., Miller, D. & John, C.R. 2005, "Readiness for organizational change: Do
organizational commitment and social relationships in the workplace make a
difference?", Human Resource Development Quarterly, vol. 16, no. 2, pp. 213.
Martin, A.J., Jones, E.S. & Callan, V.J. 2006, "Status differences in employee
adjustment during organizational change", Journal of Managerial Psychology, vol.
21, no. 1/2, pp. 145.
Martin, A.J., Jones, E.S. & Callan, V.J. 2005, "The role of psychological climate in
facilitating employee adjustment during organizational change", European Journal
of Work & Organizational Psychology, vol. 14, no. 3, pp. 263-289.
Martin, M.M. 1998, "Trust Leadership", Journal of Leadership and Organizational
Studies, vol. 5, no. 3, pp. 41-49.
Maslow, A. 1954, Motivation and Personality, Harper & Row, New York.
Mathews, B.P. & Shepherd, J.L. 2002, "Dimensionality of Cook and Wall's (1980)
British Organizational commitment Scale revisited", Journal of Occupational and
Organizational Psychology, vol. 75, pp. 369.
Mathieu, J.E. & Zajac, D.M. 1990, "A review and meta-analysis of the antecedents,
correlates, and consequences of organizational commitment", Psychological
bulletin, vol. 108, no. 2, pp. 171-194.
Maylor, H. & Blackmon, K. 2005, Researching Business and Management. London:
Palgrave, Macmillan.
McClelland, D. C. 1965, “Toward a theory of motive acquisition”, American
Psychologist, vol. 20, pp.321-333.
McGinnis, S.K. & Morrow, P.C. 1990, "Job attitudes among full- and part-time
employees", Journal of Vocational Behavior, vol. 36, no. 1, pp. 82-96.
229
McNabb, D.E. & Sepic, T.F. 1995, "Culture, Climate, and Total Quality Management:
Measuring Readiness for Change", Public Productivity and Management Review,
vol. 18, no. 4, pp. 369-385.
McNeese-Smith, D.K. 1997, "The influence of manager behavior on nurses' job
satisfaction, productivity, and commitment", Journal of Nursing Administration,
vol. 27, no. 9, pp. 47-55.
Medium Term Development Framework (MTDF) 2005-10, 2005, Higher Education
Commission, Islamabad. Web page
http:// www.hec.gov.pk/html/about_hec/HEC_med_dev.pdf
Memon, G. R. 2007, “Education in Pakistan: The Key Issues, Problems and The New
Challenges,” Journal of Management and Social Sciences, vol. 3, no. 1, pp. 47-55.
Merriam-Webster. (1999). Merriam-Webster’s Collegiate Dictionary. 10th edition.
Spring field, MA:
Meyer, J.P. & Allen, N.J. 1984, "Testing the 'side-bet theory' of organizational
commitment: Some methodological considerations", Journal of Applied
Psychology, vol. 69, no. 3, pp. 372-378.
Meyer, J.P., Allen, N.J. & Smith, C.A. 1993, "Commitment to organizations and
occupations: Extension and test of a three-component conceptualization", Journal of
Applied Psychology, vol. 78, no. 4, pp. 538-551.
Meyer, J.P., Allen, N.J. & Smith, C.A. 1993, "Commitment to organizations and
occupations: Extension and test of a three-component conceptualization", Journal of
Applied Psychology, vol. 78, no. 4, pp. 538-551.
Meyer, J.P. & Herscovitch, L. 2001, "Commitment in the workplace: Toward a general
model", Human Resource Management Review, vol. 11, no. 3, pp. 299.
Mileti, D.S., Gillespie, D.F. & Haas, J.E. 1977, "Size and Structure in Complex
Organizations", Social Forces, vol. 56, no. 1, pp. 208-217.
230
Miller and Brewer 2003, The A-Z of social research, Sage, London.
Miller, D., Madsen, S.R. & John, C.R. 2006, "Readiness for Change: Implications on
Employees' Relationship with Management, Job Knowledge and Skills, and Job
Demands", Journal of Applied Management and Entrepreneurship, vol. 11, no. 1,
pp. 3.
Moblen, W., Horner, O., & Hollingsworth, A. 1978. ‘An evaluation of precursors of
hospital employee turnover’. Journal of Applied Psychology, 63(4): 408-414.
Mohanthy, J. 2000, Current trends in higher education. New Delhi, India: Deep &
Deep.
Montgomery, D., Peck, E., & Vining G. 2001, Introduction to Linear Regression
Analysis, 3rd, Wiley: Chichester.
Morgan, N., Kaleka, A., & Katsikeas, C. 2004, "Antecedents of Export Venture
Performance: A Theoretical Model and Empirical Assessment", Journal of
Marketing, vol. 68, no. 1, pp. 90-108.
Morrow P. C. 1993, The theory and measurement of commitment, Greenwich, CT, JAL.
Morrow, P.C. 1983, "Concept Redundancy in Organizational Research: The Case of
Work Commitment", Academy of Management Review, vol. 8, no. 3, pp. 486-500.
Mottaz, C.J. 1988, "Determinants of Organizational Commitment", Human Relations,
vol. 41, no. 6, pp. 467-482.
Mowday, R. T., Porter, I. W., & Dubin, R. 1974, "Unit performance, situational factors
and employee attitudes in spatially separated work units", Organizational Behaviour
and Human Performance, vol. 12, pp. 231-248.
Mowday, R.T., Steers, R.M. & Porter, L.W. 1979, "The measurement of organizational
commitment", Journal of Vocational Behavior, vol. 14, no. 2, pp. 224-247.
Mueller, R. 1996, Basic Principles of Structural Equation Modelling, Springer, London.
231
Mughal, N. A. & Manzoor. 1999, Issues in higher education: Problems and prospects
of the Pakistani university. Jamshoro, Pakistan: University of Sindh.
Nadvi, K. & Robinson, M. 2004, Pakistan drivers of change: Synthesis and policy
implications. Institute of Development Studies, University of Sussex, Falmer, UK.
Available at: www.gsdrc.org/docs/open/DOC35.pdf (accessed on 25/06/2009)
Narayan, A., Steele-Johnson, D., Delgado, K.M. & Cole, P.A. 2007, "Differential
Effects of Pertaining Influences on Readiness to Change", Journal of Psychology,
vol. 141, no. 1, pp. 47-60.
National Education Policy, 2009, Government of Pakistan, Ministry of Education,
Islamabad.
Netemeyer, R., Bearden, W., & Sharma, S. 2003, Scaling Procedure: Issues and
Applications, Sage, London.
Neuberg, S., Judice, T., & West, S. 1997, "What the Need for Closure Scale Measures
and What It Does Not: Toward Differentiating among Related Epistemic Motives",
Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, vol. 72, no. 6, pp. 1396-1412.
Neuman, J.H. & Baron, R.A. 1998, "Workplace Violence and Workplace Aggression:
Evidence Concerning Specific Forms, Potential Causes, and Preferred Targets",
Journal of Management, vol. 24, no. 3, pp. 391-419.
Norušis, M. J. 1995. SPSS 6.1 Guide to Data Analysis. Englewood Cliffs: Prentice
Hall.
Nunnally, J. 1978, Psychometric Methods, 2nd, McGraw-Hill, New York, NY.
Nutt, P.C. & Backoff, R.W. 1993, "Transforming Public Organizations with Strategic
Management and Strategic Leadership", Journal of Management, vol. 19, no. 2, pp.
299-347.
Obaid, Z. 2006, “Reforming Political Universities: An Organizational Analysis of
University of Peshawar”, Unpublished Thesis, Department of Administration and
Organization, University of Bergen, Norway.
232
Oliver, N. 1990, "Rewards, investments, alternatives and organizational commitment:
Empirical evidence and theoretical development", Journal of Occupational
Psychology, vol. 63, no. 1, pp. 19-31.
Oppenheim, A.N. 1992, Questionnaire design, interviewing and attitude measurement,
Continuum, London.
O'Reilly, C.A. & Chatman, J. 1986, "Organizational commitment and psychological
attachment: The effects of compliance, identification, and internalization on pro-
social behaviour", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 71, no. 3, pp. 492-499.
Organ, D.W. 1988, Organizational Citizenship Behavior: The Good Soldier Syndrome,
Lexington Books, Lexington.
Osama, A., Anjam, A., Lakha, S. K., Gilani, S. Z., & King, C., 2009, “Pakistan’s reform
experiment”, Nature, vol. 461, no. 13. Pp-38-39.
Oxfam, 2006, Girls’ Education in South Asia, Education and Gender Equality Series,
Programme Insights, Oxford: Oxfam GB.
Palmer, I. & Dunford, R. 2008, "Organizational Change and the Importance of
Embedded Assumptions", British Journal of Management, vol. 19, pp. S20-S32.
Park, J. S. & Kim, T. H. 2009, "Do types of organizational culture matter in nurse job
satisfaction and turnover intention?", Leadership in Health Services, vol. 22, no. 1,
pp. 20-38.
Peach, M., Jimmieson, N.L. & White, K.M. 2005, "BELIEFS UNDERLYING
EMPLOYEE READINESS TO SUPPORT A BUILDING RELOCATION: A
Theory of Planned Behavior perspective", Organization Development Journal, vol.
23, no. 3, pp. 9.
Penley, L.E. & Gould, S. 1988, "Etzioni's model of organizational involvement: A
perspective for understanding commitment to organizations", Journal of
Organizational Behavior (1986-1998), vol. 9, no. 1, pp. 43.
233
Peter, P. 1981, "Construct Validity: A Review of Basic Issues and Marketing Practices",
Journal of Marketing Research, vol. 18, no. 2, pp. 133-145.
Peter, P. 1979, "Reliability: A review of Psychometric Basics and Recent Marketing
Practices", Journal of Marketing Research, vol. 16, no. 1, pp. 6-17.
Peter, J.P. & Churchill Jr., G.A. 1986, "Relationships among Research Design Choices
and Psychometric Properties of Rating Scales: A Meta-Analysis", Journal of
Marketing Research (JMR), vol. 23, no. 1, pp. 1-10.
Pinder, C. C. 1998, Work motivation in organizational behaviour, New York: Prentice-
Hall.
Poon, J.M.L. 2004, "Career commitment and career success: moderating role of
emotion perception", Career Development International, vol. 9, no. 4, pp. 374-390.
Powpaka, S. 1998, "Factor Affecting the Adoption of Marketing Orientation: The Case
of Thialand", Journal of International Marketing, vol. 6, no. 1, pp. 33-55.
Price, J. L., & Mueller, C.W. 1986, Absenteeism and turnover of hospital employees.
Greenwich,CT: JAI.
Price, J.L. & Mueller, C.W. 1981, "A Causal Model of Turnover for Nurses", Academy
of Management Journal, vol. 24, no. 3, pp. 543-565.
Rafferty, A.E. & Simons, R.H. 2006, "An Examination of the Antecedents of Readiness
for Fine-Tuning and Corporate Transformation Changes", Journal of Business and
Psychology, vol. 20, no. 3, pp. 325.
Reige, A.M. 2003, "Validity and Reliability Tests in Case Study Research: A Literature
Review with "Hand-on" Application for Each Research Phase", Qualitative Market
Research: An International Journal, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 75-86.
Reilly, N.P. & Orsak, C.L. 1991, "A career stage analysis of career and organizational
commitment in nursing", Journal of Vocational Behavior, vol. 39, no. 3, pp. 311-
330.
234
Remenyi, D., Williams, B., Money, A. & Swartz, E. 1998, Doing Research in Business
and Management: An Introduction to Process and Methods, Sage, London.
Robson, C. 1993, Real World Research, Blackwell, Oxford.
Rosenblatt, Z. & Inbal, B. 1999, "Skill Flexibility among Schoolteachers:
Operationalization and Organizational Implication", Journal of Educational
Administration, vol. 37, no. 4, pp. 345-367.
Rousseau, D. M., Tijoriwala, S. A. 1999, "What's a good reason to change? Motivated
reasoning and social accounts in promoting organizational change", Journal of
Applied Psychology, vol. 84, no. 4, pp. 514-528.
Sagie, A. 1997, "A leader direction and employee participation in decision making:
Contradictory or compatible", Applied Psychology, vol. 46, no. 4, pp. 387-416.
Sagie, A. 1998, "Employee Absenteeism, Organizational Commitment, and Job
Satisfaction: Another Look,", Journal of Vocational Behavior, vol. 52, no. 2, pp.
156-171.
Salomon, G. 1993, Distributed cognitions: Psycholgical and educational
considerations, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge.
Sawahel, W. 2009, Pakistan: Reform model for developed countries, University World
News, Issue: 0080.
Schein, E.H. 1996, "Kurt Lewin's Change Theory in the Field and in the Classroom:
Notes Toward a Model of Managed Learning1", Systems Practice, vol. 9, no. 1, pp.
27-47.
Seibert, S.E., Crant, J.M. & Kraimer, M.L. 1999, "Proactive personality and career
success", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 84, no. 3, pp. 416-427.
Sekaran, U. 2006, Research Methods for Business: A Skill Building Approach, 4th edn,
John Wiley and Sons, New Delhi.
235
Shami, P.A. & Hussain, K.S. 2005, Development of Education in Pakistan, Academy of
Educational Planning and Management (AEPAM), Ministry of Education,
Islamabad, Research Study No. 183.
Sharif, A. M. 2004, “Knowledge representation within information system in
manufacturing environment”, Unpublished Thesis, Department of Information
Systems and Computing, Brunel University, UK.
Sharif, M., Safdar, S., Mubeen, C., Hussain, S., & Rasheed S. 2007, “Factors Affecting
Family Size and Sex Preference: A Study of Urban Tehsil Faisalabad (Pakistan)”,
Journal of Agriculture & Social Sciences, vol. 3, no. 1, pp. 21-24.
Shirom, A. 1994, The system perspective in labour relations: Towards a new model,
JAI Press, Greenwich, CN.
Siddiqui, Z. S. 2006, Higher education reforms in Pakistan: Access and Equity, First
International Conference on Assessing Quality in Higher Education
Simpson, R. 1998, "Presenteeism, Power and Organizational Change: Long Hours as a
Career Barrier and the Impact on the Working Lives of Women Managers", British
Journal of Management, vol. 9, no. 3, pp. S37-S50.
Singh, J. 1995, "Measurement Issues in Cross-National Research", Journal of
International Business Studies, vol. 26, no. 3, pp. 597-619.
Smith, I. 2006, "Continuing professional development and workplace learning - 15",
Library Management, vol. 27, no. 4/5, pp. 300.
Smith, I. 2005, "Achieving readiness for organisational change", Library Management,
vol. 26, no. 6/7, pp. 408.
Solomon, E.E., Bishop, R.C. & Dresser, R.K. 1986, "Organization moderators of gender
differences in career development: A facet classification", Journal of Vocational
Behavior, vol. 29, no. 1, pp. 27-41.
Spector, P.E., 1997, Job Satisfaction: Application, Assessment, Causes, and
Consequences. SAGE Publications, London.
236
Steenkamp, J. E. M. and Trijp, H. C. M. 1991, "The use of LISERL in validating
Marketing Constructs", International Journal of Research in Marketing, vol. 8, pp.
283-299.
Steers, R.M. 1977, "Antecedents and Outcomes of Organizational Commitment",
Administrative Science Quarterly, vol. 22, no. 1, pp. 46.
Sullivan, E.I. & Decker, P.J. 1992, Effective management in nursing, 3rd edn, Addison
Wesley, Redwood City, CA.
Susanto, A.B. 2008, "Organizational readiness for change: A case study on change
readiness in a manufacturing company in Indonesia", International Journal of
Management Perspectives, vol. 2, no. 1, pp. 50-61.
Tabachnick, B. G., & Fidell, L. S. 2007. Using multivariate statistics (5th ed.). Upper
Saddle River, NJ.: Pearson International.
Tannenbaum, R. & Hanna, R.W. 1994, "Holding on, letting go, and moving on:
understanding a neglected perspective on change" in Human Systems Development
Jossey-Bass, San Francisco, CA.
Tetenbaum, T.J. 1998, "Shifting Paradigms: From Newton to Chaos", Organizational
dynamics, vol. 26, no. 4, pp. 21-32.
Ticehurst, G.W. & Veal, A.J. 2000, Business research methods: a managerial
approach, Longman, French Forest, NSW.
USAID, 2008, Evolution of USAID Higher Education Portfolio Task Order No. REE-1-
07-05-00053-00.
Vakola, M., & Nikolaou, I. 2005, "Attitudes towards organizational change: What is the
role of employees' stress and commitment?", Employees Relations, vol. 27, pp. 160-
174.
Vakola, M., Tsaousis, I., & Nikolaou, I. 2003, "The role of emotional intelligence and
personality variables on attitudes towards organizational change", Journal of
Managerial Psychology, vol. 19, pp. 88-110.
237
Vakola, M., Tsausis, I. & Nikolaou, I. 2004, "The role of emotional intelligence and
personality variables on attitudes toward organisational change", Journal of
Managerial Psychology, vol. 19, no. 1/2, pp. 88.
VanYperen, N.W. & van den Berg, A.E. 1999, "Towards a better understanding of the
link between participation in decision-making and organizational citizenship
behaviour: A multilevel analysis", Journal of Occupational & Organizational
Psychology, vol. 72, no. 3, pp. 377-392.
Verschuren, P., Doorewaard, H. (1999), Designing a Research Project, LEMMA,
Utrecht,
Vogt, W.P. 2007, Quantitative research methods for professionals, Pearson, Boston.
Waldrop, M.M. 1992, Complexity: The Emerging Science at the Edge of Order and
Chaos, SIMON & SCHUSTER PAPERBACKS, New York.
Wanberg, C.R. & Banas, J.T. 2000, "Predictors and outcomes of openness to changes in
a reorganizing workplace", Journal of Applied Psychology, vol. 85, no. 1, pp. 132-
142.
Weber, P.S. & Weber, J.E. 2001, "Changes in employee perceptions during
organizational change", Leadership & Organization Development Journal, vol. 22,
no. 5/6, pp. 291.
West, T.D. 1998, "Comparing change readiness, quality improvement, and cost
management among veterans administration, for-profit, and non-profit hospitals",
Journal of health care finance, vol. 25, no. 1, pp. 46.
White, L. 2000, "Changing the "whole system" in the public sector", Journal of
Organizational Change Management, vol. 13, no. 2, pp. 162.
Wiener, Y. & Vardi, Y. 1980, "Relationships between job, organization, and career
commitment and work outcomes: An integrative approach", Organizational
Behavior and Human Performance, vol. 26, pp. 81-96.
238
World Bank, 2006, Higher Education Policy Note: Pakistan: an Assessment of the
Medium-Term Development Framework, Report No. 37247, Human Development
Sector, South Asia Region.
World Bank, 2009, World Development Indicator, Washington D. C.
Wright, K.L. & Thompsen, J.A. 1997, "Building the people's capacity for change", The
TQM Magazine, vol. 9, no. 1, pp. 36-41.
Yin, R.K. 1994, Case study research: design and methods, Sage Publication, Thousands
Oakes, California.
Yoon, J. & Thye, S.R. 2002, "A Dual Process Model of Organizational Commitment:
Job Satisfaction and Organizational Support", Work and Occupations, vol. 29, no. 1,
pp. 97-124.
Zangaro, G.A. 2001, "Organizational Commitment: A Concept Analysis", Nursing
forum, vol. 36, no. 2, pp. 14.
239
Appendix 1 Survey Questionnaire
Section “A” Demography (please tick the relevant box) 1. Gender Male Female 2. Age Less than 21 21-30 31-40
41-50 51 – 60 above 60 3. Present Marital Status Single Married Divorced / Widow
Other
4. Present Employment Status Lecturer Assistant Professor Associate Professor Professor
5. Highest Education Level B.E/M.B.B.S/ Masters Degree MS/M.Phil Degree Ph.D Degree
6. Number of Dependents 1-2 3-4 5-6
7+ None
7. Years on present job < 1 year 1-5 years 6-10 years 11-15 years 16 -20 years 21 and more
8. Years with present employer < 1 year 1-5 years 6-10 years
11-15 years 16 -20 years 21 and more
Section “B” Readiness for Organisational Change
Please tick on the scale below to what extent you like with each of the following statement about the recent changes in the university: (1 = Very Unlikely, 2 = Unlikely, 3 = Somewhat Unlikely, 4 = Neutral, 5 = Somewhat Likely, 6 = Likely, 7 = Very Likely). Very Very
Likely Unlikely
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9. My willingness to work more because of
the change is
10. My willingness to solve university problems is
11. My willingness to be a part of the new project is
12. My willingness to create new ideas is
13. My willingness to find ways to make the
change fail is
240
Very Very
Likely Unlikely
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
14. My willingness to do things in a new or creative way is
15. My willingness to change the way I work because of the change is
16. My willingness to take responsibility for the change if it fails in my area is
17. My willingness to be a part of the change programme is
18. My willingness to learn new things is
19. My willingness to change something even if it appears to be working
20. My willingness to support change is
21. My willingness to improve what we are
currently doing rather than implement a major change is
22. My willingness to sell ideas about the change is
Section “C” Employee Commitment for the Organisation
Please tick on the scale below to what extent you agree with each of the following statement about the university: (1 = Strongly Disagree, 2 = Disagree, 3 = Neutral, 4 = Agree, 5 = Strongly Agree).
Strongly Strongly
Agree Disagree
1 2 3 4 5
23. I am quite proud to be able to tell people who it is I work for
24. I sometimes feel like leaving the employment for good.
25. I am not willing to put myself out just to help the university
26. Even if the university were not doing too well financially, I would be reluctant to
change to another employer
241
27. I feel myself to be part of the university
28. In my work I like to feel I am making some effort, not just for myself but for the university as well
29. The offer of a bit more money with another employer would not seriously make me think of changing my job
30. I would not recommend a close friend to join our staff
31. To know that my own work had made a contribution to the good of the university
would please me
32. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my training and education
33. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my effort that I input.
34. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work experience
35. Compared to other employees, my work reward is proper in view of my work responsibilities
36. The procedures used to determine my pay raise are fair and consistent
Section “D” Employee Commitment for the Career
Please tick on the scale below to what extent you agree with each of the following statements (1 = Strongly Disagree, 2 = Disagree, 3 = Neutral, 4 = Agree, 5 = Strongly Agree)
Strongly Strongly
Agree Disagree
37. If I could get another job different from this one and paying the same amount, I would
probably take it 38. I definitely want a career for myself in my current area
39. If I could do it all over again, I would not choose to work in this profession
40. If I had all the money I need without working, I would probably still continue in this profession
41. I like this profession too well to give it up
242
42. This is the ideal profession for a work life 43. I am disappointed that I ever entered this profession
44. I spend a significant amount of time personal time reading profession related journals or
books
45. This university prefers to promote from within rather than hire outsider for high level positions
46. Over all, this university does a good job placing competent people in position
47. This university does good job in moving people to new jobs when university require it
48. My job is like a hobby to me 49. It seems that my friends are more interested in their jobs
50. I feel fairly well satisfied with my present job 51. I feel that my job is no more interesting than others I could get
52. Each day of work seems like it will never end 53. I find really enjoyment in my work 54. I am disappointed that I ever took this job
55. The most important things that happen to me involve my job
56. To me my Job is only a small part of whom I am
57. I am very much involved personally in my job 58. I live, eat and breathe my job 59. I have very strong ties to job 60. My boss shows me how to improve my performance
61. I can communicate well with my boss 62. I respect my boss’s judgment on my issue 63. My boss lets me know what is expected of me 64. My boss encourages me to give my best efforts
243
65. My work group has helped find solutions to problems
66. Training is regarded as a way to improve performance
67. This university has a well defined training and skills development programmes for the employees
68. I am given a real opportunity to improve my skills in this University
69. I have been well trained by this university for my current job
70. This university has not trained me well for potential future Jobs
Section “E” Social Relationships in the Workplace
Please tick on the scale below to what extent you agree with each of the following statements about the social relationships at the workplace: (1 = Strongly Disagree, 2 = Disagree, 3 = Neutral, 4 = Agree, 5 = Strongly Agree)
Strongly Strongly
Agree Disagree 71. My interpersonal relationships with my co workers are excellent
72. Working with others is often difficult 73. My relationship to the leaders in my university is very positive
74. The people I have met at my job are great
(Thank you for taking the time to complete the questionnaire)
244
Appendix 2 Covering Letter
--------------------------- --------------------------- --------------------------- Subject: Participation in a survey questionnaire about a study of determinants of
employee readiness for organisational change. Dear --------------- I am writing to introduce my PhD study on “Determinants of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change”. This research study is sponsored by the Higher Education Commission of Pakistan and is being carried out at Brunel Business School, Brunel University, UK. It has approval from a Business School Research Ethics Committee, Brunel University. This research involves completion of a questionnaire that comprises questions about demography, employee readiness for change, employee commitment for the organisation and career, and social relationships in the workplace. The participants of this study include different cadres of academics / faculty members at public sector higher education institutions in Pakistan. In the hope that you are able to take part in this study and I am enclosing the consent form and the questionnaire. If you are happy to proceed please complete the attached form and return it to me within two weeks time of receiving it. If you would like to discuss this with me in more detail please email/telephone me on the address/ telephone number given below. We hope to be complete the second phase of the study over the next four months and we look forward to your positive response. Thank you for your help and time. Yours sincerely, Naimatullah Shah PhD Researcher Brunel Business School, 116 Chadwick Building (1st Floor) Brunel University, Uxbridge Campus Uxbridge, Middlesex UB8 3PH Tel. Internal: 66902 External 0044 01895266902 Cell # 0044 7904392479 Cell # 0092 3793900 E-mail: [email protected]
245
Appendix 3 Research Consent Form
Required for research involving human participants
Title of Research: Determinants of Employee Readiness for Organisational Change Researcher: Naimatullah Shah, PhD Student, Brunel Business School, Brunel
University Contact Information: [email protected] Purpose of the Research: To examine the employee attitudes and behaviours with
the support of employee commitment for the organisation and career factors towards readiness for organisational change.
What is involved in participating?
I will ask you to complete the following survey questionnaire signed below serves to signify that you agree to participate in this study.
Your participation is voluntary and you can choose to decline to answer any question or even to withdraw at any point form the project. Anything you say will only be attributed to you with your permission: if not, the information will be reported in such a way as to make direct association with yourself impossible. Confidentiality also means that the questionnaire will be coded and stored in such a way as to make it impossible to identify them directly with any individual (e.g. they will be organised by number rather than by name)
Consent:
I wish to be identified in the report YES NO I have read the above information and I agree to participate in this study (please tick) Researcher’s signature: ___________________________ Date: ____________________
246
Appendix 4 Survey Questionnaire Coding and labelling
Q. No. Question Code Question Label
1 Gender Gender
2 Age Age
3 M-Status Marital Status
4 Emp-Status Employment Status
5 HE-Level Higher Educational Level
6 N-Dependents Number of Dependents
7 YP-Job Years on Present Job
8 YP-Employer Years with Present Employer
9 ROCH1 Work because of change
10 ROCH2 Solve organisation problems
11 ROCH3 Be a part of new project
12 ROCH4 Create new ideas
13 ROCH5 Ways to make change
14 ROCH6 Do things in a creative way
15 ROCH7 Change the ways
16 ROCH8 Take responsibility if it fails
17 ROCH9 Be a part of change programme
18 ROCH10 Learn new things
19 ROCH11 Change something even appears
20 ROCH12 Support change
21 ROCH13 Improve currently
22 ROCH14 Sell ideas
23 FOPR1 Proud to tell people
24 EMAT1 Sometimes feel like leaving
25 PSO1 Not willing to put just to help
26 EMAT2 Organisation not doing too well
27 FOPR2 I feel myself to be part
28 PSO2 I am making some efforts
29 EMAT3 Offer not make me think
30 FOPR3 Not recommend to friend
31 PSO3 Contribution to the organisation
32 PAWA1 Proper reward of training
33 PAWA2 Proper reward of efforts
247
34 PAWA3 Proper reward of experience
35 PAWA4 Proper reward of work
36 PAWA5 Pay raise procedure is fair
37 CACO1 I could get another job
38 CACO2 Want a career for myself
39 CACO3 Do it all over again
40 CACO4 I probably continue this profession
41 CACO5 I like this profession
42 CACO6 This is ideal profession
43 CACO7 Disappointed to enter
44 CACO8 Significant amount of time to read
45 PMTN1 Organisation prefers to promote
46 PMTN2 Organisation placing competent people
47 PMTN3 Organisation does good job
48 JOSA1 Job is like a hobby
49 JOSA2 My friends are more interested
50 JOSA3 I am fairly satisfied with my job
51 JOSA4 Job is no more interesting
52 JOSA5 Each day work never end
53 JOSA6 Really enjoy in my work
54 JOSA7 Disappointed taking this job
55 JOIN1 Important things to involve
56 JOIN2 Job is small part for me
57 JOIN3 I am much Involve personally in job
58 JOIN4 Live, eat and breathe my job
59 JOIN5 Strong ties to job
60 SPRE1 Improve performance
61 SPRE2 Communicate with supervisor
62 SPRE3 Respect supervisor's judgement
63 SPRE4 Supervisor lets me know
64 SPRE5 Supervisor encourage me
65 SPRE6 Work group help
66 TSDE1 Training improve performance
67 TSDE2 Organisation has training programmes
68 TSDE3 Opportunity to improve skills
69 TSDE4 Organisation well trained me
70 TSDE5 Organisation not trained me
248
71 SORE1 Interpersonal relations are excellent
72 SORE2 Working with others is difficult
73 SORE3 Relationship to the leaders are positive
74 SORE4 People are great
249
Appendix 5 Survey Questionnaire Coding and labelling
Q. No. Variable Code Variable Name Question Numbers
1 Demography Demography 1 – 8
1 ROCH Readiness for Change 9 – 122
2 FOPR Feeling of Pride 23, 27, 30
3 EMAT Emotional Attachment 24, 26, 29
4 PSO Personal Sense of Obligation 25, 28, 31
5 PAWA Pays and Wages 32 – 36
7 CACO Career Commitment 37 – 44
8 PMTN Promotions 45 – 47
9 JOSA Job Satisfaction 48 – 54
10 JOIN Job Involvement 55 – 59
11 SPRE Supervisor and Peer Relations 60 – 65
12 TSDE Training and Skills Development 66 – 70
13 SORE Social Relationships in the Workplace 71 – 74
250
Appendix 6 Univariate Statistics
N Mean Std. Deviation Missing Count Percent Low High Count
ROCH1 554 5.64 1.211 2 .4 ROCH2 555 5.86 1.271 1 .2 ROCH3 554 5.61 1.316 2 .4 ROCH4 556 5.81 1.248 0 .0 ROCH5 551 4.76 1.514 5 .9 ROCH6 554 5.79 1.267 2 .4 ROCH7 553 5.59 1.186 3 .5 ROCH8 551 5.14 1.447 5 .9 ROCH9 551 5.66 1.085 5 .9 ROCH10 549 5.95 1.239 7 1.3 ROCH11 548 5.33 1.357 8 1.4 ROCH12 549 5.74 1.241 7 1.3 ROCH13 553 5.16 1.522 3 .5 ROCH14 552 5.30 1.315 4 .7 FOPR1 554 4.10 1.006 2 .4 EMAT1 552 3.88 1.204 4 .7 PSO1 550 4.02 1.050 6 1.1 EMAT2 551 3.77 1.189 5 .9 FOPR2 553 4.07 1.012 3 .5 PSO2 553 4.37 .679 3 .5 EMAT3 553 3.92 1.120 3 .5 FOPR3 552 4.09 1.095 4 .7 PSO3 554 4.51 .640 2 .4 PAWA1 554 3.87 .960 2 .4 PAWA2 554 3.90 .974 2 .4 PAWA3 552 3.86 .942 4 .7 PAWA4 554 3.81 .950 2 .4 PAWA5 553 3.48 1.098 3 .5 CACO1 554 3.98 1.188 2 .4 CACO2 554 4.27 .849 2 .4 CACO3 553 3.96 1.149 3 .5 CACO4 554 3.91 1.124 2 .4 CACO5 552 3.84 1.091 4 .7 CACO6 554 4.26 .839 2 .4 CACO7 552 4.19 1.106 4 .7 CACO8 554 3.93 .872 2 .4 PMTN1 552 3.89 1.117 4 .7 PMTN2 554 3.82 1.125 2 .4 PMTN3 553 3.80 1.136 3 .5 JOSA1 553 4.03 1.038 3 .5 JOSA2 554 3.76 .966 2 .4 JOSA3 554 3.95 1.042 2 .4 JOSA4 553 3.85 1.125 3 .5 JOSA5 553 4.01 1.156 3 .5 JOSA6 554 4.10 1.029 2 .4 JOSA7 553 3.99 1.085 3 .5
251
JOIN1 552 3.86 .897 4 .7 JOIN2 552 4.01 .917 4 .7 JOIN3 554 4.08 .923 2 .4 JOIN4 552 4.07 .900 4 .7 JOIN5 551 4.15 .867 5 .9 SPRE1 554 4.01 1.157 2 .4 SPRE2 554 3.99 .956 2 .4 SPRE3 554 3.94 .999 2 .4 SPRE4 554 3.89 1.007 2 .4 SPRE5 554 3.92 1.083 2 .4 SPRE6 553 3.75 1.002 3 .5 TSDE1 554 4.22 .845 2 .4 TSDE2 554 3.15 1.225 2 .4 TSDE3 554 3.46 1.115 2 .4 TSDE4 554 3.33 1.155 2 .4 TSDE5 554 3.53 1.165 2 .4 SORE1 554 3.98 .986 2 .4 SORE2 554 3.79 1.094 2 .4 SORE3 554 3.99 .919 2 .4 SORE4 554 4.12 1.005 2 .4 Gender 556 1.39 .488 0 .0 Age 555 3.21 1.104 1 .2 M_Status 555 1.71 .580 1 .2 Emp_Status 556 2.00 1.045 0 .0 HE_Level 556 1.87 .838 0 .0 N.Dependents 555 2.79 1.461 1 .2 YP_Job 556 2.90 1.512 0 .0 YP_Employer 556 3.37 1.699 0 .0
a Number of cases outside the range (Q1 - 1.5*IQR, Q3 + 1.5*IQR).